1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 //  This file implements semantic analysis for declarations.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/Randstruct.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h"
29 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
30 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
31 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
32 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
33 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex
34 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering.
35 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex
36 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled()
37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h"
38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
47 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
48 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
49 #include <algorithm>
50 #include <cstring>
51 #include <functional>
52 #include <unordered_map>
53 
54 using namespace clang;
55 using namespace sema;
56 
57 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) {
58   if (OwnedType) {
59     Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr };
60     return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2));
61   }
62 
63   return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr));
64 }
65 
66 namespace {
67 
68 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
69  public:
70    TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false,
71                         bool AllowTemplates = false,
72                         bool AllowNonTemplates = true)
73        : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass),
74          AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) {
75      WantExpressionKeywords = false;
76      WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
77      WantRemainingKeywords = false;
78   }
79 
80   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
81     if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) {
82       if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl())
83         return false;
84 
85       if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND))
86         return AllowTemplates;
87 
88       bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND);
89       if (!IsType)
90         return false;
91 
92       if (AllowNonTemplates)
93         return true;
94 
95       // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid
96       // as a template or as a non-template.
97       if (AllowTemplates) {
98         auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND);
99         if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName())
100           return false;
101         RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext());
102         return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() ||
103                isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD);
104       }
105 
106       return false;
107     }
108 
109     return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword();
110   }
111 
112   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
113     return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this);
114   }
115 
116  private:
117   bool AllowInvalidDecl;
118   bool WantClassName;
119   bool AllowTemplates;
120   bool AllowNonTemplates;
121 };
122 
123 } // end anonymous namespace
124 
125 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier.
126 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const {
127   switch (Kind) {
128   // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a
129   // token kind is a valid type specifier
130   case tok::kw_short:
131   case tok::kw_long:
132   case tok::kw___int64:
133   case tok::kw___int128:
134   case tok::kw_signed:
135   case tok::kw_unsigned:
136   case tok::kw_void:
137   case tok::kw_char:
138   case tok::kw_int:
139   case tok::kw_half:
140   case tok::kw_float:
141   case tok::kw_double:
142   case tok::kw___bf16:
143   case tok::kw__Float16:
144   case tok::kw___float128:
145   case tok::kw___ibm128:
146   case tok::kw_wchar_t:
147   case tok::kw_bool:
148   case tok::kw___underlying_type:
149   case tok::kw___auto_type:
150     return true;
151 
152   case tok::annot_typename:
153   case tok::kw_char16_t:
154   case tok::kw_char32_t:
155   case tok::kw_typeof:
156   case tok::annot_decltype:
157   case tok::kw_decltype:
158     return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
159 
160   case tok::kw_char8_t:
161     return getLangOpts().Char8;
162 
163   default:
164     break;
165   }
166 
167   return false;
168 }
169 
170 namespace {
171 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult {
172   NotFound,
173   FoundNonType,
174   FoundType
175 };
176 } // end anonymous namespace
177 
178 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for
179 /// dependent class.
180 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a
181 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found.
182 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult
183 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II,
184                                 SourceLocation NameLoc,
185                                 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
186   if (!RD->hasDefinition())
187     return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
188   // Look for type decls in base classes.
189   UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl =
190       UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
191   for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) {
192     const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr;
193     if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>())
194       BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
195     else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
196       // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary
197       // templates.
198       if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType())
199         continue;
200       auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl();
201       if (!TD)
202         continue;
203       if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate =
204           dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
205         if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl())
206           BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate;
207         else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) {
208           if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS =
209                   CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType()))
210             if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl())
211               BaseRD = PS;
212         }
213       }
214     }
215     if (BaseRD) {
216       for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) {
217         if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND))
218           return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType;
219         FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType;
220       }
221       if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) {
222         switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) {
223         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType:
224           return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType;
225         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType:
226           FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType;
227           break;
228         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound:
229           break;
230         }
231       }
232     }
233   }
234 
235   return FoundTypeDecl;
236 }
237 
238 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S,
239                                                       const IdentifierInfo &II,
240                                                       SourceLocation NameLoc) {
241   // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any.
242   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
243   UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl =
244       UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
245   for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext;
246        DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
247        DC = DC->getParent()) {
248     // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary
249     // templates.
250     RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
251     if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
252       FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD);
253   }
254   if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType)
255     return nullptr;
256 
257   // We found some types in dependent base classes.  Recover as if the user
258   // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'.  We'll fully resolve the
259   // lookup during template instantiation.
260   S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II;
261 
262   ASTContext &Context = S.Context;
263   auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false,
264                                           cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD)));
265   QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II);
266 
267   CXXScopeSpec SS;
268   SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
269 
270   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
271   DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T);
272   DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc);
273   DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
274   DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
275   return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
276 }
277 
278 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope,
279 /// return the declaration of that type.
280 ///
281 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II
282 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to
283 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an
284 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that
285 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL.
286 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc,
287                              Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS,
288                              bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot,
289                              ParsedType ObjectTypePtr,
290                              bool IsCtorOrDtorName,
291                              bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo,
292                              bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext,
293                              IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) {
294   // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension.
295   bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext &&
296                               getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName &&
297                               !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot;
298 
299   // Determine where we will perform name lookup.
300   DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr;
301   if (ObjectTypePtr) {
302     QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get();
303     if (ObjectType->isRecordType())
304       LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType);
305   } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) {
306     LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false);
307 
308     if (!LookupCtx) {
309       if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) {
310         // C++ [temp.res]p3:
311         //   A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the
312         //   nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2)
313         //   shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the
314         //   qualified-id denotes a type, forming an
315         //   elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3).
316         //
317         // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would
318         // refer to a member of an unknown specialization.
319         if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName)
320           return nullptr;
321 
322         // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type,
323         // so build a dependent node to describe the type.
324         if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo)
325           return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get();
326 
327         NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context);
328         QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc,
329                                        II, NameLoc);
330         return ParsedType::make(T);
331       }
332 
333       return nullptr;
334     }
335 
336     if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() &&
337         RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx))
338       return nullptr;
339   }
340 
341   // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of
342   // lookup for class-names.
343   LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName :
344                                       LookupOrdinaryName;
345   LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind);
346   if (LookupCtx) {
347     // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we
348     // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access
349     // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior
350     // nested-name-specifier.
351     LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx);
352 
353     if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) {
354       // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3:
355       //   If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up
356       //   in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of
357       //   the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also
358       //   looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall
359       //   find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T.
360       LookupName(Result, S);
361     }
362   } else {
363     // Perform unqualified name lookup.
364     LookupName(Result, S);
365 
366     // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into
367     // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known.
368     if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) {
369       if (ParsedType TypeInBase =
370               recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc))
371         return TypeInBase;
372     }
373   }
374 
375   NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr;
376   UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = nullptr;
377   switch (Result.getResultKind()) {
378   case LookupResult::NotFound:
379   case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation:
380     if (CorrectedII) {
381       TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName,
382                                AllowDeducedTemplate);
383       TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind,
384                                               S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
385       IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
386       TemplateTy Template;
387       bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
388       UnqualifiedId TemplateName;
389       TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc);
390       NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier();
391       CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS;
392       if (SS && NNS) {
393         NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
394         NewSSPtr = &NewSS;
395       }
396       if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) &&
397           // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected
398           // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names
399           // is handled elsewhere).
400           !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr &&
401             isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false,
402                            Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) {
403         ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr,
404                                     isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr,
405                                     IsCtorOrDtorName,
406                                     WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo,
407                                     IsClassTemplateDeductionContext);
408         if (Ty) {
409           diagnoseTypo(Correction,
410                        PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest)
411                          << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName);
412           if (SS && NNS)
413             SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
414           *CorrectedII = NewII;
415           return Ty;
416         }
417       }
418     }
419     // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through
420     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
421   case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
422   case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
423     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
424     return nullptr;
425 
426   case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
427     // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type.  We'll
428     // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can
429     // diagnose the error then.  If we don't do this, then the error
430     // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error
431     // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type.
432     if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) {
433       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
434       return nullptr;
435     }
436 
437     // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results.
438     for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end();
439          Res != ResEnd; ++Res) {
440       NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl();
441       if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(
442               RealRes) ||
443           (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) {
444         if (!IIDecl ||
445             // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic.
446             RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) {
447           IIDecl = RealRes;
448           FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Res);
449         }
450       }
451     }
452 
453     if (!IIDecl) {
454       // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way
455       // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't
456       // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to
457       // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which
458       // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected
459       // a type name.
460       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
461       return nullptr;
462     }
463 
464     // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the
465     // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right
466     // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to
467     // perform the name lookup again.
468     break;
469 
470   case LookupResult::Found:
471     IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl();
472     FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin());
473     break;
474   }
475 
476   assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl");
477 
478   QualType T;
479   if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) {
480     // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name
481     // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class.
482     // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name.
483     auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx);
484     auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD);
485     if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD &&
486         FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() &&
487         declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent())))
488       Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor)
489           << &II << /*Type*/1;
490 
491     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc);
492 
493     T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
494     MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false);
495   } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) {
496     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc);
497     if (!HasTrailingDot)
498       T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl);
499     FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; // FIXME: Target must be a TypeDecl.
500   } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) {
501     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc);
502     // Recover with 'int'
503     T = Context.IntTy;
504     FoundUsingShadow = nullptr;
505   } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) {
506     if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) {
507       assert(!FoundUsingShadow || FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl() == TD);
508       TemplateName Template =
509           FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD);
510       T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, QualType(),
511                                                        false);
512       // Don't wrap in a further UsingType.
513       FoundUsingShadow = nullptr;
514     }
515   }
516 
517   if (T.isNull()) {
518     // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics.
519     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
520     return nullptr;
521   }
522 
523   if (FoundUsingShadow)
524     T = Context.getUsingType(FoundUsingShadow, T);
525 
526   // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a
527   // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier
528   // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node).
529   if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName &&
530       !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) {
531     if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) {
532       // Construct a type with type-source information.
533       TypeLocBuilder Builder;
534       Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc);
535 
536       T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T);
537       ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T);
538       ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
539       ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context));
540       return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
541     } else {
542       T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T);
543     }
544   }
545 
546   return ParsedType::make(T);
547 }
548 
549 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context.
550 static NestedNameSpecifier *
551 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) {
552   for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
553     DC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
554     auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC);
555     if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace())
556       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND);
557     else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
558       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(),
559                                          RD->getTypeForDecl());
560     else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
561       return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context);
562   }
563   llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?");
564 }
565 
566 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method
567 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end
568 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC
569 /// correctly rejects.
570 static const CXXRecordDecl *
571 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) {
572   for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
573     DC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
574     if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC))
575       if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases())
576         return MD->getParent();
577   }
578   return nullptr;
579 }
580 
581 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II,
582                                           SourceLocation NameLoc,
583                                           bool IsTemplateTypeArg) {
584   assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode");
585 
586   NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr;
587   if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) {
588     // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup
589     // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We
590     // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and
591     // lookup is retried.
592     // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no
593     // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any
594     // name specifiers.
595     NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext);
596     Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II;
597   } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD =
598                  findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) {
599     // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at
600     // instantiation time.
601     NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(),
602                                       RD->getTypeForDecl());
603 
604     // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during
605     // template instantiation.
606     Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II
607                                                                       << RD;
608   } else {
609     // This is not a situation that we should recover from.
610     return ParsedType();
611   }
612 
613   QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II);
614 
615   // Build type location information.  We synthesized the qualifier, so we have
616   // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc.
617   NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder;
618   NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
619   NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context);
620 
621   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
622   DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T);
623   DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc);
624   DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
625   DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc);
626   return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
627 }
628 
629 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only*
630 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo").  If
631 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum,
632 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class).  This is used to diagnose
633 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag.
634 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) {
635   // Do a tag name lookup in this scope.
636   LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName);
637   LookupName(R, S, false);
638   R.suppressDiagnostics();
639   if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found)
640     if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) {
641       switch (TD->getTagKind()) {
642       case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct;
643       case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface;
644       case TTK_Union:  return DeclSpec::TST_union;
645       case TTK_Class:  return DeclSpec::TST_class;
646       case TTK_Enum:   return DeclSpec::TST_enum;
647       }
648     }
649 
650   return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified;
651 }
652 
653 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope,
654 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes
655 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning.
656 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example:
657 /// @code
658 /// template<class T> class A {
659 /// public:
660 ///   typedef int TYPE;
661 /// };
662 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> {
663 /// public:
664 ///   A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class.
665 /// };
666 /// @endcode
667 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) {
668   if (CurContext->isRecord()) {
669     if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super)
670       return true;
671 
672     const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType();
673 
674     CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext);
675     for (const auto &Base : RD->bases())
676       if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType()))
677         return true;
678     return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope();
679   }
680   return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope();
681 }
682 
683 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II,
684                                    SourceLocation IILoc,
685                                    Scope *S,
686                                    CXXScopeSpec *SS,
687                                    ParsedType &SuggestedType,
688                                    bool IsTemplateName) {
689   // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders.
690   if (II->isEditorPlaceholder())
691     return;
692   // We don't have anything to suggest (yet).
693   SuggestedType = nullptr;
694 
695   // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo
696   // results, in case we have something that we can suggest.
697   TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false,
698                            /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName,
699                            /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName);
700   if (TypoCorrection Corrected =
701           CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS,
702                       CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
703     // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case.
704     bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName;
705     if (Corrected.isKeyword()) {
706       // We corrected to a keyword.
707       diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
708                    PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest
709                                         : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest)
710                        << II);
711       II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
712     } else {
713       // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that.
714       if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) {
715         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
716                      PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest
717                                           : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest)
718                          << II, CanRecover);
719       } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) {
720         std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
721         bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() &&
722                                 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr);
723         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
724                      PDiag(IsTemplateName
725                                ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest
726                                : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest)
727                          << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(),
728                      CanRecover);
729       } else {
730         llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here");
731       }
732 
733       if (!CanRecover)
734         return;
735 
736       CXXScopeSpec tmpSS;
737       if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier())
738         tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(),
739                           SourceRange(IILoc));
740       // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here.
741       SuggestedType =
742           getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S,
743                       tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr,
744                       /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false,
745                       /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true);
746     }
747     return;
748   }
749 
750   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) {
751     // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to.
752     UnqualifiedId Name;
753     Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc);
754     CXXScopeSpec EmptySS;
755     TemplateTy TemplateResult;
756     bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
757     if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false,
758                        Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult,
759                        MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) {
760       diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc);
761       return;
762     }
763   }
764 
765   // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag
766   // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead?
767 
768   if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid()))
769     Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template
770                                : diag::err_unknown_typename)
771         << II;
772   else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false))
773     Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template
774                                : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found)
775         << II << DC << SS->getRange();
776   else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) {
777     SuggestedType =
778         ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get();
779   } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) {
780     unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
781     if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S))
782       DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
783 
784     Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID)
785       << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName()
786       << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc)
787       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename ");
788     SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(),
789                                       *SS, *II, IILoc).get();
790   } else {
791     assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() &&
792            "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed");
793   }
794 }
795 
796 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name
797 /// or
798 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) {
799   bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
800                        NextToken.is(tok::less);
801 
802   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) {
803     if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I))
804       return true;
805 
806     if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I))
807       return true;
808   }
809 
810   return false;
811 }
812 
813 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result,
814                                     Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
815                                     IdentifierInfo *&Name,
816                                     SourceLocation NameLoc) {
817   LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName);
818   SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS);
819   if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) {
820     StringRef FixItTagName;
821     switch (Tag->getTagKind()) {
822       case TTK_Class:
823         FixItTagName = "class ";
824         break;
825 
826       case TTK_Enum:
827         FixItTagName = "enum ";
828         break;
829 
830       case TTK_Struct:
831         FixItTagName = "struct ";
832         break;
833 
834       case TTK_Interface:
835         FixItTagName = "__interface ";
836         break;
837 
838       case TTK_Union:
839         FixItTagName = "union ";
840         break;
841     }
842 
843     StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back();
844     SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag)
845       << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
846       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName);
847 
848     for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end();
849          I != IEnd; ++I)
850       SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type)
851         << Name << TagName;
852 
853     // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl.
854     Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName);
855     SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS);
856     return true;
857   }
858 
859   return false;
860 }
861 
862 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
863                                             IdentifierInfo *&Name,
864                                             SourceLocation NameLoc,
865                                             const Token &NextToken,
866                                             CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) {
867   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc);
868   ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
869 
870   assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) &&
871          "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName");
872   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() &&
873       isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) {
874     // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the
875     // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that.
876     // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser
877     // will reject it later.
878     return NameClassification::Unknown();
879   }
880 
881   LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
882   LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod);
883 
884   if (SS.isInvalid())
885     return NameClassification::Error();
886 
887   // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into
888   // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known.
889   if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
890     if (ParsedType TypeInBase =
891             recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc))
892       return TypeInBase;
893   }
894 
895   // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically
896   // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method.
897   // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal
898   // unqualified lookup mechanism.
899   if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) {
900     DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name);
901     if (Ivar.isInvalid())
902       return NameClassification::Error();
903     if (Ivar.isUsable())
904       return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get()));
905 
906     // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods.
907     if (Result.empty())
908       LookupBuiltin(Result);
909   }
910 
911   bool SecondTry = false;
912   bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false;
913 
914 Corrected:
915   switch (Result.getResultKind()) {
916   case LookupResult::NotFound:
917     // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function
918     // call.
919     if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) {
920       // In C++, this is an ADL-only call.
921       // FIXME: Reference?
922       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
923         return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType();
924 
925       // C90 6.3.2.2:
926       //   If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a
927       //   function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no
928       //   declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is
929       //   implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing
930       //   the function call, the declaration
931       //
932       //     extern int identifier ();
933       //
934       //   appeared.
935       //
936       // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. However, this is not
937       // allowed in all language modes as functions without prototypes may not
938       // be supported.
939       if (getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) {
940         if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S))
941           return NameClassification::NonType(D);
942       }
943     }
944 
945     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) {
946       // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function
947       // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name.
948       //
949       // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case.
950       TemplateName Template =
951           Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
952       return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template);
953     }
954 
955     // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in
956     // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum",
957     // "struct", or "union".
958     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry &&
959         isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) {
960       break;
961     }
962 
963     // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is
964     // close to this name.
965     if (!SecondTry && CCC) {
966       SecondTry = true;
967       if (TypoCorrection Corrected =
968               CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S,
969                           &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
970         unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
971         unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest;
972 
973         NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl();
974         NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl();
975         if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
976             UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) {
977           UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest;
978           QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest;
979         } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl &&
980                    (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) ||
981                     isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) ||
982                     isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) {
983           UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest;
984           QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest;
985         }
986 
987         if (SS.isEmpty()) {
988           diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name);
989         } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it.
990           std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
991           bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() &&
992                                   Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr);
993           diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag)
994                                     << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
995                                     << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange());
996         }
997 
998         // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name.
999         Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
1000 
1001         // Typo correction corrected to a keyword.
1002         if (Corrected.isKeyword())
1003           return Name;
1004 
1005         // Also update the LookupResult...
1006         // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point
1007         Result.clear();
1008         Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1009         if (FirstDecl)
1010           Result.addDecl(FirstDecl);
1011 
1012         // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1013         // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
1014         // reference the ivar.
1015         // FIXME: This is a gross hack.
1016         if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1017           DeclResult R =
1018               LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier());
1019           if (R.isInvalid())
1020             return NameClassification::Error();
1021           if (R.isUsable())
1022             return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar);
1023         }
1024 
1025         goto Corrected;
1026       }
1027     }
1028 
1029     // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it.
1030     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1031     return NameClassification::Unknown();
1032 
1033   case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: {
1034     // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were
1035     // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other
1036     // dependent nested-name-specifier.
1037 
1038     // C++ [temp.res]p2:
1039     //   A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is
1040     //   dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type
1041     //   unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is
1042     //   qualified by the keyword typename.
1043     //
1044     // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to
1045     // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a
1046     // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template'
1047     // keyword here.
1048     return NameClassification::DependentNonType();
1049   }
1050 
1051   case LookupResult::Found:
1052   case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
1053   case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
1054     break;
1055 
1056   case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
1057     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
1058         hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1059                                       /*AllowDependent=*/false)) {
1060       // C++ [temp.local]p3:
1061       //   A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an
1062       //   ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than
1063       //   one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found
1064       //   refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name
1065       //   is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the
1066       //   class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not
1067       //   ambiguous.
1068       //
1069       // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one,
1070       // so try again after filtering out template names.
1071       FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result);
1072       if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) {
1073         IsFilteredTemplateName = true;
1074         break;
1075       }
1076     }
1077 
1078     // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error.
1079     return NameClassification::Error();
1080   }
1081 
1082   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
1083       (IsFilteredTemplateName ||
1084        hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(
1085            Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1086            /*AllowDependent=*/false,
1087            /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() &&
1088                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) {
1089     // C++ [temp.names]p3:
1090     //   After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that
1091     //   an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of
1092     //   overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if
1093     //   this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a
1094     //   template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator.
1095     // C++2a [temp.names]p2:
1096     //   A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an
1097     //   unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one
1098     //   or more functions or finds nothing.
1099     if (!IsFilteredTemplateName)
1100       FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result);
1101 
1102     bool IsFunctionTemplate;
1103     bool IsVarTemplate;
1104     TemplateName Template;
1105     if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) {
1106       IsFunctionTemplate = true;
1107       Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(),
1108                                                    Result.end());
1109     } else if (!Result.empty()) {
1110       auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl(
1111           *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1112           /*AllowDependent=*/false));
1113       IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD);
1114       IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD);
1115 
1116       UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow =
1117           dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin());
1118       assert(!FoundUsingShadow ||
1119              TD == cast<TemplateDecl>(FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl()));
1120       Template =
1121           FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD);
1122       if (SS.isNotEmpty())
1123         Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(),
1124                                                     /*TemplateKeyword=*/false,
1125                                                     Template);
1126     } else {
1127       // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template
1128       // name.
1129       IsFunctionTemplate = true;
1130       Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
1131     }
1132 
1133     if (IsFunctionTemplate) {
1134       // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which
1135       // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need
1136       // to based on which function we selected.
1137       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1138 
1139       return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template);
1140     }
1141 
1142     return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template)
1143                          : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template);
1144   }
1145 
1146   auto BuildTypeFor = [&](TypeDecl *Type, NamedDecl *Found) {
1147     QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type);
1148     if (const auto *USD = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Found))
1149       T = Context.getUsingType(USD, T);
1150 
1151     if (SS.isEmpty()) // No elaborated type, trivial location info
1152       return ParsedType::make(T);
1153 
1154     TypeLocBuilder Builder;
1155     Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc);
1156     T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T);
1157     ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T);
1158     ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
1159     ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
1160     return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
1161   };
1162 
1163   NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl();
1164   if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) {
1165     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc);
1166     MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false);
1167     return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin());
1168   }
1169 
1170   ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl);
1171   if (!Class) {
1172     // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this.
1173     if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias =
1174             dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl))
1175       Class = Alias->getClassInterface();
1176   }
1177 
1178   if (Class) {
1179     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc);
1180 
1181     if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) {
1182       // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression.
1183       // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now.
1184       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1185       return NameClassification::Unknown();
1186     }
1187 
1188     QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class);
1189     return ParsedType::make(T);
1190   }
1191 
1192   if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl))
1193     return NameClassification::Concept(
1194         TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)));
1195 
1196   if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) {
1197     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc);
1198     return NameClassification::Error();
1199   }
1200 
1201   // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument.
1202   if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) &&
1203       !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))
1204     return NameClassification::TypeTemplate(
1205         TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)));
1206 
1207   // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it
1208   // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found.
1209   bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star);
1210   if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) ||
1211        (NextIsOp &&
1212         FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) &&
1213       isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) {
1214     TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>();
1215     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc);
1216     return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin());
1217   }
1218 
1219   // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate
1220   // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class
1221   // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know
1222   // the context.
1223   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren));
1224   if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember())
1225     return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl());
1226 
1227   // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later.
1228   Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1229   return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(
1230       Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
1231       Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(),
1232       Result.begin(), Result.end()));
1233 }
1234 
1235 ExprResult
1236 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name,
1237                                              SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1238   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?");
1239   CXXScopeSpec SS;
1240   LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1241   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true);
1242 }
1243 
1244 ExprResult
1245 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1246                                             IdentifierInfo *Name,
1247                                             SourceLocation NameLoc,
1248                                             bool IsAddressOfOperand) {
1249   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc);
1250   return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
1251                                     NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
1252                                     /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
1253 }
1254 
1255 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1256                                               NamedDecl *Found,
1257                                               SourceLocation NameLoc,
1258                                               const Token &NextToken) {
1259   if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty())
1260     if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()))
1261       return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar);
1262 
1263   // Reconstruct the lookup result.
1264   LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1265   Result.addDecl(Found);
1266   Result.resolveKind();
1267 
1268   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren));
1269   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL);
1270 }
1271 
1272 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) {
1273   // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member
1274   // access expression if necessary.
1275   auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E);
1276   if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
1277     CXXScopeSpec SS;
1278     SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
1279 
1280     // Reconstruct the lookup result.
1281     LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
1282                         LookupOrdinaryName);
1283     Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass());
1284     for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
1285       Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess());
1286     Result.resolveKind();
1287     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result,
1288                                            nullptr, S);
1289   }
1290 
1291   // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks
1292   // are necessary.
1293   return ULE;
1294 }
1295 
1296 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics
1297 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) {
1298   auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
1299   if (!TD)
1300     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate;
1301   if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD))
1302     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate;
1303   if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD))
1304     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate;
1305   if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD))
1306     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate;
1307   if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD))
1308     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate;
1309   if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD))
1310     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam;
1311   if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD))
1312     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept;
1313   return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate;
1314 }
1315 
1316 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1317   assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext &&
1318       "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
1319   CurContext = DC;
1320   S->setEntity(DC);
1321 }
1322 
1323 void Sema::PopDeclContext() {
1324   assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!");
1325 
1326   CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent();
1327   assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!");
1328 }
1329 
1330 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S,
1331                                                                     Decl *D) {
1332   // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily
1333   // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing
1334   // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one.
1335   auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext);
1336   CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition();
1337   assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag");
1338   // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look
1339   // into the pre-existing complete definition.
1340   S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent());
1341   return Result;
1342 }
1343 
1344 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) {
1345   CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context);
1346 }
1347 
1348 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context
1349 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier.
1350 ///
1351 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1352   // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13:
1353   //   A name used in the definition of a static data member of class
1354   //   X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as
1355   //   if the name was used in a member function of X.
1356   // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14:
1357   //   If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the
1358   //   scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of
1359   //   the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as
1360   //   if the definition of the variable member occurred in its
1361   //   namespace.
1362   // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context
1363   // is the semantic context of the declaration.  We can't use
1364   // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily
1365   // lexically contained in the current context.  Fortunately,
1366   // the containing scope should have the appropriate information.
1367 
1368   assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity");
1369 
1370 #ifndef NDEBUG
1371   Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent();
1372   while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent();
1373   assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch");
1374 #endif
1375 
1376   CurContext = DC;
1377   S->setEntity(DC);
1378 
1379   if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) {
1380     // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing
1381     // template parameter scopes.
1382     EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC);
1383   }
1384 }
1385 
1386 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) {
1387   assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!");
1388 
1389   // Switch back to the lexical context.  The safety of this is
1390   // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext.
1391   Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent();
1392   while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent();
1393   CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity();
1394 
1395   // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to
1396   // disappear.
1397 }
1398 
1399 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1400   assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() &&
1401          "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope");
1402 
1403   // C++20 [temp.local]p7:
1404   //   In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside
1405   //   of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class
1406   //   template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class
1407   //   templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a
1408   //   class or function template).
1409   // C++20 [temp.local]p9:
1410   //   In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member
1411   //   of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for
1412   //   each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class
1413   //   or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a
1414   //   template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the
1415   //   template-parameter name (6.4.10).
1416   //
1417   // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately
1418   // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter
1419   // scope. For example, for
1420   //   template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V>
1421   //     void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...)
1422   // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base
1423   // classes) then T then N then ::.
1424   unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S);
1425   for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) {
1426     DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC;
1427     for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
1428       if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL =
1429               cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) {
1430         unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1;
1431         if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth)
1432           continue;
1433         if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth)
1434           SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent();
1435         break;
1436       }
1437     }
1438     S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope);
1439   }
1440 }
1441 
1442 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) {
1443   // We assume that the caller has already called
1444   // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works.
1445   FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction();
1446   if (!FD)
1447     return;
1448 
1449   // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context
1450   // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class.
1451   assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() &&
1452     "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
1453   CurContext = FD;
1454   S->setEntity(CurContext);
1455 
1456   for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) {
1457     ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P);
1458     // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope
1459     if (Param->getIdentifier()) {
1460       S->AddDecl(Param);
1461       IdResolver.AddDecl(Param);
1462     }
1463   }
1464 }
1465 
1466 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() {
1467   // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent,
1468   // rather than the top-level class.
1469   assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!");
1470   CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent();
1471   assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!");
1472 }
1473 
1474 /// Determine whether overloading is allowed for a new function
1475 /// declaration considering prior declarations of the same name.
1476 ///
1477 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not
1478 /// whether a new declaration actually overloads a previous one.
1479 /// It will return true in C++ (where overloads are alway permitted)
1480 /// or, as a C extension, when either the new declaration or a
1481 /// previous one is declared with the 'overloadable' attribute.
1482 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(const LookupResult &Previous,
1483                                        ASTContext &Context,
1484                                        const FunctionDecl *New) {
1485   if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
1486     return true;
1487 
1488   // Multiversion function declarations are not overloads in the
1489   // usual sense of that term, but lookup will report that an
1490   // overload set was found if more than one multiversion function
1491   // declaration is present for the same name. It is therefore
1492   // inadequate to assume that some prior declaration(s) had
1493   // the overloadable attribute; checking is required. Since one
1494   // declaration is permitted to omit the attribute, it is necessary
1495   // to check at least two; hence the 'any_of' check below. Note that
1496   // the overloadable attribute is implicitly added to declarations
1497   // that were required to have it but did not.
1498   if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) {
1499     return llvm::any_of(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
1500       return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
1501     });
1502   } else if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found)
1503     return Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
1504 
1505   return false;
1506 }
1507 
1508 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains.
1509 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) {
1510   // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing
1511   // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this
1512   // scope.
1513   while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())
1514     S = S->getParent();
1515 
1516   // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be
1517   // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted
1518   // into any context.
1519   if (AddToContext)
1520     CurContext->addDecl(D);
1521 
1522   // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they
1523   // are function-local declarations.
1524   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent())
1525     return;
1526 
1527   // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope.
1528   if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
1529       cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
1530     return;
1531 
1532   // If this replaces anything in the current scope,
1533   IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()),
1534                                IEnd = IdResolver.end();
1535   for (; I != IEnd; ++I) {
1536     if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) {
1537       S->RemoveDecl(*I);
1538       IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I);
1539 
1540       // Should only need to replace one decl.
1541       break;
1542     }
1543   }
1544 
1545   S->AddDecl(D);
1546 
1547   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) {
1548     // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that
1549     // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert
1550     // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain.
1551     for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) {
1552       DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
1553       if (IDC == CurContext) {
1554         if (!S->isDeclScope(*I))
1555           continue;
1556       } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext))
1557         break;
1558     }
1559 
1560     IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D);
1561   } else {
1562     IdResolver.AddDecl(D);
1563   }
1564   warnOnReservedIdentifier(D);
1565 }
1566 
1567 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S,
1568                          bool AllowInlineNamespace) {
1569   return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace);
1570 }
1571 
1572 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1573   DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
1574   do {
1575     if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity())
1576       if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC)
1577         return S;
1578   } while ((S = S->getParent()));
1579 
1580   return nullptr;
1581 }
1582 
1583 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *,
1584                                             DeclContext*,
1585                                             ASTContext&);
1586 
1587 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope
1588 /// as determined by isDeclInScope.
1589 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S,
1590                                 bool ConsiderLinkage,
1591                                 bool AllowInlineNamespace) {
1592   LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter();
1593   while (F.hasNext()) {
1594     NamedDecl *D = F.next();
1595 
1596     if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace))
1597       continue;
1598 
1599     if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context))
1600       continue;
1601 
1602     F.erase();
1603   }
1604 
1605   F.done();
1606 }
1607 
1608 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they
1609 /// have compatible owning modules.
1610 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1611   // [module.interface]p7:
1612   // A declaration is attached to a module as follows:
1613   // - If the declaration is a non-dependent friend declaration that nominates a
1614   // function with a declarator-id that is a qualified-id or template-id or that
1615   // nominates a class other than with an elaborated-type-specifier with neither
1616   // a nested-name-specifier nor a simple-template-id, it is attached to the
1617   // module to which the friend is attached ([basic.link]).
1618   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() &&
1619       Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) {
1620     New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule());
1621     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New);
1622     return false;
1623   }
1624 
1625   Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule();
1626   Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule();
1627 
1628   if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment)
1629     NewM = NewM->Parent;
1630   if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment)
1631     OldM = OldM->Parent;
1632 
1633   // If we have a decl in a module partition, it is part of the containing
1634   // module (which is the only thing that can be importing it).
1635   if (NewM && OldM &&
1636       (OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionInterface ||
1637        OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionImplementation)) {
1638     return false;
1639   }
1640 
1641   if (NewM == OldM)
1642     return false;
1643 
1644   bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview();
1645   bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview();
1646   if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) {
1647     // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]:
1648     //   if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all
1649     //   other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module
1650     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module)
1651       << New
1652       << NewIsModuleInterface
1653       << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "")
1654       << OldIsModuleInterface
1655       << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : "");
1656     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1657     New->setInvalidDecl();
1658     return true;
1659   }
1660 
1661   return false;
1662 }
1663 
1664 // [module.interface]p6:
1665 // A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by
1666 // an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported.
1667 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1668   // [module.interface]p1:
1669   // An export-declaration shall inhabit a namespace scope.
1670   //
1671   // So it is meaningless to talk about redeclaration which is not at namespace
1672   // scope.
1673   if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext()
1674            ->getNonTransparentContext()
1675            ->isFileContext() ||
1676       !Old->getLexicalDeclContext()
1677            ->getNonTransparentContext()
1678            ->isFileContext())
1679     return false;
1680 
1681   bool IsNewExported = New->isInExportDeclContext();
1682   bool IsOldExported = Old->isInExportDeclContext();
1683 
1684   // It should be irrevelant if both of them are not exported.
1685   if (!IsNewExported && !IsOldExported)
1686     return false;
1687 
1688   if (IsOldExported)
1689     return false;
1690 
1691   assert(IsNewExported);
1692 
1693   auto Lk = Old->getFormalLinkage();
1694   int S = 0;
1695   if (Lk == Linkage::InternalLinkage)
1696     S = 1;
1697   else if (Lk == Linkage::ModuleLinkage)
1698     S = 2;
1699   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redeclaration_non_exported) << New << S;
1700   Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1701   return true;
1702 }
1703 
1704 // A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of
1705 // a redeclaration within a module.
1706 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1707   if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old))
1708     return true;
1709 
1710   if (CheckRedeclarationExported(New, Old))
1711     return true;
1712 
1713   return false;
1714 }
1715 
1716 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
1717   return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) ||
1718          isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) ||
1719          isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D);
1720 }
1721 
1722 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results.
1723 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) {
1724   LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter();
1725   while (F.hasNext())
1726     if (isUsingDecl(F.next()))
1727       F.erase();
1728 
1729   F.done();
1730 }
1731 
1732 /// Check for this common pattern:
1733 /// @code
1734 /// class S {
1735 ///   S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
1736 ///   void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
1737 /// };
1738 /// @endcode
1739 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) {
1740   // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get
1741   // the decl here.
1742   if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
1743     return false;
1744 
1745   if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D))
1746     return CD->isCopyConstructor();
1747   return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator();
1748 }
1749 
1750 // We need this to handle
1751 //
1752 // typedef struct {
1753 //   void *foo() { return 0; }
1754 // } A;
1755 //
1756 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A'
1757 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A',
1758 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end
1759 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage.
1760 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or
1761 // not.
1762 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) {
1763   const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext();
1764   while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) {
1765     if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){
1766       if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage())
1767         return true;
1768     }
1769     DC = DC->getParent();
1770   }
1771 
1772   return !D->isExternallyVisible();
1773 }
1774 
1775 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want
1776 // these semantics.
1777 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
1778   if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete)
1779     return false;
1780   return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc);
1781 }
1782 
1783 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const {
1784   assert(D);
1785 
1786   if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1787     return false;
1788 
1789   // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions
1790   // of members of class templates.
1791   if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() ||
1792       D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
1793     return false;
1794 
1795   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1796     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
1797       return false;
1798     // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly
1799     // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in.
1800     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
1801         FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine())
1802       return false;
1803 
1804     if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
1805       if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD))
1806         return false;
1807     } else {
1808       // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn.
1809       if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation()))
1810         return false;
1811     }
1812 
1813     if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() &&
1814         Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD))
1815       return false;
1816   } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1817     // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal
1818     // linkage; don't warn.  (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker
1819     // like "inline".)
1820     if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation()))
1821       return false;
1822 
1823     if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD))
1824       return false;
1825 
1826     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
1827         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
1828       return false;
1829     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
1830         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
1831         VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine())
1832       return false;
1833 
1834     if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation()))
1835       return false;
1836   } else {
1837     return false;
1838   }
1839 
1840   // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit.
1841   // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function
1842   // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance.
1843   return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D);
1844 }
1845 
1846 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) {
1847   if (!D)
1848     return;
1849 
1850   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1851     const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl();
1852     if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First))
1853       return; // First should already be in the vector.
1854   }
1855 
1856   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1857     const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
1858     if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First))
1859       return; // First should already be in the vector.
1860   }
1861 
1862   if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D))
1863     UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D);
1864 }
1865 
1866 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) {
1867   if (D->isInvalidDecl())
1868     return false;
1869 
1870   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) {
1871     // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are
1872     // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which
1873     // it is, by the bindings' expressions).
1874     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
1875       if (BD->isReferenced())
1876         return false;
1877   } else if (!D->getDeclName()) {
1878     return false;
1879   } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) {
1880     return false;
1881   }
1882 
1883   if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>())
1884     return false;
1885 
1886   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D))
1887     return true;
1888 
1889   // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to
1890   // functions.
1891   bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod();
1892   if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()))
1893     // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred.
1894     WithinFunction =
1895         WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType());
1896   if (!WithinFunction)
1897     return false;
1898 
1899   if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D))
1900     return true;
1901 
1902   // White-list anything that isn't a local variable.
1903   if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D))
1904     return false;
1905 
1906   // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed.
1907   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1908 
1909     const Expr *Init = VD->getInit();
1910     if (const auto *Cleanups = dyn_cast_or_null<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
1911       Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr();
1912 
1913     const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr();
1914 
1915     // Only look at the outermost level of typedef.
1916     if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
1917       // Allow anything marked with __attribute__((unused)).
1918       if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1919         return false;
1920     }
1921 
1922     // Warn for reference variables whose initializtion performs lifetime
1923     // extension.
1924     if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast_or_null<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init)) {
1925       if (MTE->getExtendingDecl()) {
1926         Ty = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType().getTypePtr();
1927         Init = MTE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicitAsWritten();
1928       }
1929     }
1930 
1931     // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is
1932     // dependent, don't diagnose the variable.
1933     if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType())
1934       return false;
1935 
1936     // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is
1937     // consistent for both scalars and arrays.
1938     Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1939 
1940     if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) {
1941       const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
1942       if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1943         return false;
1944 
1945       if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
1946         if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>())
1947           return false;
1948 
1949         if (Init) {
1950           const CXXConstructExpr *Construct =
1951             dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init);
1952           if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) {
1953             CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor();
1954             if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() &&
1955                 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
1956               return false;
1957           }
1958 
1959           // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and
1960           // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor.
1961           if (Init->isTypeDependent()) {
1962             for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors())
1963               if (!Ctor->isTrivial())
1964                 return false;
1965           }
1966 
1967           // Suppress the warning if the constructor is unresolved because
1968           // its arguments are dependent.
1969           if (isa<CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr>(Init))
1970             return false;
1971         }
1972       }
1973     }
1974 
1975     // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates?
1976   }
1977 
1978   return true;
1979 }
1980 
1981 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx,
1982                                      FixItHint &Hint) {
1983   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) {
1984     SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken(
1985         D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(),
1986         true);
1987     if (AfterColon.isInvalid())
1988       return;
1989     Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
1990         CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon));
1991   }
1992 }
1993 
1994 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) {
1995   if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType())
1996     return;
1997 
1998   for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) {
1999     if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD))
2000       DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T);
2001     else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD))
2002       DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R);
2003   }
2004 }
2005 
2006 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used
2007 /// unless they are marked attr(unused).
2008 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) {
2009   if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D))
2010     return;
2011 
2012   if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
2013     // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted
2014     // at end-of-translation-unit.
2015     UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD);
2016     return;
2017   }
2018 
2019   FixItHint Hint;
2020   GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint);
2021 
2022   unsigned DiagID;
2023   if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable())
2024     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param;
2025   else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D))
2026     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label;
2027   else
2028     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable;
2029 
2030   Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint;
2031 }
2032 
2033 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) {
2034   // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. If it has the Cleanup attribute,
2035   // it's not really unused.
2036   if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() ||
2037       VD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>())
2038     return;
2039 
2040   const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2041 
2042   if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType())
2043     return;
2044 
2045   if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) {
2046     const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
2047     if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
2048       return;
2049     // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to
2050     // mimic gcc's behavior.
2051     if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
2052       if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>())
2053         return;
2054     }
2055   }
2056 
2057   // Don't warn about __block Objective-C pointer variables, as they might
2058   // be assigned in the block but not used elsewhere for the purpose of lifetime
2059   // extension.
2060   if (VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2061     return;
2062 
2063   // Don't warn about Objective-C pointer variables with precise lifetime
2064   // semantics; they can be used to ensure ARC releases the object at a known
2065   // time, which may mean assignment but no other references.
2066   if (VD->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2067     return;
2068 
2069   auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD);
2070   if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end())
2071     return;
2072 
2073   assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 &&
2074          "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl");
2075   if (iter->getSecond() != 0)
2076     return;
2077   unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter
2078                                          : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable;
2079   Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD;
2080 }
2081 
2082 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) {
2083   // Verify that we have no forward references left.  If so, there was a goto
2084   // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.  Label fwd
2085   // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved
2086   // MS inline assembly label name.
2087   bool Diagnose = false;
2088   if (L->isMSAsmLabel())
2089     Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel();
2090   else
2091     Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr;
2092   if (Diagnose)
2093     S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L;
2094 }
2095 
2096 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) {
2097   S->mergeNRVOIntoParent();
2098 
2099   if (S->decl_empty()) return;
2100   assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) &&
2101          "Scope shouldn't contain decls!");
2102 
2103   for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) {
2104     assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??");
2105 
2106     assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?");
2107     NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD);
2108 
2109     // Diagnose unused variables in this scope.
2110     if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) {
2111       DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D);
2112       if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D))
2113         DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD);
2114       if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
2115         DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD);
2116         RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD);
2117       }
2118     }
2119 
2120     if (!D->getDeclName()) continue;
2121 
2122     // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined.
2123     if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D))
2124       CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this);
2125 
2126     // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't
2127     // already.
2128     IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D);
2129     auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D);
2130     if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) {
2131       if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) {
2132         Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field)
2133             << D << FD << FD->getParent();
2134         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2135       }
2136       ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI);
2137     }
2138   }
2139 }
2140 
2141 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit.
2142 ///
2143 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If
2144 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated
2145 /// to the fixed name.
2146 ///
2147 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit.
2148 ///
2149 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction
2150 /// if there is no class with the given name.
2151 ///
2152 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the
2153 /// class could not be found.
2154 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id,
2155                                               SourceLocation IdLoc,
2156                                               bool DoTypoCorrection) {
2157   // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in
2158   // creation from this context.
2159   NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
2160 
2161   if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) {
2162     // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we
2163     // find an Objective-C class name.
2164     DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{};
2165     if (TypoCorrection C =
2166             CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName,
2167                         TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
2168       diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id);
2169       IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>();
2170       Id = IDecl->getIdentifier();
2171     }
2172   }
2173   ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl);
2174   // This routine must always return a class definition, if any.
2175   if (Def && Def->getDefinition())
2176       Def = Def->getDefinition();
2177   return Def;
2178 }
2179 
2180 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting
2181 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes
2182 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and
2183 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but
2184 /// ill-formed in C++:
2185 /// @code
2186 /// struct S6 {
2187 ///   enum { BAR } e;
2188 /// };
2189 ///
2190 /// void test_S6() {
2191 ///   struct S6 a;
2192 ///   a.e = BAR;
2193 /// }
2194 /// @endcode
2195 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different
2196 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration
2197 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated
2198 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent
2199 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this
2200 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the
2201 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot
2202 /// contain non-field names.
2203 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) {
2204   while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) ||
2205          (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) ||
2206          (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus))
2207     S = S->getParent();
2208   return S;
2209 }
2210 
2211 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID,
2212                                ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) {
2213   switch (Error) {
2214   case ASTContext::GE_None:
2215     return "";
2216   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type:
2217     return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID);
2218   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio:
2219     return "stdio.h";
2220   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp:
2221     return "setjmp.h";
2222   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext:
2223     return "ucontext.h";
2224   }
2225   llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind");
2226 }
2227 
2228 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type,
2229                                   unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) {
2230   DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
2231 
2232   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2233     LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create(
2234         Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false);
2235     CLinkageDecl->setImplicit();
2236     Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl);
2237     Parent = CLinkageDecl;
2238   }
2239 
2240   FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type,
2241                                            /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern,
2242                                            getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
2243                                            false, Type->isFunctionProtoType());
2244   New->setImplicit();
2245   New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID));
2246 
2247   // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the
2248   // FunctionDecl.
2249   if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) {
2250     SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params;
2251     for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
2252       ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create(
2253           Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr,
2254           FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
2255       parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
2256       Params.push_back(parm);
2257     }
2258     New->setParams(Params);
2259   }
2260 
2261   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New);
2262   return New;
2263 }
2264 
2265 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at
2266 /// file scope.  lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true
2267 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the
2268 /// built-in.
2269 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID,
2270                                      Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration,
2271                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
2272   LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID);
2273 
2274   ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error;
2275   QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error);
2276   if (Error) {
2277     if (!ForRedeclaration)
2278       return nullptr;
2279 
2280     // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a
2281     // warning when we were not able to find a type for it.
2282     if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type ||
2283         Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID))
2284       return nullptr;
2285 
2286     // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was
2287     // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration.
2288     if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) {
2289       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf)
2290           << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2291       return nullptr;
2292     }
2293 
2294     // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the
2295     // appropriate header.
2296     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader)
2297         << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error)
2298         << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2299     return nullptr;
2300   }
2301 
2302   if (!ForRedeclaration &&
2303       (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) ||
2304        Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) {
2305     Diag(Loc, LangOpts.C99 ? diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl_c99
2306                            : diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl)
2307         << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R;
2308     if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID))
2309       Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare)
2310           << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2311   }
2312 
2313   if (R.isNull())
2314     return nullptr;
2315 
2316   FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc);
2317   RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S);
2318 
2319   // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into.
2320   // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to
2321   // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext
2322   // entirely, but we're not there yet.
2323   DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext;
2324   CurContext = New->getDeclContext();
2325   PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope);
2326   CurContext = SavedContext;
2327   return New;
2328 }
2329 
2330 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same
2331 /// entity if their types are the same.
2332 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's
2333 /// isSameEntity.
2334 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S,
2335                                                      TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2336                                                      LookupResult &Previous) {
2337   // This is only interesting when modules are enabled.
2338   if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
2339     return;
2340 
2341   // Empty sets are uninteresting.
2342   if (Previous.empty())
2343     return;
2344 
2345   LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter();
2346   while (Filter.hasNext()) {
2347     NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next();
2348 
2349     // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored.
2350     if (S.isVisible(Old))
2351       continue;
2352 
2353     // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have
2354     // different linkages.
2355     if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2356       if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(),
2357                                 Decl->getUnderlyingType()))
2358         continue;
2359 
2360       // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage
2361       // purposes, then they declare the same entity.
2362       if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) &&
2363           Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName())
2364         continue;
2365     }
2366 
2367     Filter.erase();
2368   }
2369 
2370   Filter.done();
2371 }
2372 
2373 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) {
2374   QualType OldType;
2375   if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old))
2376     OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType();
2377   else
2378     OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old);
2379   QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType();
2380 
2381   if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2382     // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type.
2383     int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0;
2384     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef)
2385       << Kind << NewType;
2386     if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
2387       notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2388     New->setInvalidDecl();
2389     return true;
2390   }
2391 
2392   if (OldType != NewType &&
2393       !OldType->isDependentType() &&
2394       !NewType->isDependentType() &&
2395       !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) {
2396     int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0;
2397     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef)
2398       << Kind << NewType << OldType;
2399     if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
2400       notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2401     New->setInvalidDecl();
2402     return true;
2403   }
2404   return false;
2405 }
2406 
2407 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the
2408 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out
2409 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting
2410 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid.
2411 ///
2412 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New,
2413                                 LookupResult &OldDecls) {
2414   // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any
2415   // merging checks.
2416   if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return;
2417 
2418   // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs.
2419   // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent!
2420   if (getLangOpts().ObjC) {
2421     const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier();
2422     switch (TypeID->getLength()) {
2423     default: break;
2424     case 2:
2425       {
2426         if (!TypeID->isStr("id"))
2427           break;
2428         QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType();
2429         if (!T->isPointerType())
2430           break;
2431         if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) {
2432           QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2433           if (!PT->isStructureType())
2434             break;
2435         }
2436         Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T);
2437         // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition.
2438         New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr());
2439         return;
2440       }
2441     case 5:
2442       if (!TypeID->isStr("Class"))
2443         break;
2444       Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType());
2445       // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition.
2446       New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr());
2447       return;
2448     case 3:
2449       if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL"))
2450         break;
2451       Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType());
2452       // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition.
2453       New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr());
2454       return;
2455     }
2456     // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type.
2457   }
2458 
2459   // Verify the old decl was also a type.
2460   TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>();
2461   if (!Old) {
2462     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
2463       << New->getDeclName();
2464 
2465     NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl();
2466     if (OldD->getLocation().isValid())
2467       notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation());
2468 
2469     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2470   }
2471 
2472   // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here.
2473   if (Old->isInvalidDecl())
2474     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2475 
2476   if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2477     auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true);
2478     auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName();
2479     NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr;
2480     if (OldTag && NewTag &&
2481         OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() &&
2482         !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) {
2483       // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it
2484       // instead of our tag.
2485       New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl());
2486       if (OldTD->isModed())
2487         New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
2488                                     OldTD->getUnderlyingType());
2489       else
2490         New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo());
2491 
2492       // Make the old tag definition visible.
2493       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden);
2494 
2495       // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators
2496       // out of the scope.
2497       if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) {
2498         Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
2499         for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) {
2500           auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
2501           assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED));
2502           EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED);
2503           IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED);
2504           ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED);
2505         }
2506       }
2507     }
2508   }
2509 
2510   // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and
2511   // with any extensions enabled.
2512   if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New))
2513     return;
2514 
2515   // The types match.  Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if
2516   // the old declaration was a typedef.
2517   if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2518     New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef);
2519     mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
2520   }
2521 
2522   if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
2523     return;
2524 
2525   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2526     // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2:
2527     //   In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to
2528     //   redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer
2529     //   to the type to which it already refers.
2530     if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))
2531       return;
2532 
2533     // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4:
2534     //   In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine
2535     //   any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name
2536     //   to refer to the type to which it already refers.
2537     //
2538     // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the
2539     // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like:
2540     //
2541     //   struct S {
2542     //     typedef struct A { } A;
2543     //   };
2544     //
2545     // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which
2546     // allow the above but disallow
2547     //
2548     //   struct S {
2549     //     typedef int I;
2550     //     typedef int I;
2551     //   };
2552     //
2553     // since that was the intent of DR56.
2554     if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old))
2555       return;
2556 
2557     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition)
2558       << New->getDeclName();
2559     notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2560     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2561   }
2562 
2563   // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11.
2564   if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11)
2565     return;
2566 
2567   // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning.  This warning
2568   // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with
2569   // -Wtypedef-redefinition.  If either the original or the redefinition is
2570   // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC.
2571   if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() &&
2572       // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL).
2573       (Old->isImplicit() ||
2574        Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) ||
2575        Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation())))
2576     return;
2577 
2578   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef)
2579     << New->getDeclName();
2580   notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2581 }
2582 
2583 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target
2584 /// attribute.
2585 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) {
2586   const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A);
2587   const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A);
2588   for (const auto *i : D->attrs())
2589     if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) {
2590       if (Ann) {
2591         if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation())
2592           return true;
2593         continue;
2594       }
2595       // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check
2596       if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i))
2597         return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind();
2598       return true;
2599     }
2600 
2601   return false;
2602 }
2603 
2604 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) {
2605   if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
2606     return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition();
2607   if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
2608     return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined();
2609   return true;
2610 }
2611 
2612 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the
2613 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute.
2614 ///
2615 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New.
2616 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) {
2617   // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute
2618   // specifies the strictest alignment requirement.
2619   AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr;
2620   AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr;
2621   unsigned OldAlign = 0;
2622   for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) {
2623     // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments
2624     // in a case like:
2625     //   template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X;
2626     //   template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {};
2627     // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the
2628     // definition in such a case.
2629     if (I->isAlignmentDependent())
2630       return false;
2631 
2632     if (I->isAlignas())
2633       OldAlignasAttr = I;
2634 
2635     unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context);
2636     if (Align > OldAlign) {
2637       OldAlign = Align;
2638       OldStrictestAlignAttr = I;
2639     }
2640   }
2641 
2642   // Look for alignas attributes on New.
2643   AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr;
2644   unsigned NewAlign = 0;
2645   for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) {
2646     if (I->isAlignmentDependent())
2647       return false;
2648 
2649     if (I->isAlignas())
2650       NewAlignasAttr = I;
2651 
2652     unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context);
2653     if (Align > NewAlign)
2654       NewAlign = Align;
2655   }
2656 
2657   if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) {
2658     // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match.
2659     // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but
2660     // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match
2661     // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.)
2662 
2663     // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it
2664     // specifies the natural alignment for the type.
2665     if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) {
2666       QualType Ty;
2667       if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New))
2668         Ty = VD->getType();
2669       else
2670         Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New));
2671 
2672       if (OldAlign == 0)
2673         OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
2674       if (NewAlign == 0)
2675         NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
2676     }
2677 
2678     if (OldAlign != NewAlign) {
2679       S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch)
2680         << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity()
2681         << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity();
2682       S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2683     }
2684   }
2685 
2686   if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) {
2687     // C++11 [dcl.align]p6:
2688     //   if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier,
2689     //   every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an
2690     //   equivalent alignment.
2691     // C11 6.7.5/7:
2692     //   If the definition of an object does not have an alignment
2693     //   specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also
2694     //   have no alignment specifier.
2695     S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition)
2696       << OldAlignasAttr;
2697     S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration)
2698       << OldAlignasAttr;
2699   }
2700 
2701   bool AnyAdded = false;
2702 
2703   // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment.
2704   if (OldAlign > NewAlign) {
2705     AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context);
2706     Clone->setInherited(true);
2707     New->addAttr(Clone);
2708     AnyAdded = true;
2709   }
2710 
2711   // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one.
2712   if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr &&
2713       !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) {
2714     AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context);
2715     Clone->setInherited(true);
2716     New->addAttr(Clone);
2717     AnyAdded = true;
2718   }
2719 
2720   return AnyAdded;
2721 }
2722 
2723 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC
2724 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc"
2725 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC
2726 
2727 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D,
2728                                const InheritableAttr *Attr,
2729                                Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) {
2730   // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add
2731   // and attributes that already exist on the declaration.
2732   if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr))
2733     return false;
2734 
2735   // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the
2736   // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute
2737   // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates.
2738   // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from
2739   // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from
2740   // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent
2741   // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here.
2742   InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr;
2743   if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr))
2744     NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr(
2745         D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(),
2746         AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(),
2747         AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK,
2748         AA->getPriority());
2749   else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr))
2750     NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility());
2751   else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr))
2752     NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility());
2753   else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr))
2754     NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA);
2755   else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr))
2756     NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA);
2757   else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr))
2758     NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic());
2759   else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr))
2760     NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(),
2761                                 FA->getFirstArg());
2762   else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr))
2763     NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName());
2764   else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr))
2765     NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName());
2766   else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr))
2767     NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(),
2768                                        IA->getInheritanceModel());
2769   else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr))
2770     NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA,
2771                                       &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling()));
2772   else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
2773            (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) ||
2774             isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) {
2775     // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for
2776     // overloading purposes and must not be merged.
2777     return false;
2778   } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr))
2779     NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA);
2780   else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr))
2781     NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName());
2782   else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr))
2783     NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA);
2784   else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr))
2785     NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA);
2786   else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr))
2787     // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all
2788     // such attributes on a declaration at the same time.
2789     NewAttr = nullptr;
2790   else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) &&
2791            (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override ||
2792             AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation ||
2793             AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation))
2794     NewAttr = nullptr;
2795   else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr))
2796     NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl());
2797   else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr))
2798     NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA);
2799   else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr))
2800     NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA);
2801   else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr))
2802     NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA);
2803   else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr))
2804     NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA);
2805   else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFDeclTagAttr>(Attr))
2806     NewAttr = S.mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(D, *BTFA);
2807   else if (const auto *NT = dyn_cast<HLSLNumThreadsAttr>(Attr))
2808     NewAttr =
2809         S.mergeHLSLNumThreadsAttr(D, *NT, NT->getX(), NT->getY(), NT->getZ());
2810   else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<HLSLShaderAttr>(Attr))
2811     NewAttr = S.mergeHLSLShaderAttr(D, *SA, SA->getType());
2812   else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr))
2813     NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context));
2814 
2815   if (NewAttr) {
2816     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
2817     D->addAttr(NewAttr);
2818     if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr))
2819       S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D));
2820     return true;
2821   }
2822 
2823   return false;
2824 }
2825 
2826 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) {
2827   if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
2828     return TD->getDefinition();
2829   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
2830     const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition();
2831     if (Def)
2832       return Def;
2833     return VD->getActingDefinition();
2834   }
2835   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2836     const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
2837     if (FD->isDefined(Def, true))
2838       return Def;
2839   }
2840   return nullptr;
2841 }
2842 
2843 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) {
2844   for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs())
2845     if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind)
2846       return true;
2847   return false;
2848 }
2849 
2850 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that
2851 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration.
2852 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) {
2853   if (!New->hasAttrs())
2854     return;
2855 
2856   const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old);
2857   if (!Def || Def == New)
2858     return;
2859 
2860   AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs();
2861   for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) {
2862     const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I];
2863 
2864     if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2865       if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) {
2866         Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody;
2867         S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody);
2868 
2869         // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute.
2870         if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) {
2871           NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2872           --E;
2873           continue;
2874         }
2875       } else {
2876         VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New);
2877         unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() ==
2878                                 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition
2879                             ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative
2880                             : diag::err_redefinition;
2881         S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName();
2882         if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition)
2883           S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation());
2884         else
2885           S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2886         VD->setInvalidDecl();
2887       }
2888       ++I;
2889       continue;
2890     }
2891 
2892     if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) {
2893       // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above.
2894       if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) {
2895         ++I;
2896         continue;
2897       }
2898     }
2899 
2900     if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) {
2901       ++I;
2902       continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this.
2903     }
2904 
2905     if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2906       // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined.
2907       ++I;
2908       continue;
2909     } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2910       // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class
2911       ++I;
2912       continue;
2913     } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2914       if (AA->isAlignas()) {
2915         // C++11 [dcl.align]p6:
2916         //   if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier,
2917         //   every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an
2918         //   equivalent alignment.
2919         // C11 6.7.5/7:
2920         //   If the definition of an object does not have an alignment
2921         //   specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also
2922         //   have no alignment specifier.
2923         S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition)
2924           << AA;
2925         S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration)
2926           << AA;
2927         NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2928         --E;
2929         continue;
2930       }
2931     } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2932       // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this
2933       // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the
2934       // standard diagnostics.
2935       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2936         S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(),
2937                diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration);
2938         S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2939         NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2940         --E;
2941         continue;
2942       }
2943     } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) &&
2944                cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() &&
2945                !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) {
2946       // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables.
2947       // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany
2948       // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we
2949       // honored it.
2950       ++I;
2951       continue;
2952     } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2953       // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to
2954       // declarations after defintions.
2955       ++I;
2956       continue;
2957     }
2958 
2959     S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(),
2960            diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition);
2961     S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2962     NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2963     --E;
2964   }
2965 }
2966 
2967 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl,
2968                                      const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr,
2969                                      bool AttrBeforeInit) {
2970   SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart();
2971 
2972   // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration.
2973   // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve
2974   // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without
2975   // heroics.
2976   std::string SuitableSpelling;
2977   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
2978     SuitableSpelling = std::string(
2979         S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit}));
2980   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
2981     SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(
2982         InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square,
2983                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon,
2984                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"),
2985                     tok::r_square, tok::r_square}));
2986   if (SuitableSpelling.empty())
2987     SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(
2988         InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren,
2989                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"),
2990                     tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren}));
2991   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
2992     SuitableSpelling = "constinit";
2993   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
2994     SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]";
2995   if (SuitableSpelling.empty())
2996     SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))";
2997   SuitableSpelling += " ";
2998 
2999   if (AttrBeforeInit) {
3000     // extern constinit int a;
3001     // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension
3002     assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute");
3003     S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing)
3004         << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling);
3005     S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here);
3006   } else {
3007     // int a = 0;
3008     // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit')
3009     S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(),
3010            CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late
3011                                  : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late)
3012         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation()));
3013     S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here)
3014         << CIAttr->isConstinit()
3015         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling);
3016   }
3017 }
3018 
3019 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one.
3020 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old,
3021                                AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) {
3022   if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) {
3023     UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context);
3024     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
3025     New->addAttr(NewAttr);
3026   }
3027   if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) {
3028     RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context);
3029     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
3030     New->addAttr(NewAttr);
3031   }
3032 
3033   if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs())
3034     return;
3035 
3036   // [dcl.constinit]p1:
3037   //   If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a
3038   //   variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration.
3039   const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
3040   const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
3041   if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) {
3042     const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old);
3043     auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New);
3044 
3045     // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked
3046     // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet.
3047     const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration();
3048     if (!InitDecl &&
3049         (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()))
3050       InitDecl = NewVD;
3051 
3052     if (InitDecl == NewVD) {
3053       // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit',
3054       // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute
3055       // form).
3056       if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit())
3057         diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit,
3058                                  /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true);
3059     } else if (NewConstInit) {
3060       // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should
3061       // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing
3062       // declaration, this is too late.
3063       if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) {
3064         diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit,
3065                                  /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false);
3066         NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
3067       }
3068     }
3069   }
3070 
3071   // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored.
3072   checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old);
3073 
3074   if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) {
3075     if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) {
3076       if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) {
3077         // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label.
3078         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label);
3079         Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3080       }
3081     } else if (Old->isUsed()) {
3082       // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has
3083       // already been ODR-used.
3084       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name)
3085         << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange();
3086     }
3087   }
3088 
3089   // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's.
3090   if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) {
3091     if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) {
3092       for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) {
3093         if (!llvm::is_contained(OldAbiTagAttr->tags(), NewTag)) {
3094           Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(),
3095                diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration)
3096               << NewTag;
3097           Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3098         }
3099       }
3100     } else {
3101       Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration);
3102       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3103     }
3104   }
3105 
3106   // This redeclaration adds a section attribute.
3107   if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
3108     if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) {
3109       if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) {
3110         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration);
3111         Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3112       }
3113     }
3114   }
3115 
3116   // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute.
3117   const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>();
3118   if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() &&
3119       !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) {
3120     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section)
3121          << 0 /*codeseg*/;
3122     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3123   }
3124 
3125   if (!Old->hasAttrs())
3126     return;
3127 
3128   bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs();
3129 
3130   // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before
3131   // we process them.
3132   if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec());
3133 
3134   for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) {
3135     // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested.
3136     AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None;
3137     if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) ||
3138         isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) ||
3139         isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) {
3140       switch (AMK) {
3141       case AMK_None:
3142         continue;
3143 
3144       case AMK_Redeclaration:
3145       case AMK_Override:
3146       case AMK_ProtocolImplementation:
3147       case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation:
3148         LocalAMK = AMK;
3149         break;
3150       }
3151     }
3152 
3153     // Already handled.
3154     if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I))
3155       continue;
3156 
3157     if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK))
3158       foundAny = true;
3159   }
3160 
3161   if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old))
3162     foundAny = true;
3163 
3164   if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs();
3165 }
3166 
3167 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter
3168 /// to the new one.
3169 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl,
3170                                      const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl,
3171                                      Sema &S) {
3172   // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2:
3173   //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the
3174   //   carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration
3175   //   of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute.
3176   const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>();
3177   if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) {
3178     S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(),
3179            diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/;
3180     // Find the first declaration of the parameter.
3181     // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters?
3182     const FunctionDecl *FirstFD =
3183       cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl();
3184     const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD =
3185       FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex());
3186     S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(),
3187            diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/;
3188   }
3189 
3190   if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs())
3191     return;
3192 
3193   bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs();
3194 
3195   // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is
3196   // done before we process them.
3197   if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec());
3198 
3199   for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) {
3200     if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) {
3201       InheritableAttr *newAttr =
3202         cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context));
3203       newAttr->setInherited(true);
3204       newDecl->addAttr(newAttr);
3205       foundAny = true;
3206     }
3207   }
3208 
3209   if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs();
3210 }
3211 
3212 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam,
3213                                 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam,
3214                                 Sema &S) {
3215   if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) {
3216     if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) {
3217       if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) {
3218         S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr)
3219           << DiagNullabilityKind(
3220                *Newnullability,
3221                ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability)
3222                 != 0))
3223           << DiagNullabilityKind(
3224                *Oldnullability,
3225                ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability)
3226                 != 0));
3227         S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3228       }
3229     } else {
3230       QualType NewT = NewParam->getType();
3231       NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType(
3232                          AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability),
3233                          NewT, NewT);
3234       NewParam->setType(NewT);
3235     }
3236   }
3237 }
3238 
3239 namespace {
3240 
3241 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in
3242 /// C.
3243 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning {
3244   ParmVarDecl *OldParm;
3245   ParmVarDecl *NewParm;
3246   QualType PromotedType;
3247 };
3248 
3249 } // end anonymous namespace
3250 
3251 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit
3252 // declaration, or a declaration.
3253 template <typename T>
3254 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation>
3255 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) {
3256   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3257   SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation();
3258   if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
3259     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition;
3260   else if (Old->isImplicit()) {
3261     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration;
3262     if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Old)) {
3263       if (FD->getBuiltinID())
3264         PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration;
3265     }
3266     if (OldLocation.isInvalid())
3267       OldLocation = New->getLocation();
3268   } else
3269     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration;
3270   return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation);
3271 }
3272 
3273 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently,
3274 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in
3275 /// GNU89 mode.
3276 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
3277                                 const LangOptions& LangOpts) {
3278   return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) &&
3279           !LangOpts.CPlusPlus &&
3280           FD->isInlineSpecified() &&
3281           FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern);
3282 }
3283 
3284 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const {
3285   const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>();
3286   while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv())
3287     AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>();
3288   return AT;
3289 }
3290 
3291 template <typename T>
3292 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) {
3293   const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext();
3294   if (DC->isRecord())
3295     return false;
3296 
3297   LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage();
3298   if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext())
3299     return true;
3300   if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext())
3301     return true;
3302   return false;
3303 }
3304 
3305 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); }
3306 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; }
3307 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; }
3308 
3309 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a
3310 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload
3311 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration).
3312 template<typename ExpectedDecl>
3313 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS,
3314                                    ExpectedDecl *New) {
3315   // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4:
3316   //   Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of
3317   //   which specifies the same unqualified name,
3318   //   -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions
3319   //      and function templates; or
3320   //   -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration
3321   //      name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all
3322   //      refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions
3323   //      and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration
3324   //      name is hidden (3.3.10).
3325 
3326   // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14:
3327   //   If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the
3328   //   same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced
3329   //   by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same
3330   //   function, the program is ill-formed.
3331 
3332   auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl());
3333   if (Old &&
3334       !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
3335           New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) &&
3336       !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New)))
3337     Old = nullptr;
3338 
3339   if (!Old) {
3340     S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse);
3341     S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target);
3342     S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0;
3343     return true;
3344   }
3345   return false;
3346 }
3347 
3348 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A,
3349                                             const FunctionDecl *B) {
3350   assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams());
3351 
3352   auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) {
3353     const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
3354     const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
3355     if (AttrA == AttrB)
3356       return true;
3357     return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() &&
3358            AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic();
3359   };
3360 
3361   return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq);
3362 }
3363 
3364 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified
3365 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier.
3366 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD,
3367                                                DeclaratorDecl *OldD) {
3368   // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when
3369   // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration
3370   // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier:
3371   //
3372   //   inline namespace N { int f(); }
3373   //   int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::.
3374   //
3375   // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change
3376   // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations,
3377   // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular).
3378   if (!NewD->getQualifier())
3379     return;
3380 
3381   // NewD is probably already in the right context.
3382   auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
3383   auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
3384   if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC))
3385     return;
3386 
3387   assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) ||
3388           NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) &&
3389          "unexpected context for redeclaration");
3390 
3391   auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext();
3392   auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) {
3393     if (!D)
3394       return;
3395     D->setDeclContext(SemaDC);
3396     D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC);
3397   };
3398 
3399   FixSemaDC(NewD);
3400   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD))
3401     FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate());
3402   else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD))
3403     FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate());
3404 }
3405 
3406 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from
3407 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous
3408 /// declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to resolve this situation,
3409 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
3410 ///
3411 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not
3412 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are
3413 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be
3414 /// merged with.
3415 ///
3416 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
3417 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, Scope *S,
3418                              bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn) {
3419   // Verify the old decl was also a function.
3420   FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction();
3421   if (!Old) {
3422     if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
3423       if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) {
3424         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend);
3425         Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(),
3426              diag::note_using_decl_target);
3427         Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl)
3428             << 0;
3429         return true;
3430       }
3431 
3432       // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or
3433       // function template.
3434       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate =
3435               New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
3436         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow,
3437                                                          NewTemplate))
3438           return true;
3439         OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl())
3440                          ->getAsFunction();
3441       } else {
3442         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New))
3443           return true;
3444         OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl());
3445       }
3446     } else {
3447       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
3448         << New->getDeclName();
3449       notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation());
3450       return true;
3451     }
3452   }
3453 
3454   // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new
3455   // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match.
3456   adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old);
3457 
3458   // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here.
3459   if (Old->isInvalidDecl())
3460     return true;
3461 
3462   // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins.
3463   if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) {
3464     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName();
3465     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration)
3466         << Old << Old->getType();
3467     return true;
3468   }
3469 
3470   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3471   SourceLocation OldLocation;
3472   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) =
3473       getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
3474 
3475   // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function
3476   // is an extern inline function.
3477   // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have
3478   // storage classes.
3479   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) &&
3480       New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static &&
3481       Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() &&
3482       !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() &&
3483       !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) {
3484     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
3485       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New;
3486       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3487     } else {
3488       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New;
3489       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3490       return true;
3491     }
3492   }
3493 
3494   if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>())
3495     if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) {
3496       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
3497           << ILA;
3498       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3499       New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>();
3500     }
3501 
3502   if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) {
3503     if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) {
3504       Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA;
3505       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3506       New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>();
3507     }
3508   }
3509 
3510   if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old))
3511     return true;
3512 
3513   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3514     bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3515     if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) {
3516       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch)
3517         << New << OldOvl;
3518 
3519       // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable
3520       // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one
3521       // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter.
3522       //
3523       // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in
3524       // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it.
3525       const Decl *DiagOld = Old;
3526       if (OldOvl) {
3527         auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) {
3528           const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3529           return A && !A->isImplicit();
3530         });
3531         // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this
3532         // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless.
3533         DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter;
3534       }
3535 
3536       if (DiagOld)
3537         Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(),
3538              diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload)
3539           << OldOvl;
3540 
3541       if (OldOvl)
3542         New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
3543       else
3544         New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3545     }
3546   }
3547 
3548   // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later
3549   // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling
3550   // convention of the first.
3551   //
3552   // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention,
3553   // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention.
3554   //
3555   // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for
3556   // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written.  If they are missing or
3557   // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit.
3558   //
3559   // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have
3560   // other tests to run.
3561   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
3562   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3563   const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType);
3564   const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType);
3565   FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo();
3566   FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo();
3567   bool RequiresAdjustment = false;
3568 
3569   if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) {
3570     FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl();
3571     const FunctionType *FT =
3572         First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3573     FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo();
3574     bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType());
3575     if (!NewCCExplicit) {
3576       // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified
3577       // there but not here.
3578       NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC());
3579       RequiresAdjustment = true;
3580     } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) {
3581       // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point,
3582       // so we check if the old one is a builtin.
3583 
3584       // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a
3585       // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is
3586       // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration.
3587       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported)
3588           << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC())
3589           << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction;
3590       NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC());
3591       RequiresAdjustment = true;
3592     } else {
3593       // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain.
3594       bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType());
3595       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change)
3596         << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC())
3597         << !FirstCCExplicit
3598         << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" :
3599             FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC()));
3600 
3601       // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters.
3602       Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3603       return true;
3604     }
3605   }
3606 
3607   // FIXME: diagnose the other way around?
3608   if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) {
3609     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true);
3610     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3611   }
3612 
3613   // Merge regparm attribute.
3614   if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() ||
3615       OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) {
3616     if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) {
3617       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch)
3618         << NewType->getRegParmType()
3619         << OldType->getRegParmType();
3620       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3621       return true;
3622     }
3623 
3624     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm());
3625     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3626   }
3627 
3628   // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute.
3629   if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) {
3630     if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) {
3631       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch)
3632           << "'ns_returns_retained'";
3633       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3634       return true;
3635     }
3636 
3637     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true);
3638     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3639   }
3640 
3641   if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() !=
3642       NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) {
3643     if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) {
3644       AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr =
3645         New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>();
3646       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr;
3647       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3648       return true;
3649     }
3650 
3651     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true);
3652     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3653   }
3654 
3655   if (RequiresAdjustment) {
3656     const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3657     AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo);
3658     New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0));
3659     NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3660   }
3661 
3662   // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to
3663   // UndefinedButUsed.
3664   if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() &&
3665       !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() &&
3666       !getLangOpts().GNUInline &&
3667       Old->isUsed(false) &&
3668       !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
3669     UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(),
3670                                            SourceLocation()));
3671 
3672   // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn
3673   // about it.
3674   if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() &&
3675       Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
3676     UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl());
3677   }
3678 
3679   // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid
3680   // redeclaration.
3681   if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() &&
3682       !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) {
3683     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params)
3684         << New->getDeclName();
3685     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3686     return true;
3687   }
3688 
3689   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3690     // C++1z [over.load]p2
3691     //   Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded:
3692     //     -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type,
3693     //        the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded.
3694 
3695     // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of
3696     // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the
3697     // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before
3698     // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType
3699     // but do not necessarily update the type of New.
3700     if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New))
3701       return true;
3702     OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
3703     NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3704 
3705     // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types,
3706     // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13:
3707     //   Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template
3708     //   with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also
3709     //   use that placeholder, not a deduced type.
3710     QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType();
3711     QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType();
3712     if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) &&
3713         canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType,
3714                                        OldDeclaredReturnType)) {
3715       QualType ResQT;
3716       if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
3717           OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3718         // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type.
3719         ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType);
3720       if (ResQT.isNull()) {
3721         if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine())
3722           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type)
3723               << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3724         else
3725           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type)
3726               << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3727         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType()
3728                                     << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3729         return true;
3730       }
3731       else
3732         NewQType = ResQT;
3733     }
3734 
3735     QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType();
3736     QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType();
3737     if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) {
3738       // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been
3739       // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration.
3740       AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType();
3741       if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) {
3742         QualType DT = OldAT->getDeducedType();
3743         if (DT.isNull()) {
3744           New->setType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(New->getType()));
3745           NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(NewQType));
3746         } else {
3747           New->setType(SubstAutoType(New->getType(), DT));
3748           NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoType(NewQType, DT));
3749         }
3750       }
3751     }
3752 
3753     const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
3754     CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
3755     if (OldMethod && NewMethod) {
3756       // Preserve triviality.
3757       NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial());
3758 
3759       // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope:
3760       // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected.
3761       // We don't want a redeclaration error.
3762       bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization =
3763                               OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() &&
3764                               NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
3765       bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind();
3766 
3767       if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
3768           !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
3769         //    -- Member function declarations with the same name and the
3770         //       same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them
3771         //       is a static member function declaration.
3772         if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) {
3773           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member);
3774           Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3775           return true;
3776         }
3777 
3778         // C++ [class.mem]p1:
3779         //   [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the
3780         //   member-specification, except that a nested class or member
3781         //   class template can be declared and then later defined.
3782         if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) {
3783           unsigned NewDiag;
3784           if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod))
3785             NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared;
3786           else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod))
3787             NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared;
3788           else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod))
3789             NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared;
3790           else
3791             NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared;
3792 
3793           Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag);
3794         } else {
3795           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation)
3796             << New << New->getType();
3797         }
3798         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3799         return true;
3800 
3801       // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special
3802       // member that was initially declared implicitly.
3803       //
3804       // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order
3805       // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls.
3806       } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) {
3807         if (isFriend) {
3808           NewMethod->setImplicit();
3809         } else {
3810           Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(),
3811                diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member)
3812             << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod);
3813           return true;
3814         }
3815       } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) {
3816         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(),
3817              diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member)
3818           << getSpecialMember(OldMethod);
3819         return true;
3820       }
3821     }
3822 
3823     // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1:
3824     //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn
3825     //   attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn
3826     //   attribute.
3827     if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>())
3828       if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) {
3829         Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
3830             << NRA;
3831         Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3832       }
3833 
3834     // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2:
3835     //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the
3836     //   carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration
3837     //   of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute.
3838     const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>();
3839     if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) {
3840       Diag(CDA->getLocation(),
3841            diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/;
3842       Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(),
3843            diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/;
3844     }
3845 
3846     // (C++98 8.3.5p3):
3847     //   All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the
3848     //   return type and the parameter-type-list.
3849     // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn.
3850 
3851     // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it.
3852     QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType;
3853     if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) {
3854       auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3855       const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison
3856         = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true));
3857       OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0);
3858       assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical());
3859     }
3860 
3861     if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) {
3862       // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous
3863       // declarations of a friend function as an extension.
3864       //
3865       // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC
3866       // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language
3867       // linkage within class scope.
3868       //
3869       // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete.
3870       if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) {
3871         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New;
3872         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3873       } else {
3874         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New;
3875         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3876         return true;
3877       }
3878     }
3879 
3880     // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the
3881     // exception specifier because it was already checked above in
3882     // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics
3883     // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility.
3884     if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison,
3885                                                          NewQType))
3886       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
3887 
3888     // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or
3889     // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again
3890     // during instantiation.
3891     if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType))
3892       return false;
3893 
3894     // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions.
3895   }
3896 
3897   // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles
3898   // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly.
3899   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3900     // C99 6.7.5.3p15: ...If one type has a parameter type list and the other
3901     // type is specified by a function definition that contains a (possibly
3902     // empty) identifier list, both shall agree in the number of parameters
3903     // and the type of each parameter shall be compatible with the type that
3904     // results from the application of default argument promotions to the
3905     // type of the corresponding identifier. ...
3906     // This cannot be handled by ASTContext::typesAreCompatible() because that
3907     // doesn't know whether the function type is for a definition or not when
3908     // eventually calling ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(). The only situation
3909     // we need to cover here is that the number of arguments agree as the
3910     // default argument promotion rules were already checked by
3911     // ASTContext::typesAreCompatible().
3912     if (Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasWrittenPrototype() && NewDeclIsDefn &&
3913         Old->getNumParams() != New->getNumParams()) {
3914       if (Old->hasInheritedPrototype())
3915         Old = Old->getCanonicalDecl();
3916       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New;
3917       Diag(Old->getLocation(), PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3918       return true;
3919     }
3920 
3921     // If we are merging two functions where only one of them has a prototype,
3922     // we may have enough information to decide to issue a diagnostic that the
3923     // function without a protoype will change behavior in C2x. This handles
3924     // cases like:
3925     //   void i(); void i(int j);
3926     //   void i(int j); void i();
3927     //   void i(); void i(int j) {}
3928     // See ActOnFinishFunctionBody() for other cases of the behavior change
3929     // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function
3930     // type without a prototype.
3931     if (New->hasWrittenPrototype() != Old->hasWrittenPrototype() &&
3932         !New->isImplicit() && !Old->isImplicit()) {
3933       const FunctionDecl *WithProto, *WithoutProto;
3934       if (New->hasWrittenPrototype()) {
3935         WithProto = New;
3936         WithoutProto = Old;
3937       } else {
3938         WithProto = Old;
3939         WithoutProto = New;
3940       }
3941 
3942       if (WithProto->getNumParams() != 0) {
3943         if (WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithoutProto->isImplicit()) {
3944           // The one without the prototype will be changing behavior in C2x, so
3945           // warn about that one so long as it's a user-visible declaration.
3946           bool IsWithoutProtoADef = false, IsWithProtoADef = false;
3947           if (WithoutProto == New)
3948             IsWithoutProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn;
3949           else
3950             IsWithProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn;
3951           Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(),
3952                diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior)
3953               << IsWithoutProtoADef << (WithoutProto->getNumParams() ? 0 : 1)
3954               << (WithoutProto == Old) << IsWithProtoADef;
3955 
3956           // The reason the one without the prototype will be changing behavior
3957           // is because of the one with the prototype, so note that so long as
3958           // it's a user-visible declaration. There is one exception to this:
3959           // when the new declaration is a definition without a prototype, the
3960           // old declaration with a prototype is not the cause of the issue,
3961           // and that does not need to be noted because the one with a
3962           // prototype will not change behavior in C2x.
3963           if (WithProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithProto->isImplicit() &&
3964               !IsWithoutProtoADef)
3965             Diag(WithProto->getLocation(), diag::note_conflicting_prototype);
3966         }
3967       }
3968     }
3969 
3970     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) {
3971       const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3972       const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3973       const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr;
3974       if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) &&
3975           (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) {
3976         // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the
3977         // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype.
3978         assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C");
3979         SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types());
3980         NewQType =
3981             Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes,
3982                                     OldProto->getExtProtoInfo());
3983         New->setType(NewQType);
3984         New->setHasInheritedPrototype();
3985 
3986         // Synthesize parameters with the same types.
3987         SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params;
3988         for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) {
3989           ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(
3990               Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr,
3991               ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
3992           Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
3993           Param->setImplicit();
3994           Params.push_back(Param);
3995         }
3996 
3997         New->setParams(Params);
3998       }
3999 
4000       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
4001     }
4002   }
4003 
4004   // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address
4005   // spaces are ignored.
4006   if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType))
4007     return false;
4008 
4009   // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration
4010   // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition
4011   // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the
4012   // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ
4013   // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from
4014   // the prototype.
4015   //
4016   // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition,
4017   // the K&R definition becomes variadic.  This is sort of an edge case, but
4018   // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and
4019   // C99 6.9.1p8.
4020   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
4021       Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() &&
4022       New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() &&
4023       Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) {
4024     SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes;
4025     SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings;
4026     const FunctionProtoType *OldProto
4027       = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4028     const FunctionProtoType *NewProto
4029       = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4030 
4031     // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension.
4032     QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(),
4033                                                NewProto->getReturnType());
4034     bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull();
4035     for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams();
4036          LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) {
4037       ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx);
4038       ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx);
4039       if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(),
4040                                      NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) {
4041         ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType());
4042       } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(),
4043                                             NewParm->getType(),
4044                                             /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) {
4045         GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm,
4046                                            NewProto->getParamType(Idx) };
4047         Warnings.push_back(Warn);
4048         ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType());
4049       } else
4050         LooseCompatible = false;
4051     }
4052 
4053     if (LooseCompatible) {
4054       for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) {
4055         Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(),
4056              diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype)
4057           << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType
4058           << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType();
4059         if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid())
4060           Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(),
4061                diag::note_previous_declaration);
4062       }
4063 
4064       if (MergeTypeWithOld)
4065         New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes,
4066                                              OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()));
4067       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
4068     }
4069 
4070     // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types.
4071   }
4072 
4073   // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or
4074   // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic.
4075 
4076   // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin
4077   // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note.
4078   unsigned BuiltinID;
4079   if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) {
4080     // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc'
4081     // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration.
4082     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) {
4083       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New;
4084       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration)
4085         << Old << Old->getType();
4086       return false;
4087     }
4088 
4089     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration;
4090   }
4091 
4092   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName();
4093   Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
4094   return true;
4095 }
4096 
4097 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are
4098 /// known to be compatible.
4099 ///
4100 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other
4101 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to
4102 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a
4103 /// redeclaration of Old.
4104 ///
4105 /// \returns false
4106 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
4107                                         Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
4108   // Merge the attributes
4109   mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
4110 
4111   // Merge "pure" flag.
4112   if (Old->isPure())
4113     New->setPure();
4114 
4115   // Merge "used" flag.
4116   if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false))
4117     New->setIsUsed();
4118 
4119   // Merge attributes from the parameters.  These can mismatch with K&R
4120   // declarations.
4121   if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams())
4122       for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
4123         ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i);
4124         ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i);
4125         mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this);
4126         mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this);
4127       }
4128 
4129   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4130     return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S);
4131 
4132   // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return
4133   // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl
4134   // was visible.
4135   QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType());
4136   if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld)
4137     New->setType(Merged);
4138 
4139   return false;
4140 }
4141 
4142 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod,
4143                                 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) {
4144   // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable
4145   AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind =
4146       isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext())
4147           ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation
4148                                      : AMK_ProtocolImplementation)
4149           : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration
4150                                                            : AMK_Override;
4151 
4152   mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind);
4153 
4154   // Merge attributes from the parameters.
4155   ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(),
4156                                        oe = oldMethod->param_end();
4157   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator
4158          ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end();
4159        ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi)
4160     mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this);
4161 
4162   CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod);
4163 }
4164 
4165 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) {
4166   assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType()));
4167 
4168   S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()
4169          ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type
4170          : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type)
4171     << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType();
4172 
4173   diag::kind PrevDiag;
4174   SourceLocation OldLocation;
4175   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation)
4176     = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
4177   S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4178   New->setInvalidDecl();
4179 }
4180 
4181 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and
4182 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to merge their types,
4183 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4184 ///
4185 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back
4186 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer
4187 /// is attached.
4188 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old,
4189                              bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
4190   if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl())
4191     return;
4192 
4193   QualType MergedT;
4194   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4195     if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
4196       // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached.
4197       return;
4198     } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) {
4199       // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked.
4200       return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old);
4201     }
4202     // C++ [basic.link]p10:
4203     //   [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given
4204     //   object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an
4205     //   array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or
4206     //   absence of a major array bound (8.3.4).
4207     else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) {
4208       const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType());
4209       const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType());
4210 
4211       // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array
4212       // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the
4213       // mismatch.
4214       if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) {
4215         for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD;
4216              PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) {
4217           QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType();
4218           if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType())
4219             continue;
4220 
4221           if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy))
4222             return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD);
4223         }
4224       }
4225 
4226       if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) {
4227         if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(),
4228                                 NewArray->getElementType()))
4229           MergedT = New->getType();
4230       }
4231       // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New
4232       // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not
4233       // visible.
4234       else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) {
4235         if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(),
4236                                 NewArray->getElementType()))
4237           MergedT = Old->getType();
4238       }
4239     }
4240     else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
4241                Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4242       MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(),
4243                                               Old->getType());
4244     }
4245   } else {
4246     // C 6.2.7p2:
4247     //   All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have
4248     //   compatible type.
4249     MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType());
4250   }
4251   if (MergedT.isNull()) {
4252     // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a
4253     // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class
4254     // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be
4255     // equivalent.
4256     // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this.
4257     if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() ||
4258          Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) {
4259       // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type
4260       // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we
4261       // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable.
4262       if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld)
4263         New->setType(Context.DependentTy);
4264       return;
4265     }
4266     return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old);
4267   }
4268 
4269   // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old
4270   // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope.
4271   if (MergeTypeWithOld)
4272     New->setType(MergedT);
4273 }
4274 
4275 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD,
4276                                   LookupResult &Previous) {
4277   // C11 6.2.7p4:
4278   //   For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared
4279   //   in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is
4280   //   visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or
4281   //   external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later
4282   //   declaration becomes the composite type.
4283   //
4284   // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type.
4285   if (Previous.isShadowed())
4286     return false;
4287 
4288   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4289     // C++11 [dcl.array]p3:
4290     //   If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same
4291     //   scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound
4292     //   is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration.
4293     return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() ||
4294            (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
4295             !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
4296   } else {
4297     // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its
4298     // type unless we're in the same function.
4299     return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() ||
4300            OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext();
4301   }
4302 }
4303 
4304 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name
4305 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to resolve this
4306 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4307 ///
4308 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by
4309 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative
4310 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached.
4311 ///
4312 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) {
4313   // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking.
4314   if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4315     return;
4316 
4317   if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New))
4318     return;
4319 
4320   VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate();
4321 
4322   // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template.
4323   VarDecl *Old = nullptr;
4324   VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr;
4325   if (Previous.isSingleResult()) {
4326     if (NewTemplate) {
4327       OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
4328       Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr;
4329 
4330       if (auto *Shadow =
4331               dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()))
4332         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate))
4333           return New->setInvalidDecl();
4334     } else {
4335       Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
4336 
4337       if (auto *Shadow =
4338               dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()))
4339         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New))
4340           return New->setInvalidDecl();
4341     }
4342   }
4343   if (!Old) {
4344     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
4345         << New->getDeclName();
4346     notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(),
4347                            New->getLocation());
4348     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4349   }
4350 
4351   // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new
4352   // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match.
4353   adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old);
4354 
4355   // Ensure the template parameters are compatible.
4356   if (NewTemplate &&
4357       !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
4358                                       OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
4359                                       /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch))
4360     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4361 
4362   // C++ [class.mem]p1:
4363   //   A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...]
4364   //
4365   // Here, we need only consider static data members.
4366   if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) {
4367     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member)
4368       << New->getIdentifier();
4369     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4370     New->setInvalidDecl();
4371   }
4372 
4373   mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
4374   // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent
4375   // declaration
4376   if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() &&
4377       Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None &&
4378       !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) {
4379     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName();
4380     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4381     // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration.
4382     New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>();
4383   }
4384 
4385   if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>())
4386     if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) {
4387       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
4388           << ILA;
4389       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4390       New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>();
4391     }
4392 
4393   // Merge the types.
4394   VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl();
4395   if (MostRecent != Old) {
4396     MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent,
4397                       mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous));
4398     if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4399       return;
4400   }
4401 
4402   MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous));
4403   if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4404     return;
4405 
4406   diag::kind PrevDiag;
4407   SourceLocation OldLocation;
4408   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) =
4409       getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
4410 
4411   // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static.
4412   if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static &&
4413       !New->isStaticDataMember() &&
4414       Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) {
4415     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
4416       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static)
4417           << New->getDeclName();
4418       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4419     } else {
4420       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static)
4421           << New->getDeclName();
4422       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4423       return New->setInvalidDecl();
4424     }
4425   }
4426   // C99 6.2.2p4:
4427   //   For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier
4428   //   extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that
4429   //   identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies
4430   //   internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at
4431   //   the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at
4432   //   the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or
4433   //   if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the
4434   //   identifier has external linkage.
4435   if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage())
4436     /* Okay */;
4437   else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static &&
4438            !New->isStaticDataMember() &&
4439            Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
4440     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName();
4441     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4442     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4443   }
4444 
4445   // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa.
4446   if (New->hasExternalStorage() &&
4447       !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) {
4448     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName();
4449     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4450     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4451   }
4452   if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() &&
4453       !New->hasExternalStorage()) {
4454     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName();
4455     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4456     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4457   }
4458 
4459   if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old))
4460     return;
4461 
4462   // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup.
4463 
4464   // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still
4465   // need to check for mismatches.
4466   if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() &&
4467       // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members.
4468       !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
4469         !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) {
4470     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName();
4471     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4472     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4473   }
4474 
4475   if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) {
4476     if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) {
4477       // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4:
4478       //   If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before
4479       //   its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed.
4480       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New;
4481       Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
4482     }
4483   }
4484 
4485   // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to
4486   // UndefinedButUsed.
4487   if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) &&
4488       !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
4489     UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(),
4490                                            SourceLocation()));
4491 
4492   if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) {
4493     if (!Old->getTLSKind()) {
4494       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName();
4495       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4496     } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) {
4497       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName();
4498       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4499     } else {
4500       // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring
4501       // static and dynamic initialization.
4502       // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first
4503       // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here?
4504       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind)
4505         << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic);
4506       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4507     }
4508   }
4509 
4510   // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here.
4511   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4512     if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() &&
4513         Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) {
4514       // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged.
4515       Diag(New->getLocation(),
4516            diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def);
4517     } else if (New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) {
4518       VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition();
4519       if (Def && checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New))
4520         return;
4521     }
4522   }
4523 
4524   if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) {
4525     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New;
4526     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4527     New->setInvalidDecl();
4528     return;
4529   }
4530 
4531   // Merge "used" flag.
4532   if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false))
4533     New->setIsUsed();
4534 
4535   // Keep a chain of previous declarations.
4536   New->setPreviousDecl(Old);
4537   if (NewTemplate)
4538     NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate);
4539 
4540   // Inherit access appropriately.
4541   New->setAccess(Old->getAccess());
4542   if (NewTemplate)
4543     NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess());
4544 
4545   if (Old->isInline())
4546     New->setImplicitlyInline();
4547 }
4548 
4549 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) {
4550   SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager();
4551   auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New);
4552   auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation());
4553   auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first);
4554   auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first);
4555   auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo();
4556   StringRef HdrFilename =
4557       SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation()));
4558 
4559   auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod,
4560                                      SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool {
4561     // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped
4562     // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets
4563     // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition
4564     // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on.
4565     if (IncLoc.isValid()) {
4566       if (Mod) {
4567         Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file)
4568             << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName();
4569         if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid())
4570           Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here)
4571               << Mod->getFullModuleName();
4572       } else {
4573         Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file)
4574             << HdrFilename.str();
4575       }
4576       return true;
4577     }
4578 
4579     return false;
4580   };
4581 
4582   // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why
4583   // this leads to a redefinition error.
4584   if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) {
4585     SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first);
4586     SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first);
4587     bool EmittedDiag =
4588         noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc);
4589     EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc);
4590 
4591     // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one.
4592     if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld))
4593       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards);
4594 
4595     if (EmittedDiag)
4596       return;
4597   }
4598 
4599   // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above.
4600   if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
4601     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
4602 }
4603 
4604 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions
4605 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem.
4606 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) {
4607   if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) &&
4608       (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage ||
4609        New->isInline() ||
4610        New->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
4611        New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() ||
4612        New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) {
4613     // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are
4614     // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration.
4615     New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration();
4616 
4617     // Make the canonical definition visible.
4618     if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate())
4619       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD);
4620     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old);
4621     return false;
4622   } else {
4623     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New;
4624     notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
4625     New->setInvalidDecl();
4626     return true;
4627   }
4628 }
4629 
4630 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4631 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed.
4632 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS,
4633                                        DeclSpec &DS,
4634                                        const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs,
4635                                        RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) {
4636   return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(
4637       S, AS, DS, DeclAttrs, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false, AnonRecord);
4638 }
4639 
4640 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to
4641 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes.
4642 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks
4643 // compatibility.
4644 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being
4645 // targeted.
4646 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) {
4647   return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015)
4648              ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber()
4649              : S->getMSLastManglingNumber();
4650 }
4651 
4652 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) {
4653   if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4654     return;
4655 
4656   if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) {
4657     // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if
4658     // it is anonymous.
4659     if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl())
4660       return;
4661     MangleNumberingContext &MCtx =
4662         Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent());
4663     Context.setManglingNumber(
4664         Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber(
4665                  Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope)));
4666     return;
4667   }
4668 
4669   // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local.
4670   MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
4671   Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
4672   std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
4673       getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext());
4674   if (MCtx) {
4675     Context.setManglingNumber(
4676         Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
4677                  Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope)));
4678   }
4679 }
4680 
4681 namespace {
4682 struct NonCLikeKind {
4683   enum {
4684     None,
4685     BaseClass,
4686     DefaultMemberInit,
4687     Lambda,
4688     Friend,
4689     OtherMember,
4690     Invalid,
4691   } Kind = None;
4692   SourceRange Range;
4693 
4694   explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; }
4695 };
4696 }
4697 
4698 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++
4699 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage.
4700 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
4701   if (RD->isInvalidDecl())
4702     return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}};
4703 
4704   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1]
4705   //   An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not
4706   //
4707   //    -- have any base classes
4708   if (RD->getNumBases())
4709     return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass,
4710             SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(),
4711                         RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())};
4712   bool Invalid = false;
4713   for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) {
4714     // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed.
4715     if (D->isInvalidDecl()) {
4716       Invalid = true;
4717       continue;
4718     }
4719 
4720     //  -- have any [...] default member initializers
4721     if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) {
4722       if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) {
4723         auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer();
4724         return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit,
4725                 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()};
4726       }
4727       continue;
4728     }
4729 
4730     // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of
4731     // P1766, but not the intent.
4732     if (isa<FriendDecl>(D))
4733       return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()};
4734 
4735     //  -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member
4736     //     enumerations, or member classes,
4737     if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) ||
4738         isa<EnumDecl>(D))
4739       continue;
4740     auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
4741     if (!MemberRD) {
4742       if (D->isImplicit())
4743         continue;
4744       return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()};
4745     }
4746 
4747     //  -- contain a lambda-expression,
4748     if (MemberRD->isLambda())
4749       return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()};
4750 
4751     //  and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements
4752     //  (recursively).
4753     if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
4754       if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD))
4755         return Kind;
4756     }
4757   }
4758 
4759   return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}};
4760 }
4761 
4762 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec,
4763                                         TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) {
4764   if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl())
4765     return;
4766 
4767   // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes.
4768   if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage())
4769     return;
4770 
4771   // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition.
4772   assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition());
4773 
4774   // The type must match the tag exactly;  no qualifiers allowed.
4775   if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(),
4776                            Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) {
4777     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4778       Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD);
4779     return;
4780   }
4781 
4782   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR]
4783   //   An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be
4784   //   C-like].
4785   //
4786   // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally
4787   // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't
4788   // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early.
4789   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec);
4790   NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD)
4791                              : NonCLikeKind();
4792   bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed();
4793   if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) {
4794     if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid)
4795       return;
4796 
4797     unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef;
4798     if (ChangesLinkage) {
4799       // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension.
4800       if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None)
4801         DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage;
4802       else
4803         DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef;
4804     }
4805 
4806     SourceLocation FixitLoc =
4807         getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart());
4808     llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert;
4809     TextToInsert += ' ';
4810     TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName();
4811 
4812     Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID)
4813       << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD)
4814       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert);
4815     if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) {
4816       Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct)
4817         << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range;
4818     }
4819     Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here)
4820       << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD);
4821 
4822     if (ChangesLinkage)
4823       return;
4824   }
4825 
4826   // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag.
4827   TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD);
4828 }
4829 
4830 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) {
4831   switch (T) {
4832   case DeclSpec::TST_class:
4833     return 0;
4834   case DeclSpec::TST_struct:
4835     return 1;
4836   case DeclSpec::TST_interface:
4837     return 2;
4838   case DeclSpec::TST_union:
4839     return 3;
4840   case DeclSpec::TST_enum:
4841     return 4;
4842   default:
4843     llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier");
4844   }
4845 }
4846 
4847 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4848 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template
4849 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations.
4850 Decl *Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS,
4851                                        DeclSpec &DS,
4852                                        const ParsedAttributesView &DeclAttrs,
4853                                        MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams,
4854                                        bool IsExplicitInstantiation,
4855                                        RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) {
4856   Decl *TagD = nullptr;
4857   TagDecl *Tag = nullptr;
4858   if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class ||
4859       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct ||
4860       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface ||
4861       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union ||
4862       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) {
4863     TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl();
4864 
4865     if (!TagD) // We probably had an error
4866       return nullptr;
4867 
4868     // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the
4869     // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others
4870     // it's a Type.
4871     if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD))
4872       Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
4873     else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD))
4874       Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl();
4875   }
4876 
4877   if (Tag) {
4878     handleTagNumbering(Tag, S);
4879     Tag->setFreeStanding();
4880     if (Tag->isInvalidDecl())
4881       return Tag;
4882   }
4883 
4884   if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
4885     // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object
4886     // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified."
4887     if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict)
4888       Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(),
4889            diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg)
4890            << DS.getSourceRange();
4891   }
4892 
4893   if (DS.isInlineSpecified())
4894     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
4895         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
4896 
4897   if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) {
4898     // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations
4899     // and definitions of functions and variables.
4900     // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to
4901     // the declaration of a function or function template
4902     if (Tag)
4903       Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag)
4904           << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType())
4905           << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier());
4906     else
4907       Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
4908           << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier());
4909     // Don't emit warnings after this error.
4910     return TagD;
4911   }
4912 
4913   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS);
4914 
4915   if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) {
4916     // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that
4917     // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect.
4918     if (TagD && !Tag)
4919       return nullptr;
4920     return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams);
4921   }
4922 
4923   const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope();
4924   bool IsExplicitSpecialization =
4925     !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0;
4926   if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() &&
4927       !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization &&
4928       !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) {
4929     // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a
4930     // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation
4931     // or an explicit specialization.
4932     //
4933     // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the
4934     // obvious intent of DR1819.
4935     //
4936     // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either.
4937     Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier)
4938         << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange();
4939     return nullptr;
4940   }
4941 
4942   // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything.
4943   bool DeclaresAnything = true;
4944 
4945   // Handle anonymous struct definitions.
4946   if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) {
4947     if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() &&
4948         DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) {
4949       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
4950           Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) {
4951         // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements,
4952         // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that
4953         // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext.
4954         // Also store them here so that they can be part of the
4955         // DeclStmt that gets created in this case.
4956         // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by
4957         // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason?
4958         if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
4959           AnonRecord = Record;
4960         return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record,
4961                                            Context.getPrintingPolicy());
4962       }
4963 
4964       DeclaresAnything = false;
4965     }
4966   }
4967 
4968   // C11 6.7.2.1p2:
4969   //   A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or
4970   //   anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list.
4971   //
4972   // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration
4973   // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list.
4974   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() &&
4975       DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) {
4976     // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member.
4977     // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union:
4978     //   struct STRUCT;
4979     //   union UNION;
4980     // and
4981     //   STRUCT_TYPE;  <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct.
4982     //   UNION_TYPE;   <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union.
4983     if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) ||
4984         DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) {
4985       RecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
4986       if (Tag)
4987         Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag);
4988       else if (const RecordType *RT =
4989                    DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType())
4990         Record = RT->getDecl();
4991       else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType())
4992         Record = UT->getDecl();
4993 
4994       if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
4995         Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record)
4996             << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange();
4997         return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record);
4998       }
4999 
5000       DeclaresAnything = false;
5001     }
5002   }
5003 
5004   // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error.
5005   if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error ||
5006       (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl()))
5007     return TagD;
5008 
5009   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
5010       DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5011     if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag))
5012       if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() &&
5013           !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl())
5014         DeclaresAnything = false;
5015 
5016   if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) {
5017     // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name.
5018     if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5019       Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name)
5020           << DS.getSourceRange();
5021     else
5022       DeclaresAnything = false;
5023   }
5024 
5025   if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() &&
5026       Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
5027     Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class)
5028       << Tag->getTagKind()
5029       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
5030 
5031   ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD);
5032 
5033   // C 6.7/2:
5034   //   A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag,
5035   //   or the members of an enumeration.
5036   // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3:
5037   //   [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an
5038   //   unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more
5039   //   names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a
5040   //   previous declaration.
5041   if (!DeclaresAnything) {
5042     // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother
5043     // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this.
5044     Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty())
5045                                ? diag::err_no_declarators
5046                                : diag::ext_no_declarators)
5047         << DS.getSourceRange();
5048     return TagD;
5049   }
5050 
5051   // C++ [dcl.stc]p1:
5052   //   If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the
5053   //   init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty.
5054   // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1:
5055   //   If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the
5056   //   init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty.
5057   //
5058   // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C.
5059   unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier;
5060   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5061     DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier;
5062 
5063   // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but
5064   // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically
5065   // useless.
5066   if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) {
5067     if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable)
5068       // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is
5069       // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error.
5070       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
5071     else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5072       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID)
5073         << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS);
5074   }
5075 
5076   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec())
5077     Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID)
5078       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
5079   if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
5080     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const)
5081       Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const";
5082     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile)
5083       Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile";
5084     // Restrict is covered above.
5085     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic)
5086       Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic";
5087     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned)
5088       Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned";
5089   }
5090 
5091   // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example:
5092   // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A;
5093   // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration.
5094   if (!DS.getAttributes().empty() || !DeclAttrs.empty()) {
5095     DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType();
5096     if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class ||
5097         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct ||
5098         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface ||
5099         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union ||
5100         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) {
5101       for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes())
5102         Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored)
5103             << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType);
5104       for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DeclAttrs)
5105         Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored)
5106             << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType);
5107     }
5108   }
5109 
5110   return TagD;
5111 }
5112 
5113 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope;
5114 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded.
5115 ///
5116 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration
5117 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef,
5118                                          Scope *S,
5119                                          DeclContext *Owner,
5120                                          DeclarationName Name,
5121                                          SourceLocation NameLoc,
5122                                          bool IsUnion) {
5123   LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName,
5124                  Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
5125   if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false;
5126 
5127   // Pick a representative declaration.
5128   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5129   assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl");
5130 
5131   if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S))
5132     return false;
5133 
5134   SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl)
5135     << IsUnion << Name;
5136   SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
5137 
5138   return true;
5139 }
5140 
5141 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the
5142 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner
5143 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize
5144 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or
5145 /// struct, e.g.,
5146 ///
5147 /// @code
5148 /// union {
5149 ///   int i;
5150 ///   float f;
5151 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and
5152 ///    // f into the surrounding scope.x
5153 /// @endcode
5154 ///
5155 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous
5156 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well.
5157 static bool
5158 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner,
5159                                     RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS,
5160                                     SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) {
5161   bool Invalid = false;
5162 
5163   // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name.
5164   for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) {
5165     if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) &&
5166         cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) {
5167       ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D);
5168       if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(),
5169                                        VD->getLocation(),
5170                                        AnonRecord->isUnion())) {
5171         // C++ [class.union]p2:
5172         //   The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be
5173         //   distinct from the names of any other entity in the
5174         //   scope in which the anonymous union is declared.
5175         Invalid = true;
5176       } else {
5177         // C++ [class.union]p2:
5178         //   For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union
5179         //   definition, the members of the anonymous union are
5180         //   considered to have been defined in the scope in which the
5181         //   anonymous union is declared.
5182         unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size();
5183         if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
5184           Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end());
5185         else
5186           Chaining.push_back(VD);
5187 
5188         assert(Chaining.size() >= 2);
5189         NamedDecl **NamedChain =
5190           new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()];
5191         for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++)
5192           NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i];
5193 
5194         IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create(
5195             SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(),
5196             VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()});
5197 
5198         for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs())
5199           IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context));
5200 
5201         IndirectField->setAccess(AS);
5202         IndirectField->setImplicit();
5203         SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S);
5204 
5205         // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier.
5206         if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS);
5207 
5208         Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize);
5209       }
5210     }
5211   }
5212 
5213   return Invalid;
5214 }
5215 
5216 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to
5217 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller:
5218 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None.
5219 static StorageClass
5220 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) {
5221   DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec();
5222   assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef &&
5223          "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl.");
5224   switch (StorageClassSpec) {
5225   case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified:    return SC_None;
5226   case DeclSpec::SCS_extern:
5227     if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec())
5228       return SC_None;
5229     return SC_Extern;
5230   case DeclSpec::SCS_static:         return SC_Static;
5231   case DeclSpec::SCS_auto:           return SC_Auto;
5232   case DeclSpec::SCS_register:       return SC_Register;
5233   case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern;
5234     // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller.
5235   case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable:        // Fall through.
5236   case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef:        return SC_None;
5237   }
5238   llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier");
5239 }
5240 
5241 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
5242   assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer());
5243 
5244   for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) {
5245     const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I);
5246     if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I))
5247       FD = IFD->getAnonField();
5248     if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer())
5249       return FD->getLocation();
5250   }
5251 
5252   llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer");
5253 }
5254 
5255 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent,
5256                                       SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) {
5257   if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer())
5258     return;
5259 
5260   S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization);
5261   S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0;
5262 }
5263 
5264 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent,
5265                                       CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) {
5266   if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer())
5267     return;
5268 
5269   checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion));
5270 }
5271 
5272 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an
5273 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature
5274 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures
5275 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension.
5276 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
5277                                         AccessSpecifier AS,
5278                                         RecordDecl *Record,
5279                                         const PrintingPolicy &Policy) {
5280   DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext();
5281 
5282   // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension.
5283   if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11)
5284     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union);
5285   else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5286     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct);
5287   else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11)
5288     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct);
5289 
5290   // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous
5291   // structs/unions.
5292   bool Invalid = false;
5293   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5294     const char *PrevSpec = nullptr;
5295     if (Record->isUnion()) {
5296       // C++ [class.union]p6:
5297       // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2:
5298       //   Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the
5299       //   global namespace shall be declared static.
5300       unsigned DiagID;
5301       DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext();
5302       if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static &&
5303           (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() ||
5304            (OwnerScope->isNamespace() &&
5305             !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) {
5306         Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static)
5307           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static ");
5308 
5309         // Recover by adding 'static'.
5310         DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(),
5311                                PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy);
5312       }
5313       // C++ [class.union]p6:
5314       //   A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an
5315       //   anonymous union in a class scope.
5316       else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified &&
5317                isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) {
5318         Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
5319              diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec)
5320           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
5321 
5322         // Recover by removing the storage specifier.
5323         DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified,
5324                                SourceLocation(),
5325                                PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy());
5326       }
5327     }
5328 
5329     // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers.
5330     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
5331       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const)
5332         Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5333           << Record->isUnion() << "const"
5334           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc());
5335       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile)
5336         Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(),
5337              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5338           << Record->isUnion() << "volatile"
5339           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc());
5340       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict)
5341         Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(),
5342              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5343           << Record->isUnion() << "restrict"
5344           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc());
5345       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic)
5346         Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(),
5347              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5348           << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic"
5349           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc());
5350       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned)
5351         Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(),
5352              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5353           << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned"
5354           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc());
5355 
5356       DS.ClearTypeQualifiers();
5357     }
5358 
5359     // C++ [class.union]p2:
5360     //   The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only
5361     //   define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and
5362     //   functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ]
5363     for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) {
5364       // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them.
5365       if (Mem->isInvalidDecl())
5366         continue;
5367 
5368       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) {
5369         // C++ [class.union]p3:
5370         //   An anonymous union shall not have private or protected
5371         //   members (clause 11).
5372         assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none);
5373         if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) {
5374           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member)
5375             << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected);
5376           Invalid = true;
5377         }
5378 
5379         // C++ [class.union]p1
5380         //   An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial
5381         //   copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy
5382         //   assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an
5383         //   array of such objects.
5384         if (CheckNontrivialField(FD))
5385           Invalid = true;
5386       } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) {
5387         // Any implicit members are fine.
5388       } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) {
5389         // This is a type that showed up in an
5390         // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or
5391         // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the
5392         // anonymous struct or union. It's okay.
5393       } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) {
5394         if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
5395             MemRecord->getDeclName()) {
5396           // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union.
5397           if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
5398             Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type)
5399               << Record->isUnion();
5400           else {
5401             // This is a nested type declaration.
5402             Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type)
5403               << Record->isUnion();
5404             Invalid = true;
5405           }
5406         } else {
5407           // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type.
5408           // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but
5409           // not part of standard C++.
5410           Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(),
5411                diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type)
5412             << Record->isUnion();
5413         }
5414       } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) {
5415         // Any access specifier is fine.
5416       } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) {
5417         // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine.
5418       } else {
5419         // We have something that isn't a non-static data
5420         // member. Complain about it.
5421         unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member;
5422         if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem))
5423           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type;
5424         else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem))
5425           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function;
5426         else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem))
5427           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static;
5428 
5429         // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union.
5430         if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt &&
5431             DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type)
5432           Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type)
5433             << Record->isUnion();
5434         else {
5435           Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion();
5436           Invalid = true;
5437         }
5438       }
5439     }
5440 
5441     // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460):
5442     //   At most one variant member of a union may have a
5443     //   brace-or-equal-initializer.
5444     if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() &&
5445         Owner->isRecord())
5446       checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner),
5447                                 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record));
5448   }
5449 
5450   if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) {
5451     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member)
5452       << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
5453     Invalid = true;
5454   }
5455 
5456   // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3:
5457   //   [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an
5458   //   unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more
5459   //   names into the program
5460   // C++ [class.mem]p2:
5461   //   each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member
5462   //   name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field
5463   //
5464   // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere.
5465   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty())
5466     Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange();
5467 
5468   // Mock up a declarator.
5469   Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Member);
5470   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S);
5471   assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union");
5472 
5473   // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union.
5474   NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr;
5475   if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) {
5476     Anon = FieldDecl::Create(
5477         Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(),
5478         /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo,
5479         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false,
5480         /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit);
5481     Anon->setAccess(AS);
5482     ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc);
5483 
5484     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5485       FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon));
5486   } else {
5487     DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec();
5488     StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS);
5489     if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) {
5490       // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always
5491       // an error here
5492       Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
5493       Invalid = true;
5494       SC = SC_None;
5495     }
5496 
5497     assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected");
5498     Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(),
5499                            Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr,
5500                            Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC);
5501 
5502     // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be
5503     // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class
5504     // initializer:
5505     //   union { int n = 0; };
5506     ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon);
5507   }
5508   Anon->setImplicit();
5509 
5510   // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type.
5511   Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true);
5512 
5513   // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current
5514   // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of
5515   // its members.
5516   Owner->addDecl(Anon);
5517 
5518   // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning
5519   // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup
5520   // purposes.
5521   SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain;
5522   Chain.push_back(Anon);
5523 
5524   if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain))
5525     Invalid = true;
5526 
5527   if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) {
5528     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
5529       MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
5530       Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
5531       std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
5532           getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext());
5533       if (MCtx) {
5534         Context.setManglingNumber(
5535             NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
5536                        NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S)));
5537         Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD));
5538       }
5539     }
5540   }
5541 
5542   if (Invalid)
5543     Anon->setInvalidDecl();
5544 
5545   return Anon;
5546 }
5547 
5548 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an
5549 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure.
5550 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx
5551 /// Example:
5552 ///
5553 /// struct A { int a; };
5554 /// struct B { struct A; int b; };
5555 ///
5556 /// void foo() {
5557 ///   B var;
5558 ///   var.a = 3;
5559 /// }
5560 ///
5561 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
5562                                            RecordDecl *Record) {
5563   assert(Record && "expected a record!");
5564 
5565   // Mock up a declarator.
5566   Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::TypeName);
5567   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S);
5568   assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct");
5569 
5570   auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext);
5571   QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record);
5572 
5573   // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct.
5574   NamedDecl *Anon =
5575       FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(),
5576                         /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo,
5577                         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false,
5578                         /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit);
5579   Anon->setImplicit();
5580 
5581   // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context.
5582   CurContext->addDecl(Anon);
5583 
5584   // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current
5585   // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup
5586   // purposes.
5587   SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain;
5588   Chain.push_back(Anon);
5589 
5590   RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition();
5591   if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy,
5592                                diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) ||
5593       InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef,
5594                                           AS_none, Chain)) {
5595     Anon->setInvalidDecl();
5596     ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl();
5597   }
5598 
5599   return Anon;
5600 }
5601 
5602 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the
5603 /// given Declarator.
5604 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) {
5605   return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName());
5606 }
5607 
5608 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id.
5609 DeclarationNameInfo
5610 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) {
5611   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
5612   NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation);
5613 
5614   switch (Name.getKind()) {
5615 
5616   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam:
5617   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier:
5618     NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier);
5619     return NameInfo;
5620 
5621   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: {
5622     // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3:
5623     //   The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization.
5624     //   The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name
5625     //   of the simple-template-id.
5626     // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a
5627     // class template.
5628     // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {};
5629     //        template<typename T> using Y = X<T>;
5630     //        Y(int) -> Y<int>;
5631     //   satisfies these rules but does not name a class template.
5632     TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get();
5633     auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl();
5634     if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) {
5635       Diag(Name.StartLocation,
5636            diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template)
5637         << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN;
5638       if (Template)
5639         Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
5640       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5641     }
5642 
5643     NameInfo.setName(
5644         Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template));
5645     return NameInfo;
5646   }
5647 
5648   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId:
5649     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(
5650                                            Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator));
5651     NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(
5652         Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation));
5653     return NameInfo;
5654 
5655   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId:
5656     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(
5657                                                            Name.Identifier));
5658     NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation);
5659     return NameInfo;
5660 
5661   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: {
5662     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5663     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo);
5664     if (Ty.isNull())
5665       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5666     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName(
5667                                                Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5668     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5669     return NameInfo;
5670   }
5671 
5672   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: {
5673     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5674     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo);
5675     if (Ty.isNull())
5676       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5677     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
5678                                               Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5679     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5680     return NameInfo;
5681   }
5682 
5683   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: {
5684     // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor
5685     // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there
5686     // to find the actual type being constructed.
5687     CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext);
5688     if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name)
5689       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5690 
5691     // Determine the type of the class being constructed.
5692     QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass);
5693 
5694     // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as
5695     // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name
5696     // was qualified.
5697 
5698     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
5699                                     Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType)));
5700     // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo?
5701     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr);
5702     return NameInfo;
5703   }
5704 
5705   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: {
5706     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5707     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo);
5708     if (Ty.isNull())
5709       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5710     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(
5711                                               Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5712     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5713     return NameInfo;
5714   }
5715 
5716   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: {
5717     TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get();
5718     SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
5719     return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
5720   }
5721 
5722   } // switch (Name.getKind())
5723 
5724   llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind");
5725 }
5726 
5727 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) {
5728   do {
5729     if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType())
5730       Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
5731     else if (Ty->isArrayType())
5732       Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType();
5733     else
5734       return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers();
5735   } while (true);
5736 }
5737 
5738 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration
5739 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is
5740 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function
5741 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace.
5742 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ
5743 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters
5744 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match.
5745 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context,
5746                                      FunctionDecl *Declaration,
5747                                      FunctionDecl *Definition,
5748                                      SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) {
5749   Params.clear();
5750   if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size())
5751     return false;
5752   for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) {
5753     QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType();
5754     QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType();
5755 
5756     // The parameter types are identical
5757     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy))
5758       continue;
5759 
5760     QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy);
5761     QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy);
5762     const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier();
5763     const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier();
5764 
5765     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) ||
5766         (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName))
5767       Params.push_back(Idx);
5768     else  // The two parameters aren't even close
5769       return false;
5770   }
5771 
5772   return true;
5773 }
5774 
5775 /// RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given
5776 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation.
5777 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for
5778 /// consideration here.  That's specifically the type in the decl spec
5779 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks.
5780 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D,
5781                                                     DeclarationName Name) {
5782   // The types we specifically need to rebuild are:
5783   //   - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes
5784   //   - types which will become injected class names
5785   // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a
5786   // type.  It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a
5787   // few cases here.
5788 
5789   DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec();
5790   switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) {
5791   case DeclSpec::TST_typename:
5792   case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType:
5793   case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType:
5794   case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: {
5795     // Grab the type from the parser.
5796     TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr;
5797     QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI);
5798     if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break;
5799 
5800     // Make sure there's a type source info.  This isn't really much
5801     // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info
5802     // attached already.
5803     if (!TSI)
5804       TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc());
5805 
5806     // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation.
5807     TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name);
5808     if (!TSI) return true;
5809 
5810     // Store the new type back in the decl spec.
5811     ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI);
5812     DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType);
5813     break;
5814   }
5815 
5816   case DeclSpec::TST_decltype:
5817   case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: {
5818     Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr();
5819     ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E);
5820     if (Result.isInvalid()) return true;
5821     DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get());
5822     break;
5823   }
5824 
5825   default:
5826     // Nothing to do for these decl specs.
5827     break;
5828   }
5829 
5830   // It doesn't matter what order we do this in.
5831   for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) {
5832     DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I);
5833 
5834     // The only type information in the declarator which can come
5835     // before the declaration name is the base type of a member
5836     // pointer.
5837     if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer)
5838       continue;
5839 
5840     // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place.
5841     CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope();
5842     if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS))
5843       return true;
5844   }
5845 
5846   return false;
5847 }
5848 
5849 /// Returns true if the declaration is declared in a system header or from a
5850 /// system macro.
5851 static bool isFromSystemHeader(SourceManager &SM, const Decl *D) {
5852   return SM.isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()) ||
5853          SM.isInSystemMacro(D->getLocation());
5854 }
5855 
5856 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) {
5857   // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration
5858   // of system decl.
5859   if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit())
5860     return;
5861   ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts());
5862   if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved &&
5863       !isFromSystemHeader(Context.getSourceManager(), D)) {
5864     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol)
5865         << D << static_cast<int>(Status);
5866   }
5867 }
5868 
5869 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
5870   D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration);
5871   Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg());
5872 
5873   if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() &&
5874       Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
5875     Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
5876 
5877   return Dcl;
5878 }
5879 
5880 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13:
5881 ///   If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
5882 ///   name different from T:
5883 ///     - every static data member of class T;
5884 ///     - every member function of class T
5885 ///     - every member of class T that is itself a type;
5886 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules.
5887 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC,
5888                                    DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) {
5889   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
5890 
5891   CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
5892   while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
5893     Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent());
5894   if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) {
5895     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name;
5896     return true;
5897   }
5898 
5899   return false;
5900 }
5901 
5902 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given
5903 /// nested-name-specifier.
5904 ///
5905 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
5906 ///
5907 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier
5908 /// resolves.
5909 ///
5910 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared.
5911 ///
5912 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared.
5913 ///
5914 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus
5915 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation.
5916 ///
5917 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise.
5918 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC,
5919                                         DeclarationName Name,
5920                                         SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) {
5921   DeclContext *Cur = CurContext;
5922   while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur))
5923     Cur = Cur->getParent();
5924 
5925   // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the
5926   // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it.
5927   //
5928   // class X {
5929   //   void X::f();
5930   // };
5931   //
5932   // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all
5933   // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482.
5934   if (Cur->Equals(DC)) {
5935     if (Cur->isRecord()) {
5936       Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification
5937                                       : diag::err_member_extra_qualification)
5938         << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange());
5939       SS.clear();
5940     } else {
5941       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name;
5942     }
5943     return false;
5944   }
5945 
5946   // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original
5947   // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in
5948   // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope.
5949   if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) {
5950     if (Cur->isRecord())
5951       Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification)
5952         << Name << SS.getRange();
5953     else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
5954       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope)
5955         << Name << SS.getRange();
5956     else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur))
5957       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function)
5958         << Name << SS.getRange();
5959     else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur))
5960       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block)
5961         << Name << SS.getRange();
5962     else if (isa<ExportDecl>(Cur)) {
5963       if (!isa<NamespaceDecl>(DC))
5964         Diag(Loc, diag::err_export_non_namespace_scope_name)
5965             << Name << SS.getRange();
5966       else
5967         // The cases that DC is not NamespaceDecl should be handled in
5968         // CheckRedeclarationExported.
5969         return false;
5970     } else
5971       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope)
5972       << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange();
5973 
5974     return true;
5975   }
5976 
5977   if (Cur->isRecord()) {
5978     // Cannot qualify members within a class.
5979     Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification)
5980       << Name << SS.getRange();
5981     SS.clear();
5982 
5983     // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break
5984     // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If
5985     // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely.
5986     if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName ||
5987          Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) &&
5988         !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(),
5989                              Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur))))
5990       return true;
5991 
5992     return false;
5993   }
5994 
5995   // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1:
5996   //   [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall
5997   //   not begin with a decltype-specifer"
5998   NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data());
5999   while (SpecLoc.getPrefix())
6000     SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix();
6001   if (isa_and_nonnull<DecltypeType>(
6002           SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType()))
6003     Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator)
6004       << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
6005 
6006   return false;
6007 }
6008 
6009 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
6010                                   MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) {
6011   // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic.
6012   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D);
6013   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
6014 
6015   // All of these full declarators require an identifier.  If it doesn't have
6016   // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used.
6017   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
6018     return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists);
6019   } else if (!Name) {
6020     if (!D.isInvalidType())  // Reject this if we think it is valid.
6021       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident)
6022           << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange();
6023     return nullptr;
6024   } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType))
6025     return nullptr;
6026 
6027   // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope.  Zip up the scope tree until
6028   // we find one that is.
6029   while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 ||
6030          (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0)
6031     S = S->getParent();
6032 
6033   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
6034   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid())
6035     D.setInvalidType();
6036   else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6037     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
6038                                         UPPC_DeclarationQualifier))
6039       return nullptr;
6040 
6041     bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
6042     DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext);
6043     if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) {
6044       // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the
6045       // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class,
6046       // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain
6047       // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster.
6048       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6049            diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match)
6050         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()
6051         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6052       return nullptr;
6053     }
6054     bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext();
6055 
6056     if (!IsDependentContext &&
6057         RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC))
6058       return nullptr;
6059 
6060     // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it.
6061     if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) {
6062       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6063            diag::err_member_def_undefined_record)
6064         << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6065       return nullptr;
6066     }
6067     if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) {
6068       if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(
6069               D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6070               D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) {
6071         if (DC->isRecord())
6072           return nullptr;
6073 
6074         D.setInvalidType();
6075       }
6076     }
6077 
6078     // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given
6079     // declaration in the current instantiation.
6080     if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext &&
6081         TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) {
6082       ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC);
6083       if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name))
6084         D.setInvalidType();
6085     }
6086   }
6087 
6088   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
6089   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
6090 
6091   if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo,
6092                                       UPPC_DeclarationType))
6093     D.setInvalidType();
6094 
6095   LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName,
6096                         forRedeclarationInCurContext());
6097 
6098   // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope.
6099   if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6100     bool IsLinkageLookup = false;
6101     bool CreateBuiltins = false;
6102 
6103     // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function
6104     // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with
6105     // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6).
6106     //
6107     // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with
6108     // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with
6109     // the same name.
6110     if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
6111       /* Do nothing*/;
6112     else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
6113              (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern ||
6114               R->isFunctionType())) {
6115       IsLinkageLookup = true;
6116       CreateBuiltins =
6117           CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit();
6118     } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
6119                D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static)
6120       CreateBuiltins = true;
6121 
6122     if (IsLinkageLookup) {
6123       Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage);
6124       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration);
6125     }
6126 
6127     LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins);
6128   } else { // Something like "int foo::x;"
6129     LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC);
6130 
6131     // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1:
6132     //   When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a
6133     //  previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the
6134     //  qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the
6135     //  inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization
6136     //  thereof; [...]
6137     //
6138     // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have
6139     // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration
6140     // we want to match. For example, given:
6141     //
6142     //   class X {
6143     //     void f();
6144     //     void f(float);
6145     //   };
6146     //
6147     //   void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed
6148     //
6149     // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set
6150     // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them
6151     // matches.
6152 
6153     // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1:
6154     //   [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a
6155     //   using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by
6156     //   the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
6157     RemoveUsingDecls(Previous);
6158   }
6159 
6160   if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
6161       Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) {
6162     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
6163     if (!D.isInvalidType())
6164       DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6165                                       Previous.getFoundDecl());
6166 
6167     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
6168     Previous.clear();
6169   }
6170 
6171   if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo))
6172     // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name.
6173     Previous.clear();
6174 
6175   // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type
6176   // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the
6177   // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and
6178   // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates.
6179   if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() &&
6180       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef &&
6181       (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType()))
6182     Previous.clear();
6183 
6184   // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters
6185   // of a function declaration (C++ only).
6186   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6187     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
6188 
6189   NamedDecl *New;
6190 
6191   bool AddToScope = true;
6192   if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) {
6193     if (TemplateParamLists.size()) {
6194       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef);
6195       return nullptr;
6196     }
6197 
6198     New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous);
6199   } else if (R->isFunctionType()) {
6200     New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous,
6201                                   TemplateParamLists,
6202                                   AddToScope);
6203   } else {
6204     New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists,
6205                                   AddToScope);
6206   }
6207 
6208   if (!New)
6209     return nullptr;
6210 
6211   // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization,
6212   // add it to the scope stack.
6213   if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope)
6214     PushOnScopeChains(New, S);
6215 
6216   if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext())
6217     checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New);
6218 
6219   return New;
6220 }
6221 
6222 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array
6223 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for
6224 /// GCC compatibility).
6225 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T,
6226                                                     ASTContext &Context,
6227                                                     bool &SizeIsNegative,
6228                                                     llvm::APSInt &Oversized) {
6229   // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant
6230   // array even when the size isn't an ICE.  This is necessary
6231   // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy
6232   // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];}
6233   SizeIsNegative = false;
6234   Oversized = 0;
6235 
6236   if (T->isDependentType())
6237     return QualType();
6238 
6239   QualifierCollector Qs;
6240   const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T);
6241 
6242   if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) {
6243     QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType();
6244     QualType FixedType =
6245         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative,
6246                                             Oversized);
6247     if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType;
6248     FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType);
6249     return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType);
6250   }
6251   if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) {
6252     QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType();
6253     QualType FixedType =
6254         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative,
6255                                             Oversized);
6256     if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType;
6257     FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType);
6258     return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType);
6259   }
6260 
6261   const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T);
6262   if (!VLATy)
6263     return QualType();
6264 
6265   QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType();
6266   if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
6267     ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context,
6268                                                  SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6269     if (ElemTy.isNull())
6270       return QualType();
6271   }
6272 
6273   Expr::EvalResult Result;
6274   if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() ||
6275       !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context))
6276     return QualType();
6277 
6278   llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt();
6279 
6280   // Check whether the array size is negative.
6281   if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) {
6282     SizeIsNegative = true;
6283     return QualType();
6284   }
6285 
6286   // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed.
6287   unsigned ActiveSizeBits =
6288       (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
6289        !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType())
6290           ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res)
6291           : Res.getActiveBits();
6292   if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) {
6293     Oversized = Res;
6294     return QualType();
6295   }
6296 
6297   QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType(
6298       ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6299   return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType);
6300 }
6301 
6302 static void
6303 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) {
6304   SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc();
6305   DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc();
6306   if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) {
6307     PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>();
6308     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(),
6309                                       DstPTL.getPointeeLoc());
6310     DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc());
6311     return;
6312   }
6313   if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) {
6314     ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>();
6315     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(),
6316                                       DstPTL.getInnerLoc());
6317     DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc());
6318     DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc());
6319     return;
6320   }
6321   ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>();
6322   ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>();
6323   TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc();
6324   TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc();
6325   if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL =
6326           SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) {
6327     ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>();
6328     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL);
6329   } else {
6330     DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL);
6331   }
6332   DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc());
6333   DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr());
6334   DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc());
6335 }
6336 
6337 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array
6338 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for
6339 /// GCC compatibility).
6340 static TypeSourceInfo*
6341 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
6342                                               ASTContext &Context,
6343                                               bool &SizeIsNegative,
6344                                               llvm::APSInt &Oversized) {
6345   QualType FixedTy
6346     = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context,
6347                                           SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6348   if (FixedTy.isNull())
6349     return nullptr;
6350   TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy);
6351   FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(),
6352                                     FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc());
6353   return FixedTInfo;
6354 }
6355 
6356 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning
6357 /// true if we were successful.
6358 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo,
6359                                            QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc,
6360                                            unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) {
6361   bool SizeIsNegative;
6362   llvm::APSInt Oversized;
6363   TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(
6364       TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6365   if (FixedTInfo) {
6366     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
6367     TInfo = FixedTInfo;
6368     T = FixedTInfo->getType();
6369     return true;
6370   }
6371 
6372   if (SizeIsNegative)
6373     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size);
6374   else if (Oversized.getBoolValue())
6375     Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10);
6376   else if (FailedFoldDiagID)
6377     Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID);
6378   return false;
6379 }
6380 
6381 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so
6382 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C"
6383 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just
6384 /// function-scope declarations.
6385 void
6386 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) {
6387   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6388       ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit())
6389     // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C.
6390     return;
6391 
6392   // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name.
6393   Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND);
6394 }
6395 
6396 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) {
6397   // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)).
6398   auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name);
6399   return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin();
6400 }
6401 
6402 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that
6403 /// does not identify a function.
6404 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) {
6405   // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid
6406   // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;"
6407   if (DS.isVirtualSpecified())
6408     Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(),
6409          diag::err_virtual_non_function);
6410 
6411   if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier())
6412     Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(),
6413          diag::err_explicit_non_function);
6414 
6415   if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified())
6416     Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(),
6417          diag::err_noreturn_non_function);
6418 }
6419 
6420 NamedDecl*
6421 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC,
6422                              TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) {
6423   // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
6424   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6425     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator)
6426       << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6427     D.setInvalidType();
6428     // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier.
6429     DC = CurContext;
6430     Previous.clear();
6431   }
6432 
6433   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
6434 
6435   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified())
6436     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
6437         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
6438   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier())
6439     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr)
6440         << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
6441 
6442   if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) {
6443     if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName)
6444       Diag(D.getName().StartLocation,
6445            diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier)
6446           << "typedef";
6447     else
6448       Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier)
6449           << D.getName().getSourceRange();
6450     return nullptr;
6451   }
6452 
6453   TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo);
6454   if (!NewTD) return nullptr;
6455 
6456   // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl
6457   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D);
6458 
6459   CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD);
6460 
6461   bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration();
6462   NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration);
6463   D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration);
6464   return ND;
6465 }
6466 
6467 void
6468 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) {
6469   // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type
6470   // then it shall have block scope.
6471   // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so
6472   // that redeclarations will match.
6473   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo();
6474   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
6475   if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
6476     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
6477 
6478     if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) {
6479       bool SizeIsNegative;
6480       llvm::APSInt Oversized;
6481       TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo =
6482         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context,
6483                                                       SizeIsNegative,
6484                                                       Oversized);
6485       if (FixedTInfo) {
6486         Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
6487         NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo);
6488       } else {
6489         if (SizeIsNegative)
6490           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size);
6491         else if (T->isVariableArrayType())
6492           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope);
6493         else if (Oversized.getBoolValue())
6494           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large)
6495             << toString(Oversized, 10);
6496         else
6497           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope);
6498         NewTD->setInvalidDecl();
6499       }
6500     }
6501   }
6502 }
6503 
6504 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which
6505 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via
6506 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'.
6507 NamedDecl*
6508 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD,
6509                            LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) {
6510 
6511   // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope.
6512   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous);
6513 
6514   // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is
6515   // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing.
6516   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false,
6517                        /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false);
6518   filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous);
6519   if (!Previous.empty()) {
6520     Redeclaration = true;
6521     MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous);
6522   } else {
6523     inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD);
6524   }
6525 
6526   if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration)
6527     CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous);
6528 
6529   // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context.
6530   if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier())
6531     if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() &&
6532         NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
6533       if (II->isStr("FILE"))
6534         Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD);
6535       else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf"))
6536         Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD);
6537       else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf"))
6538         Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD);
6539       else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t"))
6540         Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD);
6541     }
6542 
6543   return NewTD;
6544 }
6545 
6546 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope
6547 /// previous declaration.
6548 ///
6549 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a
6550 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a
6551 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new
6552 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with
6553 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99
6554 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6).
6555 ///
6556 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name
6557 /// lookup
6558 ///
6559 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being
6560 /// declared.
6561 ///
6562 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration
6563 /// for a new delcaration with the same name.
6564 static bool
6565 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC,
6566                                 ASTContext &Context) {
6567   if (!PrevDecl)
6568     return false;
6569 
6570   if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage())
6571     return false;
6572 
6573   if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6574     // C++ [basic.link]p6:
6575     //   If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage
6576     //   having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared
6577     //   outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block
6578     //   scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the
6579     //   linkage of the previous declaration.
6580     DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext();
6581     if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
6582       // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations.
6583       return false;
6584 
6585     DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext();
6586     if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord())
6587       // We found a member function: ignore it.
6588       return false;
6589 
6590     // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and
6591     // previous declarations.
6592     OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
6593     PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
6594 
6595     // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it
6596     // isn't the same function.
6597     if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext))
6598       return false;
6599   }
6600 
6601   return true;
6602 }
6603 
6604 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) {
6605   CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec();
6606   if (!SS.isSet()) return;
6607   DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context));
6608 }
6609 
6610 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) {
6611   QualType type = decl->getType();
6612   Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime();
6613   if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
6614     // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing.
6615     unsigned kind = -1U;
6616     if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) {
6617       if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
6618         kind = 0; // __block
6619       else if (!var->hasLocalStorage())
6620         kind = 1; // global
6621     } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) {
6622       kind = 3; // ivar
6623     } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) {
6624       kind = 2; // field
6625     }
6626 
6627     if (kind != -1U) {
6628       Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var)
6629         << kind;
6630     }
6631   } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) {
6632     // Try to infer lifetime.
6633     if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType())
6634       return false;
6635 
6636     lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime();
6637     type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime);
6638     decl->setType(type);
6639   }
6640 
6641   if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) {
6642     // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime.
6643     if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone &&
6644         var->getTLSKind()) {
6645       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership)
6646         << var->getType();
6647       return true;
6648     }
6649   }
6650 
6651   return false;
6652 }
6653 
6654 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) {
6655   if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace())
6656     return;
6657   if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType())
6658     return;
6659   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) {
6660     QualType Type = Var->getType();
6661     if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType())
6662       return;
6663     LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private;
6664     // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the
6665     // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space
6666     // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside
6667     // a function are inferred to be __global.
6668     if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) &&
6669         Var->hasGlobalStorage())
6670       ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global;
6671     // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array
6672     // type has no address space yet, deduce it now.
6673     if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) {
6674       auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType();
6675       if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) {
6676         // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate
6677         // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`.
6678         OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS);
6679         OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0);
6680         // Re-generate the decayed type.
6681         Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy);
6682       }
6683     }
6684     Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS);
6685     // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to
6686     // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of
6687     // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so
6688     // qualified, not the array type."
6689     if (Type->isArrayType())
6690       Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0);
6691     Decl->setType(Type);
6692   }
6693 }
6694 
6695 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) {
6696   // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache
6697   // the wrong linkage.
6698   assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0);
6699 
6700   // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage.
6701   if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) {
6702     if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6703       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static);
6704       ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>();
6705     }
6706   }
6707   if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) {
6708     if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6709       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static);
6710       ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>();
6711       ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
6712     }
6713   }
6714 
6715   if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) {
6716     if (VD->hasInit()) {
6717       if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
6718         assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
6719                !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!");
6720         S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0;
6721         VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
6722       }
6723     }
6724   }
6725 
6726   // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations.
6727   // It does not apply to functions.
6728   if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) {
6729     if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6730       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(),
6731              diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data);
6732       ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>();
6733     }
6734   }
6735 
6736   if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) {
6737     auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND);
6738     bool IsAnonymousNS = false;
6739     bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft();
6740     if (VD) {
6741       const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext());
6742       while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) {
6743         IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace();
6744         NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent());
6745       }
6746     }
6747     // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external
6748     // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported.
6749     // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have
6750     // external linkage in order to be exported.
6751     bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft;
6752     if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) ||
6753         (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode &&
6754          (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) {
6755       S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern)
6756         << &ND << Attr;
6757       ND.setInvalidDecl();
6758     }
6759   }
6760 
6761   // Check the attributes on the function type, if any.
6762   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) {
6763     // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement;
6764     // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the
6765     // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769.
6766     AttributedTypeLoc ATL;
6767     for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
6768          (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>());
6769          TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) {
6770       // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object
6771       // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor)
6772       // by applying it to the function type.
6773       if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) {
6774         const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
6775         if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) {
6776           S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param)
6777               << !MD << A->getRange();
6778         } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) {
6779           S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor)
6780               << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange();
6781         }
6782       }
6783     }
6784   }
6785 }
6786 
6787 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl,
6788                                            NamedDecl *NewDecl,
6789                                            bool IsSpecialization,
6790                                            bool IsDefinition) {
6791   if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl())
6792     return;
6793 
6794   bool IsTemplate = false;
6795   if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) {
6796     OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl();
6797     IsTemplate = true;
6798     if (!IsSpecialization)
6799       IsDefinition = false;
6800   }
6801   if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6802     NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl();
6803     IsTemplate = true;
6804   }
6805 
6806   if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl)
6807     return;
6808 
6809   const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6810   const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>();
6811   const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6812   const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>();
6813 
6814   // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude
6815   // inherited attribute instances.
6816   bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) ||
6817                     (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited());
6818 
6819   // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute,
6820   // the only exception being explicit specializations.
6821   // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there
6822   // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport.
6823   bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr;
6824 
6825   if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) {
6826     // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables.
6827     bool JustWarn = false;
6828     if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) {
6829       auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl);
6830       if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate())
6831         JustWarn = true;
6832       auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl);
6833       if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate)
6834         JustWarn = true;
6835     }
6836 
6837     // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already
6838     // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo
6839     // address equality) as they can use the thunk.
6840     if (OldDecl->isUsed())
6841       if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr)
6842         JustWarn = false;
6843 
6844     unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration
6845                                : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration;
6846     S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID)
6847         << NewDecl
6848         << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr);
6849     S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6850     if (!JustWarn) {
6851       NewDecl->setInvalidDecl();
6852       return;
6853     }
6854   }
6855 
6856   // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only
6857   // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function
6858   // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or
6859   // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if
6860   // it were marked dllexport.
6861   bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false;
6862   bool IsMicrosoftABI  = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols();
6863   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6864     // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed
6865     // separately.
6866     IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember();
6867     IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) !=
6868                    VarDecl::DeclarationOnly;
6869   } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6870     IsInline = FD->isInlined();
6871     IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() &&
6872                         FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared;
6873   }
6874 
6875   if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr &&
6876       (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember &&
6877       !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) {
6878     if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) {
6879       S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6880              diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute)
6881           << NewDecl;
6882       S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6883       NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6884       NewDecl->addAttr(
6885           DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange()));
6886     } else {
6887       S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6888              diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored)
6889           << NewDecl << OldImportAttr;
6890       S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6891       S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute);
6892       OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6893       NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6894     }
6895   } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) {
6896     // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport
6897     // attribute.
6898     OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6899     NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6900     S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6901            diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function)
6902         << NewDecl << OldImportAttr;
6903   }
6904 
6905   // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here
6906   // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the
6907   // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically
6908   // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later.
6909   if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6910     if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization &&
6911         !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) {
6912       if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr =
6913               MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
6914         DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context);
6915         NewAttr->setInherited(true);
6916         NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr);
6917       }
6918     }
6919   }
6920 }
6921 
6922 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function,
6923 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the
6924 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes?
6925 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) {
6926   // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction.
6927 
6928   // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword.
6929   if (!FD->isInlined()) return false;
6930 
6931   // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute.
6932   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
6933     return false;
6934 
6935   // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function.
6936   return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally;
6937 }
6938 
6939 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching
6940 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that
6941 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally
6942 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer.
6943 ///
6944 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a
6945 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration.
6946 ///
6947 /// For instance:
6948 ///
6949 ///   auto x = []{};
6950 ///
6951 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally
6952 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage.
6953 ///
6954 /// FIXME: This is a hack.
6955 template<typename T>
6956 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) {
6957   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6958     // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C".
6959     if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
6960       return false;
6961 
6962     // So do CUDA's host/device attributes.
6963     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() ||
6964                                  D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()))
6965       return false;
6966   }
6967   return D->isExternC();
6968 }
6969 
6970 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) {
6971   const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
6972   if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) ||
6973       isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC))
6974     return VD->hasExternalStorage();
6975   if (DC->isFileContext())
6976     return true;
6977   if (DC->isRecord())
6978     return false;
6979   if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC))
6980     return false;
6981   llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context");
6982 }
6983 
6984 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
6985   const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
6986   if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() ||
6987       isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC))
6988     return true;
6989   if (DC->isRecord())
6990     return false;
6991   llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context");
6992 }
6993 
6994 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD,
6995                           ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) {
6996   // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec.
6997   if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind))
6998     return true;
6999 
7000   // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type
7001   // position to the decl itself.
7002   for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) {
7003     if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind))
7004       return true;
7005   }
7006 
7007   // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself.
7008   return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind) ||
7009          PD.getDeclarationAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind);
7010 }
7011 
7012 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a
7013 /// function-local external declaration.
7014 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) {
7015   if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod())
7016     return false;
7017 
7018   // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function
7019   // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is
7020   // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now.
7021   if (DC->isDependentContext())
7022     return true;
7023 
7024   // C++11 [basic.link]p7:
7025   //   When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to
7026   //   refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the
7027   //   innermost enclosing namespace.
7028   //
7029   // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a
7030   // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one.
7031   while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC))
7032     DC = DC->getParent();
7033   return true;
7034 }
7035 
7036 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage.
7037 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) {
7038   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D))
7039     return FD->isExternC();
7040   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
7041     return VD->isExternC();
7042 
7043   llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!");
7044 }
7045 
7046 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed.
7047 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) {
7048   DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext();
7049   QualType R = NewVD->getType();
7050 
7051   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument.
7052   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function
7053   // argument.
7054   if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) {
7055     Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(),
7056             diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter)
7057         << R;
7058     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7059     return false;
7060   }
7061 
7062   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r:
7063   // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable.
7064   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q:
7065   // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program
7066   // scope.
7067   if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
7068     if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) {
7069       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(),
7070               diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var)
7071           << R;
7072       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7073       return false;
7074     }
7075   }
7076 
7077   // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed.
7078   if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers",
7079                                                Se.getLangOpts())) {
7080     QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType();
7081     while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() ||
7082            NR->isReferenceType()) {
7083       if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() ||
7084           NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) {
7085         Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer)
7086             << NR->isReferenceType();
7087         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7088         return false;
7089       }
7090       NR = NR->getPointeeType();
7091     }
7092   }
7093 
7094   if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16",
7095                                                Se.getLangOpts())) {
7096     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and
7097     // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled).
7098     if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) {
7099       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R;
7100       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7101       return false;
7102     }
7103   }
7104 
7105   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r:
7106   // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global
7107   // address space qualifiers.
7108   if (R->isEventT()) {
7109     if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) {
7110       Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual);
7111       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7112       return false;
7113     }
7114   }
7115 
7116   if (R->isSamplerT()) {
7117     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4:
7118     // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address
7119     // space qualifiers.
7120     if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local ||
7121         R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) {
7122       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace);
7123       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7124     }
7125 
7126     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1:
7127     // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address
7128     // space qualifier or with the const qualifier.
7129     if (DC->isTranslationUnit() &&
7130         !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
7131           R.isConstQualified())) {
7132       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler);
7133       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7134     }
7135     if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7136       return false;
7137   }
7138 
7139   return true;
7140 }
7141 
7142 template <typename AttrTy>
7143 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) {
7144   const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl();
7145   if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) {
7146     AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context);
7147     Clone->setInherited(true);
7148     D->addAttr(Clone);
7149   }
7150 }
7151 
7152 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator(
7153     Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7154     LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists,
7155     bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) {
7156   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
7157   DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName();
7158 
7159   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
7160 
7161   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
7162     // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic
7163     // purposes.
7164     auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator();
7165     if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) {
7166       II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name;
7167       Name = II;
7168     }
7169   } else if (!II) {
7170     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name;
7171     return nullptr;
7172   }
7173 
7174 
7175   DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec();
7176   StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec());
7177 
7178   // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We
7179   // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext.
7180   if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() &&
7181       hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) &&
7182       !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport))
7183     SC = SC_Extern;
7184 
7185   DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC;
7186   bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern &&
7187                            adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC);
7188 
7189   if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) {
7190     // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always
7191     // an error here
7192     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
7193     D.setInvalidType();
7194     SC = SC_None;
7195   }
7196 
7197   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register &&
7198       !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(
7199                               D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) {
7200     // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated.
7201     // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some
7202     // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro.
7203     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7204          getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class
7205                                    : diag::warn_deprecated_register)
7206       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7207   }
7208 
7209   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
7210 
7211   if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) {
7212     // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not
7213     // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration.
7214     // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support.
7215     if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) {
7216       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope);
7217       D.setInvalidType();
7218     }
7219   }
7220 
7221   // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to
7222   // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid.
7223   if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType())
7224     tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7225                                     /*DiagID=*/0);
7226 
7227   bool IsMemberSpecialization = false;
7228   bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false;
7229   bool IsPartialSpecialization = false;
7230   bool IsVariableTemplate = false;
7231   VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr;
7232   VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr;
7233   TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr;
7234   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7235     NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7236                             II, R, TInfo, SC);
7237 
7238     if (R->getContainedDeducedType())
7239       ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD);
7240 
7241     if (D.isInvalidType())
7242       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7243 
7244     if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() &&
7245         NewVD->hasLocalStorage())
7246       checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(),
7247                             NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct);
7248   } else {
7249     bool Invalid = false;
7250 
7251     if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) {
7252       // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member.
7253       switch (SC) {
7254       case SC_None:
7255         break;
7256       case SC_Static:
7257         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7258              diag::err_static_out_of_line)
7259           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7260         break;
7261       case SC_Auto:
7262       case SC_Register:
7263       case SC_Extern:
7264         // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only
7265         // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters.
7266         // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration
7267         // of class members
7268 
7269         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7270              diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member)
7271           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7272         break;
7273       case SC_PrivateExtern:
7274         llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!");
7275       }
7276     }
7277 
7278     if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) {
7279       if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
7280         // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are
7281         // incompatible with static data members.
7282         const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr;
7283         const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr;
7284         for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) {
7285           if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
7286             FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt;
7287             break;
7288           }
7289           const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt);
7290           if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) {
7291             AnonStruct = ParentDecl;
7292             break;
7293           }
7294         }
7295         if (FunctionOrMethod) {
7296           // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data
7297           // members.
7298           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7299                diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class)
7300             << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind();
7301         } else if (AnonStruct) {
7302           // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained
7303           // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain
7304           // static data members.
7305           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7306                diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct)
7307             << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind();
7308           Invalid = true;
7309         } else if (RD->isUnion()) {
7310           // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member,
7311           // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction.
7312           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7313                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11
7314                  ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union
7315                  : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name;
7316         }
7317       }
7318     }
7319 
7320     // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then
7321     // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization.
7322     bool InvalidScope = false;
7323     TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
7324         D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7325         D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
7326         D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId
7327             ? D.getName().TemplateId
7328             : nullptr,
7329         TemplateParamLists,
7330         /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope);
7331     Invalid |= InvalidScope;
7332 
7333     if (TemplateParams) {
7334       if (!TemplateParams->size() &&
7335           D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
7336         // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain
7337         // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable.
7338         Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(),
7339              diag::err_template_variable_noparams)
7340           << II
7341           << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(),
7342                          TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc());
7343         TemplateParams = nullptr;
7344       } else {
7345         // Check that we can declare a template here.
7346         if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams))
7347           return nullptr;
7348 
7349         if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
7350           // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization.
7351           IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true;
7352           IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0;
7353         } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0)
7354           // This is a template declaration.
7355           IsVariableTemplate = true;
7356 
7357           // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651).
7358           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7359                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14
7360                    ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template
7361                    : diag::ext_variable_template);
7362         }
7363       }
7364     } else {
7365       // Check that we can declare a member specialization here.
7366       if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization &&
7367           CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back()))
7368         return nullptr;
7369       assert((Invalid ||
7370               D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) &&
7371              "should have a 'template<>' for this decl");
7372     }
7373 
7374     if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) {
7375       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc =
7376           TemplateParamLists.size() > 0
7377               ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc()
7378               : SourceLocation();
7379       DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization(
7380           S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC,
7381           IsPartialSpecialization);
7382       if (Res.isInvalid())
7383         return nullptr;
7384       NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get());
7385       AddToScope = false;
7386     } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
7387       NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
7388                                         D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC,
7389                                         Bindings);
7390     } else
7391       NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
7392                               D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC);
7393 
7394     // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such.
7395     if (IsVariableTemplate) {
7396       NewTemplate =
7397           VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name,
7398                                   TemplateParams, NewVD);
7399       NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate);
7400     }
7401 
7402     // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the
7403     // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer.
7404     if (R->getContainedDeducedType())
7405       ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD);
7406 
7407     if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) {
7408       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7409       if (NewTemplate)
7410         NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
7411     }
7412 
7413     SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D);
7414 
7415     // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to
7416     // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them.
7417     unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0;
7418     if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists)
7419       NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(
7420           Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists));
7421   }
7422 
7423   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) {
7424     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7425       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
7426           << 0;
7427     } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
7428       // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration.
7429       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
7430            diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name
7431         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc());
7432     } else {
7433       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
7434            getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable
7435                                      : diag::ext_inline_variable);
7436       NewVD->setInlineSpecified();
7437     }
7438   }
7439 
7440   // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the
7441   // lexical context will be different from the semantic context.
7442   NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
7443   if (NewTemplate)
7444     NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
7445 
7446   if (IsLocalExternDecl) {
7447     if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator())
7448       for (auto *B : Bindings)
7449         B->setLocalExternDecl();
7450     else
7451       NewVD->setLocalExternDecl();
7452   }
7453 
7454   bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false;
7455   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) {
7456     // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4:
7457     //   When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the
7458     //   storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear
7459     //   explicitly.
7460     // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared
7461     //   'extern'.
7462     if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() &&
7463         (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified ||
7464          TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local ||
7465          !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()))
7466       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7467            diag::err_thread_non_global)
7468         << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
7469     else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) {
7470       if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice ||
7471           getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) {
7472         // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to
7473         // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the
7474         // error should be ignored.
7475         EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true;
7476         // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with
7477         // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going
7478         // to emit any code for it.
7479         NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS);
7480       } else
7481         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7482              diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7483     } else
7484       NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS);
7485   }
7486 
7487   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) {
7488   case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified:
7489     break;
7490 
7491   case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval:
7492     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7493          diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
7494         << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
7495     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
7496 
7497   case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr:
7498     NewVD->setConstexpr(true);
7499     // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1:
7500     //   A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is
7501     //   implicitly an inline variable.
7502     if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() &&
7503         (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ||
7504          Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()))
7505       NewVD->setImplicitlyInline();
7506     break;
7507 
7508   case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit:
7509     if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())
7510       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7511            diag::err_constinit_local_variable);
7512     else
7513       NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create(
7514           Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7515           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit));
7516     break;
7517   }
7518 
7519   // C99 6.7.4p3
7520   //   An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall
7521   //   not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or
7522   //   thread storage duration...
7523   // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined
7524   // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'.  Note
7525   // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to
7526   // be marked 'static'.  Also note that it's possible to get these
7527   // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)).
7528   if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr &&
7529       !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) {
7530     FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl();
7531     if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) {
7532       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7533            diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline);
7534       MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD);
7535     }
7536   }
7537 
7538   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
7539     if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization)
7540       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
7541           << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0)
7542           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
7543                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7544     else if (IsMemberSpecialization)
7545       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
7546         << 2
7547         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7548     else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage())
7549       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
7550           << 0 << NewVD
7551           << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
7552           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
7553                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7554     else {
7555       NewVD->setModulePrivate();
7556       if (NewTemplate)
7557         NewTemplate->setModulePrivate();
7558       for (auto *B : Bindings)
7559         B->setModulePrivate();
7560     }
7561   }
7562 
7563   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
7564     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD);
7565 
7566     DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec();
7567     if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) {
7568       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7569            diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier)
7570           << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString()
7571           << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1;
7572       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7573     }
7574   }
7575 
7576   // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl
7577   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D);
7578 
7579   // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should
7580   // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function
7581   // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally
7582   // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen.
7583   if (R->isFunctionPointerType())
7584     if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>())
7585       copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT);
7586 
7587   if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice ||
7588       getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) {
7589     if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError &&
7590         ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) ||
7591          (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
7592           OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD))))
7593       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7594            diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7595 
7596     if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError &&
7597         (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice)))
7598       targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7599     // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static
7600     // storage [duration]."
7601     if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr &&
7602         (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() ||
7603          NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) {
7604       NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static);
7605     }
7606   }
7607 
7608   // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as
7609   // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can
7610   // check the VarDecl itself.
7611   assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() ||
7612          NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() ||
7613          NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None);
7614 
7615   // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of
7616   // retainable type.
7617   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD))
7618     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7619 
7620   // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute).
7621   if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) {
7622     // The parser guarantees this is a string.
7623     StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
7624     StringRef Label = SE->getString();
7625     if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) {
7626       switch (SC) {
7627       case SC_None:
7628       case SC_Auto:
7629         Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label;
7630         break;
7631       case SC_Register:
7632         // Local Named register
7633         if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) &&
7634             DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl()))
7635           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label;
7636         break;
7637       case SC_Static:
7638       case SC_Extern:
7639       case SC_PrivateExtern:
7640         break;
7641       }
7642     } else if (SC == SC_Register) {
7643       // Global Named register
7644       if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) {
7645         const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo();
7646         bool HasSizeMismatch;
7647 
7648         if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label))
7649           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label;
7650         else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label,
7651                                                     Context.getTypeSize(R),
7652                                                     HasSizeMismatch))
7653           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label;
7654         else if (HasSizeMismatch)
7655           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label;
7656       }
7657 
7658       if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) {
7659         Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type);
7660         NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true);
7661       }
7662     }
7663 
7664     NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label,
7665                                         /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true,
7666                                         SE->getStrTokenLoc(0)));
7667   } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) {
7668     llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I =
7669       ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier());
7670     if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) {
7671       if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) {
7672         NewVD->addAttr(I->second);
7673         ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I);
7674       } else
7675         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
7676             << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD;
7677     }
7678   }
7679 
7680   // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope.
7681   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty()
7682                                 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)
7683                                 : nullptr;
7684 
7685   // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different
7686   // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new
7687   // declaration has linkage).
7688   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD),
7689                        D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() ||
7690                        IsMemberSpecialization ||
7691                        IsVariableTemplateSpecialization);
7692 
7693   // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This
7694   // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3.
7695   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
7696       NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage())
7697     NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope(
7698         Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() &&
7699         isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false));
7700 
7701   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7702     D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous));
7703   } else {
7704     // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it.
7705     if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() &&
7706         CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous))
7707       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7708 
7709     // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate.
7710     if (!Previous.empty()) {
7711       if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
7712           isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) &&
7713           D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
7714         // The user tried to define a non-static data member
7715         // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
7716         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line)
7717           << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
7718         Previous.clear();
7719         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7720       }
7721     } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
7722       // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope.
7723       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
7724         << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true)
7725         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
7726       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7727     }
7728 
7729     if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization)
7730       D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous));
7731 
7732     if (NewTemplate) {
7733       VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate =
7734           NewVD->getPreviousDecl()
7735               ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate()
7736               : nullptr;
7737 
7738       // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly
7739       // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable
7740       // template declaration.
7741       if (CheckTemplateParameterList(
7742               TemplateParams,
7743               PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters()
7744                               : nullptr,
7745               (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() &&
7746                DC->isDependentContext())
7747                   ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember
7748                   : TPC_VarTemplate))
7749         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7750 
7751       // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable
7752       // template, make a note of that.
7753       if (PrevVarTemplate &&
7754           PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate())
7755         PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization();
7756     }
7757   }
7758 
7759   // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration.
7760   if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration())
7761     CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous);
7762 
7763   ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD);
7764 
7765   // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update
7766   // the map of such variables.
7767   if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() &&
7768       isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD))
7769     RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S);
7770 
7771   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
7772     MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
7773     Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
7774     std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
7775         getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext());
7776     if (MCtx) {
7777       Context.setManglingNumber(
7778           NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
7779                      NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S)));
7780       Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD));
7781     }
7782   }
7783 
7784   // Special handling of variable named 'main'.
7785   if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") &&
7786       NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
7787       !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) {
7788 
7789     // C++ [basic.start.main]p3
7790     // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed.
7791     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
7792       Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable);
7793 
7794     // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined
7795     // behavior.
7796     else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage())
7797       Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined);
7798   }
7799 
7800   if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) {
7801     NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
7802     checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization,
7803                                    D.isFunctionDefinition());
7804   }
7805 
7806   if (NewTemplate) {
7807     if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7808       NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
7809     ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate);
7810     return NewTemplate;
7811   }
7812 
7813   if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7814     CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous);
7815 
7816   return NewVD;
7817 }
7818 
7819 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow.
7820 enum ShadowedDeclKind {
7821   SDK_Local,
7822   SDK_Global,
7823   SDK_StaticMember,
7824   SDK_Field,
7825   SDK_Typedef,
7826   SDK_Using,
7827   SDK_StructuredBinding
7828 };
7829 
7830 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing.
7831 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
7832                                                 const DeclContext *OldDC) {
7833   if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7834     return SDK_Using;
7835   else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7836     return SDK_Typedef;
7837   else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7838     return SDK_StructuredBinding;
7839   else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC))
7840     return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember;
7841 
7842   return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local;
7843 }
7844 
7845 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given
7846 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise.
7847 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
7848                                          const VarDecl *VD) {
7849   for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) {
7850     if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD)
7851       return Capture.getLocation();
7852   }
7853   return SourceLocation();
7854 }
7855 
7856 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags,
7857                                      const LookupResult &R) {
7858   // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable.
7859   if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found)
7860     return false;
7861 
7862   // Return false if warning is ignored.
7863   return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc());
7864 }
7865 
7866 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
7867 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7868 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D,
7869                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7870   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7871     return nullptr;
7872 
7873   // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope.
7874   if (D->hasGlobalStorage())
7875     return nullptr;
7876 
7877   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7878   return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl
7879                                                             : nullptr;
7880 }
7881 
7882 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null
7883 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7884 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D,
7885                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7886   // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class
7887   if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord())
7888     return nullptr;
7889 
7890   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7891     return nullptr;
7892 
7893   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7894   return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr;
7895 }
7896 
7897 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
7898 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7899 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D,
7900                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7901   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7902     return nullptr;
7903 
7904   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7905   return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl
7906                                                             : nullptr;
7907 }
7908 
7909 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing.  Implements
7910 /// -Wshadow.
7911 ///
7912 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful"
7913 /// scope.
7914 ///
7915 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable
7916 /// \param R the lookup of the name
7917 ///
7918 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
7919                        const LookupResult &R) {
7920   DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext();
7921 
7922   if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) {
7923     // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods.
7924     if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC))
7925       if (MD->isStatic())
7926         return;
7927 
7928     // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually
7929     // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter.
7930     if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC))
7931       if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) {
7932         // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its
7933         // modification or its existence depending on warning settings.
7934         ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD});
7935         return;
7936       }
7937   }
7938 
7939   if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7940     if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) {
7941       // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global
7942       // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration.
7943       for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls())
7944         if (I->isFileVarDecl()) {
7945           ShadowedDecl = I;
7946           break;
7947         }
7948     }
7949 
7950   DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
7951 
7952   unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow;
7953   SourceLocation CaptureLoc;
7954   if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC &&
7955       isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) {
7956     if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) {
7957       if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) {
7958         if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) {
7959           // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list.
7960           const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction());
7961           // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly.
7962           CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl));
7963           if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
7964             WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local;
7965         } else {
7966           // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the
7967           // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it.
7968           cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction())
7969               ->ShadowingDecls.push_back(
7970                   {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)});
7971           return;
7972         }
7973       }
7974 
7975       if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) {
7976         // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if
7977         // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context.
7978         for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC;
7979              ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC);
7980              ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) {
7981           // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions
7982           // can capture; other scopes don't.
7983           if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) &&
7984               !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) {
7985             return;
7986           }
7987         }
7988       }
7989     }
7990   }
7991 
7992   // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members.
7993   if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) {
7994     // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members.
7995     if (!OldDC->isRecord())
7996       return;
7997 
7998     // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing
7999     // static data members from base classes?
8000 
8001     // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members.
8002     // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the
8003     // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative.
8004   }
8005 
8006 
8007   DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
8008 
8009   // Emit warning and note.
8010   ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC);
8011   Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC;
8012   if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
8013     Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here)
8014         << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1;
8015   Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
8016 }
8017 
8018 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD
8019 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda.
8020 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) {
8021   for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) {
8022     const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl;
8023     // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured.
8024     SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl);
8025     const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext();
8026     Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid()
8027                                        ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local
8028                                        : diag::warn_decl_shadow)
8029         << Shadow.VD->getDeclName()
8030         << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC;
8031     if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
8032       Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here)
8033           << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0;
8034     Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
8035   }
8036 }
8037 
8038 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup.
8039 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) {
8040   if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation()))
8041     return;
8042 
8043   LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(),
8044                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
8045   LookupName(R, S);
8046   if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R))
8047     CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R);
8048 }
8049 
8050 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers
8051 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field.
8052 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8053   // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters.
8054   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty())
8055     return;
8056   E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8057   auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
8058   if (!DRE)
8059     return;
8060   const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
8061   auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D);
8062   if (I == ShadowingDecls.end())
8063     return;
8064   const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second;
8065   const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext();
8066   Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC;
8067   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D;
8068   Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
8069 
8070   // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl.
8071   ShadowingDecls.erase(I);
8072 }
8073 
8074 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and
8075 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++.
8076 template<typename T>
8077 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(
8078     Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) {
8079   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\"");
8080   NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName());
8081 
8082   if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) {
8083     // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C"
8084     // declaration.
8085     return false;
8086   }
8087 
8088   if (Prev) {
8089     if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) {
8090       // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a
8091       // redeclaration.
8092       Previous.clear();
8093       Previous.addDecl(Prev);
8094       return true;
8095     }
8096 
8097     // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous
8098     // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable
8099     // declaration.
8100     if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND))
8101       return false;
8102   } else {
8103     // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the
8104     // translation unit which might conflict.
8105     if (IsGlobal) {
8106       // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit.
8107       IsGlobal = false;
8108       for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end();
8109            I != E; ++I) {
8110         if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) {
8111           Prev = *I;
8112           break;
8113         }
8114       }
8115     } else {
8116       DeclContext::lookup_result R =
8117           S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName());
8118       for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end();
8119            I != E; ++I) {
8120         if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) {
8121           Prev = *I;
8122           break;
8123         }
8124         // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope,
8125         // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the
8126         // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name
8127         // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a
8128         // diagnostic.
8129       }
8130     }
8131 
8132     if (!Prev)
8133       return false;
8134   }
8135 
8136   // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which
8137   // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec.
8138   assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose");
8139   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev))
8140     Prev = FD->getFirstDecl();
8141   else
8142     Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl();
8143 
8144   S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict)
8145     << IsGlobal << ND;
8146   S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict)
8147     << IsGlobal;
8148   return false;
8149 }
8150 
8151 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true
8152 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity.
8153 ///
8154 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6:
8155 ///   Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage
8156 ///   with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same
8157 ///   [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with
8158 ///   the same name as an entity in global scope.
8159 template<typename T>
8160 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND,
8161                                                   LookupResult &Previous) {
8162   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8163     // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern'
8164     // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because
8165     // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext.
8166     if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
8167       if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) {
8168         Previous.clear();
8169         Previous.addDecl(Prev);
8170         return true;
8171       }
8172     }
8173     return false;
8174   }
8175 
8176   // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C"
8177   // declaration.
8178   if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit())
8179     return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous);
8180 
8181   // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the
8182   // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration
8183   // in another scope.
8184   if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND))
8185     return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous);
8186 
8187   // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do.
8188   return false;
8189 }
8190 
8191 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) {
8192   // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it.
8193   if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
8194     return;
8195 
8196   QualType T = NewVD->getType();
8197 
8198   // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached.
8199   if (T->isUndeducedType())
8200     return;
8201 
8202   if (NewVD->hasAttrs())
8203     CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD);
8204 
8205   if (T->isObjCObjectType()) {
8206     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object)
8207       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*");
8208     T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
8209     NewVD->setType(T);
8210   }
8211 
8212   // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage.
8213   // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not
8214   // automatic variables that point to other address spaces.
8215   // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2
8216   if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() &&
8217       T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
8218     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0;
8219     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8220     return;
8221   }
8222 
8223   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program
8224   // scope.
8225   if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 &&
8226       !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers",
8227                                             getLangOpts()) &&
8228       NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
8229     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope);
8230     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8231     return;
8232   }
8233 
8234   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8235     if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD))
8236       return;
8237 
8238     // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported.
8239     if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8240       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type);
8241       return;
8242     }
8243 
8244     if (T->isBlockPointerType()) {
8245       // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and
8246       // can't use 'extern' storage class.
8247       if (!T.isConstQualified()) {
8248         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration)
8249             << 0 /*const*/;
8250         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8251         return;
8252       }
8253       if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) {
8254         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration);
8255         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8256         return;
8257       }
8258     }
8259 
8260     // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense.
8261     if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() ||
8262         NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) {
8263       if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() &&
8264           !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
8265             (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global &&
8266              getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(
8267                  getLangOpts())))) {
8268         int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1;
8269         if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()))
8270           Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space)
8271               << Scope << "global or constant";
8272         else
8273           Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space)
8274               << Scope << "constant";
8275         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8276         return;
8277       }
8278     } else {
8279       if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) {
8280         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8281             << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global";
8282         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8283         return;
8284       }
8285       if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
8286           T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) {
8287         FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl();
8288         // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables
8289         // in functions.
8290         if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8291           if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant)
8292             Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8293                 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant";
8294           else
8295             Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8296                 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local";
8297           NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8298           return;
8299         }
8300         // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be
8301         // in the outermost scope of a kernel function.
8302         if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8303           if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) {
8304             if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant)
8305               Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope)
8306                   << "constant";
8307             else
8308               Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope)
8309                   << "local";
8310             NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8311             return;
8312           }
8313         }
8314       } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private &&
8315                  // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr
8316                  // space yet.
8317                  T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
8318         // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable.
8319         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1;
8320         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8321         return;
8322       }
8323     }
8324   }
8325 
8326   if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak()
8327       && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8328     if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
8329       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local);
8330     else {
8331       assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
8332       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local);
8333     }
8334   }
8335 
8336   bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType();
8337   if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() ||
8338       NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
8339     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
8340 
8341   if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) ||
8342       (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) {
8343     bool SizeIsNegative;
8344     llvm::APSInt Oversized;
8345     TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(
8346         NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
8347     QualType FixedT;
8348     if (FixedTInfo &&  T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType())
8349       FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType();
8350     else if (FixedTInfo) {
8351       // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up
8352       // both types separately.
8353       FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative,
8354                                                    Oversized);
8355     }
8356     if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) {
8357       const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T);
8358       // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for
8359       // int a[10][n];
8360       SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange();
8361 
8362       if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl())
8363         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope)
8364         << SizeRange;
8365       else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal())
8366         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage)
8367         << SizeRange;
8368       else
8369         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage)
8370         << SizeRange;
8371       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8372       return;
8373     }
8374 
8375     if (!FixedTInfo) {
8376       if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl())
8377         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope);
8378       else
8379         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage);
8380       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8381       return;
8382     }
8383 
8384     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
8385     NewVD->setType(FixedT);
8386     NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo);
8387   }
8388 
8389   if (T->isVoidType()) {
8390     // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names
8391     //                    of objects and functions.
8392     if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8393       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
8394         << T;
8395       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8396       return;
8397     }
8398   }
8399 
8400   if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8401     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal);
8402     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8403     return;
8404   }
8405 
8406   if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) {
8407     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T;
8408     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8409     return;
8410   }
8411 
8412   if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8413     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm);
8414     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8415     return;
8416   }
8417 
8418   if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() &&
8419       RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T,
8420                          diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) {
8421     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8422     return;
8423   }
8424 
8425   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types.
8426   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
8427       !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() &&
8428       CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) {
8429     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8430     return;
8431   }
8432 }
8433 
8434 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable
8435 /// declaration.
8436 ///
8437 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a
8438 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to
8439 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators
8440 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables
8441 /// that have been instantiated from a template.
8442 ///
8443 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered.
8444 ///
8445 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration.
8446 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) {
8447   CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD);
8448 
8449   // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it.
8450   if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
8451     return false;
8452 
8453   // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible
8454   // extern "C" declaration with the same name.
8455   if (Previous.empty() &&
8456       checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous))
8457     Previous.setShadowed();
8458 
8459   if (!Previous.empty()) {
8460     MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous);
8461     return true;
8462   }
8463   return false;
8464 }
8465 
8466 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes,
8467 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it.
8468 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) {
8469   llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden;
8470 
8471   // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override.
8472   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false,
8473                      /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
8474   auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) {
8475     CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
8476     DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName();
8477 
8478     if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
8479       // We really want to find the base class destructor here.
8480       QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord);
8481       CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T);
8482       Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT);
8483     }
8484 
8485     for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) {
8486       CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD =
8487           dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl());
8488       if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() ||
8489           IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false,
8490                      /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true,
8491                      // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires
8492                      // clauses when overriding.
8493                      /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false))
8494         continue;
8495 
8496       if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) {
8497         MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD);
8498         CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD);
8499         CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD);
8500         CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD);
8501         CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD);
8502       }
8503 
8504       // A method can only override one function from each base class. We
8505       // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases.
8506       return true;
8507     }
8508 
8509     return false;
8510   };
8511 
8512   DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths);
8513   return !Overridden.empty();
8514 }
8515 
8516 namespace {
8517   // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by
8518   // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator.
8519   struct ActOnFDArgs {
8520     Scope *S;
8521     Declarator &D;
8522     MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists;
8523     bool AddToScope;
8524   };
8525 } // end anonymous namespace
8526 
8527 namespace {
8528 
8529 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance.
8530 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl.
8531 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
8532  public:
8533   DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD,
8534                             CXXRecordDecl *Parent)
8535       : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD),
8536         ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {}
8537 
8538   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
8539     if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0)
8540       return false;
8541 
8542     SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams;
8543     for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(),
8544                                           CDeclEnd = candidate.end();
8545          CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) {
8546       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl);
8547 
8548       if (FD && !FD->hasBody() &&
8549           hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8550         if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8551           CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent();
8552           if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent)
8553             return true;
8554         } else if (!ExpectedParent) {
8555           return true;
8556         }
8557       }
8558     }
8559 
8560     return false;
8561   }
8562 
8563   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
8564     return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this);
8565   }
8566 
8567  private:
8568   ASTContext &Context;
8569   FunctionDecl *OriginalFD;
8570   CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent;
8571 };
8572 
8573 } // end anonymous namespace
8574 
8575 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) {
8576   TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F);
8577 }
8578 
8579 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration.
8580 ///
8581 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid
8582 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations
8583 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with
8584 /// the same name.
8585 ///
8586 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in
8587 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors.
8588 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
8589     Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
8590     ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) {
8591   DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName();
8592   DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext();
8593   SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams;
8594   SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches;
8595   TypoCorrection Correction;
8596   bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition();
8597   unsigned DiagMsg =
8598     IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend :
8599     NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match :
8600     diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match;
8601   LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(),
8602                     IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName
8603                                   : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
8604                     Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
8605 
8606   NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
8607   if (IsLocalFriend)
8608     SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S);
8609   else
8610     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC);
8611   assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() &&
8612          "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup");
8613   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD);
8614   DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD,
8615                                 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr);
8616   if (!Prev.empty()) {
8617     for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end();
8618          Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) {
8619       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func);
8620       if (FD &&
8621           hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8622         // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't
8623         // involve a parameter
8624         unsigned ParamNum =
8625             MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1;
8626         NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum));
8627       }
8628     }
8629   // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction
8630   } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo(
8631                   Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S,
8632                   &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery,
8633                   IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) {
8634     // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator
8635     ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(),
8636                               ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc());
8637     Previous.clear();
8638     Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection());
8639     for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(),
8640                                     CDeclEnd = Correction.end();
8641          CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) {
8642       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl);
8643       if (FD && !FD->hasBody() &&
8644           hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8645         Previous.addDecl(FD);
8646       }
8647     }
8648     bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration();
8649 
8650     NamedDecl *Result;
8651     // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous
8652     // declarations, and with errors suppressed.
8653     {
8654       // Trap errors.
8655       Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef);
8656 
8657       // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the
8658       // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully
8659       // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs.
8660       Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator(
8661           ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D,
8662           Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(),
8663           NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists,
8664           ExtraArgs.AddToScope);
8665 
8666       if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
8667         Result = nullptr;
8668     }
8669 
8670     if (Result) {
8671       // Determine which correction we picked.
8672       Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl();
8673       for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end();
8674            I != E; ++I)
8675         if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical)
8676           Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I);
8677 
8678       // Let Sema know about the correction.
8679       SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result);
8680       SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(
8681           Correction,
8682           SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend
8683                           ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest
8684                           : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest)
8685             << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition);
8686       return Result;
8687     }
8688 
8689     // Pretend the typo correction never occurred
8690     ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(),
8691                               ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc());
8692     ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration);
8693     Previous.clear();
8694     Previous.setLookupName(Name);
8695   }
8696 
8697   SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg)
8698       << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation();
8699 
8700   bool NewFDisConst = false;
8701   if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD))
8702     NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst();
8703 
8704   for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator
8705        NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end();
8706        NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) {
8707     FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first;
8708     CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
8709     bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst();
8710     bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend;
8711 
8712     // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case.
8713     if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) {
8714       ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1);
8715       SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc();
8716       if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation();
8717       SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match
8718                                  : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match)
8719         << Idx << FDParam->getType()
8720         << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType();
8721     } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) {
8722       SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match)
8723           << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd()
8724           << (NewFDisConst
8725                   ? FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo()
8726                                                  .getConstQualifierLoc())
8727                   : FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo()
8728                                                    .getRParenLoc()
8729                                                    .getLocWithOffset(1),
8730                                                " const"));
8731     } else
8732       SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
8733                    IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match
8734                             : diag::note_local_decl_close_match);
8735   }
8736   return nullptr;
8737 }
8738 
8739 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) {
8740   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) {
8741   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!");
8742   case DeclSpec::SCS_auto:
8743   case DeclSpec::SCS_register:
8744   case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable:
8745     SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
8746                  diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func);
8747     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs();
8748     D.setInvalidType();
8749     break;
8750   case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break;
8751   case DeclSpec::SCS_extern:
8752     if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec())
8753       return SC_None;
8754     return SC_Extern;
8755   case DeclSpec::SCS_static: {
8756     if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
8757       // C99 6.7.1p5:
8758       //   The declaration of an identifier for a function that has
8759       //   block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier
8760       //   other than extern
8761       // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4).
8762       SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
8763                    diag::err_static_block_func);
8764       break;
8765     } else
8766       return SC_Static;
8767   }
8768   case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern;
8769   }
8770 
8771   // No explicit storage class has already been returned
8772   return SC_None;
8773 }
8774 
8775 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D,
8776                                            DeclContext *DC, QualType &R,
8777                                            TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8778                                            StorageClass SC,
8779                                            bool &IsVirtualOkay) {
8780   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D);
8781   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
8782 
8783   FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr;
8784   bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified();
8785 
8786   if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8787     // Determine whether the function was written with a prototype. This is
8788     // true when:
8789     //   - there is a prototype in the declarator, or
8790     //   - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non-
8791     //     attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a
8792     //     function type). Note, we can't always look at the adjusted type to
8793     //     check this case because attributes may cause a non-function
8794     //     declarator to still have a function type. e.g.,
8795     //       typedef void func(int a);
8796     //       __attribute__((noreturn)) func other_func; // This has a prototype
8797     bool HasPrototype =
8798         (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) ||
8799         (D.getDeclSpec().isTypeRep() &&
8800          D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsType().get()->isFunctionProtoType()) ||
8801         (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType());
8802     assert(
8803         (HasPrototype || !SemaRef.getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes()) &&
8804         "Strict prototypes are required");
8805 
8806     NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(
8807         SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC,
8808         SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype,
8809         ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified,
8810         /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr);
8811     if (D.isInvalidType())
8812       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
8813 
8814     return NewFD;
8815   }
8816 
8817   ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier();
8818 
8819   ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier();
8820   if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) {
8821     SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
8822                  diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
8823         << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind);
8824     ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified;
8825     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec();
8826   }
8827   Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause();
8828 
8829   // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type.
8830   // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once
8831   // the class has been completely parsed.
8832   if (!DC->isRecord() &&
8833       SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType(
8834           D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(),
8835           diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType))
8836     D.setInvalidType();
8837 
8838   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) {
8839     // This is a C++ constructor declaration.
8840     assert(DC->isRecord() &&
8841            "Constructors can only be declared in a member context");
8842 
8843     R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8844     return CXXConstructorDecl::Create(
8845         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8846         TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
8847         isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind,
8848         InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause);
8849 
8850   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
8851     // This is a C++ destructor declaration.
8852     if (DC->isRecord()) {
8853       R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8854       CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
8855       CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create(
8856           SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo,
8857           SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8858           /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind,
8859           TrailingRequiresClause);
8860       // User defined destructors start as not selected if the class definition is still
8861       // not done.
8862       if (Record->isBeingDefined())
8863         NewDD->setIneligibleOrNotSelected(true);
8864 
8865       // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it
8866       // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start
8867       // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration.
8868       if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
8869         SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD);
8870 
8871       IsVirtualOkay = true;
8872       return NewDD;
8873 
8874     } else {
8875       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member);
8876       D.setInvalidType();
8877 
8878       // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing
8879       // code path.
8880       return FunctionDecl::Create(
8881           SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R,
8882           TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8883           /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause);
8884     }
8885 
8886   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
8887     if (!DC->isRecord()) {
8888       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
8889            diag::err_conv_function_not_member);
8890       return nullptr;
8891     }
8892 
8893     SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8894     if (D.isInvalidType())
8895       return nullptr;
8896 
8897     IsVirtualOkay = true;
8898     return CXXConversionDecl::Create(
8899         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8900         TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8901         ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(),
8902         TrailingRequiresClause);
8903 
8904   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) {
8905     if (TrailingRequiresClause)
8906       SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(),
8907                    diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide)
8908           << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange();
8909     SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8910 
8911     return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
8912                                          ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo,
8913                                          D.getEndLoc());
8914   } else if (DC->isRecord()) {
8915     // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record,
8916     // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type.
8917     // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a
8918     // constructor if it has no return type).
8919     if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() &&
8920         Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){
8921       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type)
8922         << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc())
8923         << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc());
8924       return nullptr;
8925     }
8926 
8927     // This is a C++ method declaration.
8928     CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create(
8929         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8930         TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8931         ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause);
8932     IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic();
8933     return Ret;
8934   } else {
8935     bool isFriend =
8936         SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
8937     if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord())
8938       return nullptr;
8939 
8940     // Determine whether the function was written with a
8941     // prototype. This true when:
8942     //   - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype),
8943     return FunctionDecl::Create(
8944         SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC,
8945         SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8946         true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause);
8947   }
8948 }
8949 
8950 enum OpenCLParamType {
8951   ValidKernelParam,
8952   PtrPtrKernelParam,
8953   PtrKernelParam,
8954   InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam,
8955   InvalidKernelParam,
8956   RecordKernelParam
8957 };
8958 
8959 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) {
8960   // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types
8961   // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to
8962   // integers other than by their names.
8963   StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"};
8964 
8965   // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef
8966   // for a size dependent type.
8967   QualType DesugaredTy = Ty;
8968   do {
8969     ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames);
8970     auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString());
8971     if (Names.end() != Match)
8972       return true;
8973 
8974     Ty = DesugaredTy;
8975     DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C);
8976   } while (DesugaredTy != Ty);
8977 
8978   return false;
8979 }
8980 
8981 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) {
8982   if (PT->isDependentType())
8983     return InvalidKernelParam;
8984 
8985   if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) {
8986     QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType();
8987     if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic ||
8988         PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private ||
8989         PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default)
8990       return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam;
8991 
8992     if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) {
8993       // This is a pointer to pointer parameter.
8994       // Recursively check inner type.
8995       OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType);
8996       if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam ||
8997           ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam)
8998         return ParamKind;
8999 
9000       return PtrPtrKernelParam;
9001     }
9002 
9003     // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4:
9004     // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be:
9005     // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to
9006     // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters.
9007     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus &&
9008         !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
9009             "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) &&
9010         !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() &&
9011         !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType())
9012       return InvalidKernelParam;
9013 
9014     return PtrKernelParam;
9015   }
9016 
9017   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k:
9018   // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the
9019   // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and
9020   // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one
9021   // of these built-in scalar types.
9022   if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT))
9023     return InvalidKernelParam;
9024 
9025   if (PT->isImageType())
9026     return PtrKernelParam;
9027 
9028   if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT())
9029     return InvalidKernelParam;
9030 
9031   // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5:
9032   // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in
9033   // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc.
9034   if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) &&
9035       PT->isHalfType())
9036     return InvalidKernelParam;
9037 
9038   // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type.
9039   if (PT->isArrayType()) {
9040     const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType();
9041     // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the
9042     // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an
9043     // array, this recursive call only happens once.
9044     return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0));
9045   }
9046 
9047   // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4:
9048   // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be:
9049   // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data
9050   // types) for parameters passed by value;
9051   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus &&
9052       !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
9053           "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) &&
9054       !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context))
9055     return InvalidKernelParam;
9056 
9057   if (PT->isRecordType())
9058     return RecordKernelParam;
9059 
9060   return ValidKernelParam;
9061 }
9062 
9063 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(
9064   Sema &S,
9065   Declarator &D,
9066   ParmVarDecl *Param,
9067   llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) {
9068   QualType PT = Param->getType();
9069 
9070   // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are
9071   // used again
9072   if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr()))
9073     return;
9074 
9075   switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) {
9076   case PtrPtrKernelParam:
9077     // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a:
9078     // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer
9079     // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below.
9080     if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) {
9081       S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param);
9082       D.setInvalidType();
9083       return;
9084     }
9085 
9086     ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr());
9087     return;
9088 
9089   case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam:
9090     // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5:
9091     // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point
9092     // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or
9093     // __constant.
9094     S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space);
9095     D.setInvalidType();
9096     return;
9097 
9098     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k:
9099     // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the
9100     // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and
9101     // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be
9102     // one of these built-in scalar types.
9103 
9104   case InvalidKernelParam:
9105     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n:
9106     // A kernel function argument cannot be declared
9107     // of event_t type.
9108     // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument
9109     // type for any function elsewhere.
9110     if (!PT->isHalfType()) {
9111       S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT;
9112 
9113       // Explain what typedefs are involved.
9114       const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr;
9115       while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) {
9116         SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation();
9117         // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type.
9118         if (Loc.isValid())
9119           S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT;
9120         PT = Typedef->desugar();
9121       }
9122     }
9123 
9124     D.setInvalidType();
9125     return;
9126 
9127   case PtrKernelParam:
9128   case ValidKernelParam:
9129     ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr());
9130     return;
9131 
9132   case RecordKernelParam:
9133     break;
9134   }
9135 
9136   // Track nested structs we will inspect
9137   SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack;
9138 
9139   // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from
9140   // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field.
9141   SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack;
9142   HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr);
9143 
9144   // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or
9145   // an ArrayType of a RecordType.
9146   assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type.");
9147   const RecordType *RecTy =
9148       PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>();
9149   const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl();
9150 
9151   VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl());
9152   assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?");
9153 
9154   do {
9155     const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val();
9156     if (!Next) {
9157       assert(!HistoryStack.empty());
9158       // Found a marker, we have gone up a level
9159       if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val())
9160         ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr());
9161 
9162       continue;
9163     }
9164 
9165     // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a
9166     // field itself) to the history stack.
9167     const RecordDecl *RD;
9168     if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) {
9169       HistoryStack.push_back(Field);
9170 
9171       QualType FieldTy = Field->getType();
9172       // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we
9173       // walk around RecordDecl::fields().
9174       assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) &&
9175              "Unexpected type.");
9176       const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType();
9177 
9178       RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
9179     } else {
9180       RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next);
9181     }
9182 
9183     // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level
9184     VisitStack.push_back(nullptr);
9185 
9186     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
9187       QualType QT = FD->getType();
9188 
9189       if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr()))
9190         continue;
9191 
9192       OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT);
9193       if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam)
9194         continue;
9195 
9196       if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) {
9197         VisitStack.push_back(FD);
9198         continue;
9199       }
9200 
9201       // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p:
9202       // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union
9203       // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or
9204       // union.
9205       if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam ||
9206           ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) {
9207         S.Diag(Param->getLocation(),
9208                diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param)
9209           << PT->isUnionType()
9210           << PT;
9211       } else {
9212         S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT;
9213       }
9214 
9215       S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type)
9216           << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName();
9217 
9218       // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where
9219       // the offending field came from
9220       for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator
9221                I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1,
9222                E = HistoryStack.end();
9223            I != E; ++I) {
9224         const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I;
9225         S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type)
9226           << OuterField->getType();
9227       }
9228 
9229       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here)
9230         << QT->isPointerType()
9231         << QT;
9232       D.setInvalidType();
9233       return;
9234     }
9235   } while (!VisitStack.empty());
9236 }
9237 
9238 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an
9239 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds
9240 /// nothing.
9241 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) {
9242   while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())
9243     DC = DC->getParent();
9244   return DC;
9245 }
9246 
9247 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an
9248 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds
9249 /// nothing.
9250 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
9251   while (S->isClassScope() ||
9252          (LangOpts.CPlusPlus &&
9253           S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) ||
9254          ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) ||
9255          (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()))
9256     S = S->getParent();
9257   return S;
9258 }
9259 
9260 /// Determine whether a declaration matches a known function in namespace std.
9261 static bool isStdBuiltin(ASTContext &Ctx, FunctionDecl *FD,
9262                          unsigned BuiltinID) {
9263   switch (BuiltinID) {
9264   case Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo:
9265     // No type checking whatsoever.
9266     return Ctx.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft();
9267 
9268   case Builtin::BIaddressof:
9269   case Builtin::BI__addressof:
9270   case Builtin::BIforward:
9271   case Builtin::BImove:
9272   case Builtin::BImove_if_noexcept:
9273   case Builtin::BIas_const: {
9274     // Ensure that we don't treat the algorithm
9275     //   OutputIt std::move(InputIt, InputIt, OutputIt)
9276     // as the builtin std::move.
9277     const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9278     return FPT->getNumParams() == 1 && !FPT->isVariadic();
9279   }
9280 
9281   default:
9282     return false;
9283   }
9284 }
9285 
9286 NamedDecl*
9287 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC,
9288                               TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous,
9289                               MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef,
9290                               bool &AddToScope) {
9291   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
9292 
9293   assert(R->isFunctionType());
9294   if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr())
9295     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call);
9296 
9297   SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists;
9298   llvm::append_range(TemplateParamLists, TemplateParamListsRef);
9299   if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) {
9300     if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() &&
9301         Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth())
9302       TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented;
9303     else
9304       TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented);
9305   }
9306 
9307   // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic.
9308   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D);
9309   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
9310   StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D);
9311 
9312   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec())
9313     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
9314          diag::err_invalid_thread)
9315       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
9316 
9317   if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember())
9318     adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(),
9319                            D.getIdentifierLoc());
9320 
9321   bool isFriend = false;
9322   FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr;
9323   bool isMemberSpecialization = false;
9324   bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false;
9325 
9326   bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false;
9327   bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9328   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs;
9329 
9330   bool isVirtualOkay = false;
9331 
9332   DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC;
9333   bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC);
9334 
9335   FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC,
9336                                               isVirtualOkay);
9337   if (!NewFD) return nullptr;
9338 
9339   if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer())
9340     NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
9341 
9342   // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a
9343   // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical
9344   // context will be different from the semantic context.
9345   NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
9346 
9347   if (IsLocalExternDecl)
9348     NewFD->setLocalExternDecl();
9349 
9350   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9351     bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified();
9352     bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified();
9353     bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier();
9354     isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
9355     if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9356       // C++ [class.friend]p5
9357       //   A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a
9358       //   class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline.
9359       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9360     }
9361 
9362     // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor
9363     // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already
9364     // return true).
9365     if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent =
9366           dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) {
9367       if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided())
9368         NewFD->setPure(true);
9369 
9370       // C++ [class.union]p2
9371       //   A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions.
9372       if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) {
9373         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union);
9374         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9375       }
9376       if ((Parent->isClass() || Parent->isStruct()) &&
9377           Parent->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>() &&
9378           NewFD->getKind() == Decl::Kind::CXXMethod && NewFD->getIdentifier() &&
9379           NewFD->getName() == "__init" && D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9380         if (auto *Def = Parent->getDefinition())
9381           Def->setInitMethod(true);
9382       }
9383     }
9384 
9385     SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D);
9386     isMemberSpecialization = false;
9387     isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false;
9388     if (D.isInvalidType())
9389       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9390 
9391     // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then
9392     // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization.
9393     bool Invalid = false;
9394     TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams =
9395         MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
9396             D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
9397             D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
9398             D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId
9399                 ? D.getName().TemplateId
9400                 : nullptr,
9401             TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization,
9402             Invalid);
9403     if (TemplateParams) {
9404       // Check that we can declare a template here.
9405       if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams))
9406         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9407 
9408       if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) {
9409         // This is a function template
9410 
9411         // A destructor cannot be a template.
9412         if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
9413           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template);
9414           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9415         }
9416 
9417         // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to
9418         // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list,
9419         // now that we know what the current instantiation is.
9420         if (DC->isDependentContext()) {
9421           ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC);
9422           if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams))
9423             Invalid = true;
9424         }
9425 
9426         FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC,
9427                                                         NewFD->getLocation(),
9428                                                         Name, TemplateParams,
9429                                                         NewFD);
9430         FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
9431         NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate);
9432 
9433         // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists.
9434         if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) {
9435           NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context,
9436               ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists)
9437                   .drop_back(1));
9438         }
9439       } else {
9440         // This is a function template specialization.
9441         isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true;
9442         // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists.
9443         if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0)
9444           NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists);
9445 
9446         // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);".
9447         if (isFriend) {
9448           // We want to remove the "template<>", found here.
9449           SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange();
9450 
9451           // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a
9452           // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem:
9453           // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl,
9454           // and clearly the user wants a template specialization.  So
9455           // we need to insert '<>' after the name.
9456           SourceLocation InsertLoc;
9457           if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
9458             InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd();
9459             InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc);
9460           }
9461 
9462           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend)
9463             << Name << RemoveRange
9464             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange)
9465             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>");
9466           Invalid = true;
9467         }
9468       }
9469     } else {
9470       // Check that we can declare a template here.
9471       if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization &&
9472           CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back()))
9473         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9474 
9475       // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier:
9476       // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template.
9477       if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0)
9478         // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists.
9479         NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists);
9480     }
9481 
9482     if (Invalid) {
9483       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9484       if (FunctionTemplate)
9485         FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
9486     }
9487 
9488     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5:
9489     //   The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of
9490     //   nonstatic class member functions that appear within a
9491     //   member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3.
9492     //
9493     if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9494       if (!isVirtualOkay) {
9495         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9496              diag::err_virtual_non_function);
9497       } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) {
9498         // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class.
9499         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9500              diag::err_virtual_out_of_class)
9501           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc());
9502       } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
9503         // C++ [temp.mem]p3:
9504         //  A member function template shall not be virtual.
9505         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9506              diag::err_virtual_member_function_template)
9507           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc());
9508       } else {
9509         // Okay: Add virtual to the method.
9510         NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true);
9511       }
9512 
9513       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
9514           NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType())
9515         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual);
9516     }
9517 
9518     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
9519         (NewFD->isDependentContext() ||
9520          (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) &&
9521         NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) {
9522       // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a
9523       // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type.
9524       // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane
9525       // thing to do.
9526       // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being
9527       // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work.
9528       const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
9529           NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9530       QualType Result = SubstAutoTypeDependent(FPT->getReturnType());
9531       NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(),
9532                                              FPT->getExtProtoInfo()));
9533     }
9534 
9535     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3:
9536     //  The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function
9537     //  declaration.
9538     if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9539       if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
9540         // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration.
9541         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
9542              diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name
9543           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc());
9544       }
9545     }
9546 
9547     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6:
9548     //  The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a
9549     //  constructor or conversion function within its class definition;
9550     //  see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2.
9551     if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9552         !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) {
9553       if (!CurContext->isRecord()) {
9554         // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class.
9555         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(),
9556              diag::err_explicit_out_of_class)
9557             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange());
9558       } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) &&
9559                  !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) {
9560         // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor
9561         // or conversion function.
9562         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(),
9563              diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function)
9564             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange());
9565       }
9566     }
9567 
9568     ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier();
9569     if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) {
9570       // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors
9571       // are implicitly inline.
9572       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9573 
9574       // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to
9575       // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore,
9576       // destructors cannot be declared constexpr.
9577       if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) &&
9578           (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 ||
9579            ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) {
9580         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor)
9581             << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind);
9582         NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
9583                                     ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified
9584                                     : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr);
9585       }
9586       // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a
9587       // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval
9588       // specifier.
9589       if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval &&
9590           (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New ||
9591            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New ||
9592            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete ||
9593            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) {
9594         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
9595              diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind)
9596             << NewFD;
9597         NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr);
9598       }
9599     }
9600 
9601     // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly.
9602     if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
9603       if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9604         SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc
9605           = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc();
9606         Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization)
9607           << 0
9608           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc);
9609       } else {
9610         NewFD->setModulePrivate();
9611         if (FunctionTemplate)
9612           FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate();
9613       }
9614     }
9615 
9616     if (isFriend) {
9617       if (FunctionTemplate) {
9618         FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl();
9619         FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public);
9620       }
9621       NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl();
9622       NewFD->setAccess(AS_public);
9623     }
9624 
9625     // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now.
9626     // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later.
9627     switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) {
9628     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration:
9629     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition:
9630       break;
9631 
9632     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted:
9633       NewFD->setDefaulted();
9634       break;
9635 
9636     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted:
9637       NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten();
9638       break;
9639     }
9640 
9641     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext &&
9642         D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9643       // C++ [class.mfct]p2:
9644       //   A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in
9645       //   which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2)
9646       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9647     }
9648 
9649     if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) &&
9650         !CurContext->isRecord()) {
9651       // C++ [class.static]p1:
9652       //   A data or function member of a class may be declared static
9653       //   in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of
9654       //   the class.
9655 
9656       // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line
9657       // member function definition.
9658 
9659       // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line
9660       // member function template declaration and class member template
9661       // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this.
9662       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
9663            ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) &&
9664              cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) ||
9665            (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()))
9666            ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line)
9667         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9668     }
9669 
9670     // C++11 [except.spec]p15:
9671     //   A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated
9672     //   as if it were specified with noexcept(true).
9673     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9674     if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete ||
9675          Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) &&
9676         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec())
9677       NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(
9678           FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(),
9679           FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept)));
9680   }
9681 
9682   // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope.
9683   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD),
9684                        D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() ||
9685                        isMemberSpecialization ||
9686                        isFunctionTemplateSpecialization);
9687 
9688   // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute).
9689   if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) {
9690     // The parser guarantees this is a string.
9691     StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
9692     NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(),
9693                                         /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true,
9694                                         SE->getStrTokenLoc(0)));
9695   } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) {
9696     llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I =
9697       ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier());
9698     if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) {
9699       if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) {
9700         NewFD->addAttr(I->second);
9701         ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I);
9702       } else
9703         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
9704             << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD;
9705     }
9706   }
9707 
9708   // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function
9709   // declaration NewFD, if they are available.  First scavenge them into Params.
9710   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
9711   unsigned FTIIdx;
9712   if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) {
9713     DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun;
9714 
9715     // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs
9716     // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a
9717     // single void argument.
9718     // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator
9719     // already checks for that case.
9720     if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) {
9721       for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) {
9722         ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param);
9723         assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?");
9724         Param->setDeclContext(NewFD);
9725         Params.push_back(Param);
9726 
9727         if (Param->isInvalidDecl())
9728           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9729       }
9730     }
9731 
9732     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9733       // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them
9734       // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag
9735       // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always
9736       // the TU.
9737       DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext =
9738           getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext());
9739       for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) {
9740         auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl);
9741 
9742         // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum
9743         // instead.
9744         if (!TD) {
9745           if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl))
9746             TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext());
9747         }
9748         if (!TD)
9749           continue;
9750         DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext();
9751         if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD))
9752           continue;
9753         TagDC->removeDecl(TD);
9754         TD->setDeclContext(NewFD);
9755         NewFD->addDecl(TD);
9756 
9757         // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag
9758         // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of
9759         // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the
9760         // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f:
9761         //   void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s);
9762         if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext)
9763           TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC);
9764       }
9765     }
9766   } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
9767     // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the
9768     // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed)
9769     // parameters for use in the declaration.
9770     //
9771     // @code
9772     // typedef void fn(int);
9773     // fn f;
9774     // @endcode
9775 
9776     // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type.
9777     for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
9778       ParmVarDecl *Param =
9779           BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI);
9780       Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
9781       Params.push_back(Param);
9782     }
9783   } else {
9784     assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 &&
9785            "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn");
9786   }
9787 
9788   // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them.
9789   NewFD->setParams(Params);
9790 
9791   if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified())
9792     NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context,
9793                                            D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(),
9794                                            AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword));
9795 
9796   // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2
9797   // because all functions have linkage.
9798   if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9799       NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
9800     Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl);
9801     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9802   }
9803 
9804   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active
9805   if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9806       !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>())
9807     NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
9808         Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName,
9809         PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
9810 
9811   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active.
9812   if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9813       !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
9814     NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
9815         Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
9816         CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma,
9817         SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate));
9818     if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
9819                      ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute |
9820                          ASTContext::PSF_Read,
9821                      NewFD))
9822       NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>();
9823   }
9824 
9825   // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or
9826   // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active.
9827   if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
9828     if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD,
9829                                                                  D.isFunctionDefinition())) {
9830       NewFD->addAttr(SAttr);
9831     }
9832   }
9833 
9834   // Handle attributes.
9835   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D);
9836 
9837   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
9838     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return
9839     // type declaration will generate a compilation error.
9840     LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace();
9841     if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) {
9842       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9843            diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space);
9844       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9845     }
9846   }
9847 
9848   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9849     // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration.
9850     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain())
9851       CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec());
9852 
9853     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
9854       CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD);
9855 
9856     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
9857       D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous,
9858                                                   isMemberSpecialization,
9859                                                   D.isFunctionDefinition()));
9860     else if (!Previous.empty())
9861       // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration.
9862       D.setRedeclaration(true);
9863     assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() ||
9864             Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) &&
9865            "previous declaration set still overloaded");
9866 
9867     // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that
9868     // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging
9869     // possibly prototyped redeclarations.
9870     const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
9871     if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9872       CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC();
9873       if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) {
9874         // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without
9875         // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning.
9876         int DiagID =
9877             CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr;
9878         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID)
9879             << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC);
9880       }
9881     }
9882 
9883    if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
9884        NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
9885      checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(),
9886                            NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
9887                            NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
9888   } else {
9889     // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3:
9890     //  The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline.
9891     //
9892     // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340.
9893     //
9894     // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since
9895     // that forces an external definition to be emitted.
9896     if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() &&
9897         NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() &&
9898         !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9899       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
9900            diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline)
9901         << NewFD->getDeclName();
9902 
9903     // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template
9904     // argument list into our AST format.
9905     if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
9906       TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId;
9907       TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
9908       TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
9909       ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
9910                                          TemplateId->NumArgs);
9911       translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr,
9912                                  TemplateArgs);
9913 
9914       HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true;
9915 
9916       if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9917         HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9918       } else if (FunctionTemplate) {
9919         // Function template with explicit template arguments.
9920         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec)
9921           << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
9922 
9923         HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9924       } else {
9925         assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization ||
9926                 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) &&
9927                "should have a 'template<>' for this decl");
9928         // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl.
9929         isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true;
9930       }
9931     } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9932       // This combination is only possible in a recovery case;  the user
9933       // wrote something like:
9934       //   template <> friend void foo(int);
9935       // which we're recovering from as if the user had written:
9936       //   friend void foo<>(int);
9937       // Go ahead and fake up a template id.
9938       HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true;
9939       TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc());
9940       TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc());
9941     }
9942 
9943     // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because
9944     // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their
9945     // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied,
9946     // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a
9947     // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template
9948     // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below.
9949     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization)
9950       maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous);
9951 
9952     // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible
9953     // that either the specialized function type or the specialized
9954     // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail.  In
9955     // this case, don't check the specialization yet.
9956     if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend &&
9957         (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() ||
9958          TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments(
9959              TemplateArgs.arguments()))) {
9960       assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs &&
9961              "friend function specialization without template args");
9962       if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs,
9963                                                        Previous))
9964         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9965     } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9966       if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord()
9967           && !isFriend) {
9968         isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true;
9969       } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9970                  CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9971                      NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr),
9972                      Previous))
9973         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9974 
9975       // C++ [dcl.stc]p1:
9976       //   A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit
9977       //   specialization (14.7.3)
9978       FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info =
9979           NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo();
9980       if (Info && SC != SC_None) {
9981         if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass())
9982           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9983                diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class)
9984             << SC
9985             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
9986                                       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9987 
9988         else
9989           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9990                diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class)
9991             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
9992                                       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9993       }
9994     } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
9995       if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous))
9996           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9997     }
9998 
9999     // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration.
10000     if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
10001       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain())
10002         CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec());
10003 
10004       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
10005         CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD);
10006 
10007       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10008         D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous,
10009                                                     isMemberSpecialization,
10010                                                     D.isFunctionDefinition()));
10011       else if (!Previous.empty())
10012         // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration.
10013         D.setRedeclaration(true);
10014     }
10015 
10016     assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() ||
10017             Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) &&
10018            "previous declaration set still overloaded");
10019 
10020     NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate
10021                                 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate)
10022                                 : NewFD);
10023 
10024     if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) {
10025       AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public;
10026       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10027         Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess();
10028 
10029       NewFD->setAccess(Access);
10030       if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access);
10031     }
10032 
10033     if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() &&
10034         PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary))
10035       PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator();
10036 
10037     // If we have a function template, check the template parameter
10038     // list. This will check and merge default template arguments.
10039     if (FunctionTemplate) {
10040       FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate =
10041                                      FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl();
10042       CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
10043                        PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters()
10044                                     : nullptr,
10045                             D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()
10046                               ? (D.isFunctionDefinition()
10047                                    ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition
10048                                    : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate)
10049                               : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() &&
10050                                  DC && DC->isRecord() &&
10051                                  DC->isDependentContext())
10052                                   ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember
10053                                   : TPC_FunctionTemplate);
10054     }
10055 
10056     if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
10057       // Ignore all the rest of this.
10058     } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) {
10059       struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists,
10060                                        AddToScope };
10061       // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member.
10062       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext()))
10063         NewFD->setAccess(AS_public);
10064 
10065       // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration.
10066       if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
10067         // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or
10068         // dependent-scope friend declarations.
10069 
10070         // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent
10071         // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when
10072         // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be
10073         // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor.  But there
10074         // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we
10075         // can actually do this check immediately.
10076         //
10077         // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified
10078         // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now;
10079         // nothing will diagnose that error later.
10080         if (isFriend &&
10081             (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() ||
10082              (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) {
10083           // ignore these
10084         } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
10085                    NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) {
10086           // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new
10087           // versions of the function.
10088         } else {
10089           // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a
10090           // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there
10091           // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2,
10092           // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example:
10093           //
10094           // class X {
10095           //   void f() const;
10096           // };
10097           //
10098           // void X::f() { } // ill-formed
10099           //
10100           // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close
10101           // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and
10102           // whether the parameter types are references).
10103 
10104           if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
10105                   *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) {
10106             AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope;
10107             return Result;
10108           }
10109         }
10110 
10111         // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve
10112         // to something.
10113       } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) {
10114         if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
10115                 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) {
10116           AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope;
10117           return Result;
10118         }
10119       }
10120     } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
10121                isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() &&
10122                !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization &&
10123                !isMemberSpecialization) {
10124       // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a
10125       // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2).
10126       // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of
10127       // function templates or member functions of class templates, per
10128       // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an
10129       // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to
10130       // generate them.
10131       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration)
10132         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
10133     }
10134   }
10135 
10136   // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add
10137   // attributes as appropriate.
10138   if (!D.isRedeclaration()) {
10139     if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) {
10140       if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
10141         bool InStdNamespace = Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID);
10142         if (!InStdNamespace &&
10143             NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) {
10144           if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) {
10145             // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as
10146             // matching regardless of its declared type.
10147             if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) {
10148               NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
10149             } else {
10150               ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error;
10151               LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID);
10152               QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error);
10153 
10154               if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() &&
10155                   Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(
10156                       NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType))
10157                 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
10158             }
10159           }
10160         } else if (InStdNamespace && NewFD->isInStdNamespace() &&
10161                    isStdBuiltin(Context, NewFD, BuiltinID)) {
10162           NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
10163         }
10164       }
10165     }
10166   }
10167 
10168   ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD);
10169   checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD);
10170 
10171   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD);
10172 
10173   if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() &&
10174       !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10175     Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
10176          diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype)
10177       << NewFD;
10178 
10179     // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters.
10180     const auto *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
10181     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI(
10182         Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false));
10183     EPI.Variadic = true;
10184     EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo();
10185 
10186     QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI);
10187     NewFD->setType(R);
10188   }
10189 
10190   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class
10191   // member, set the visibility of this function.
10192   if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible())
10193     AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD);
10194 
10195   // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider
10196   // marking the function.
10197   AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD);
10198 
10199   // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply any
10200   // attributes (i.e. optnone and no_builtin) due to a pragma.
10201   if (D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
10202     AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD);
10203     AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(NewFD);
10204     AddSectionMSAllocText(NewFD);
10205     ModifyFnAttributesMSPragmaOptimize(NewFD);
10206   }
10207 
10208   // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update
10209   // the map of such variables.
10210   if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
10211       isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD))
10212     RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S);
10213 
10214   // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren.
10215   NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd());
10216 
10217   if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) {
10218     NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
10219     checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD,
10220                                    isMemberSpecialization ||
10221                                        isFunctionTemplateSpecialization,
10222                                    D.isFunctionDefinition());
10223   }
10224 
10225   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
10226     IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier();
10227     if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) &&
10228         !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
10229         NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
10230       if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType())
10231         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return)
10232             << getCudaConfigureFuncName();
10233       Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD);
10234     }
10235 
10236     // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed
10237     // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed
10238     // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions.
10239     if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() &&
10240         (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() ||
10241          NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) &&
10242         !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() &&
10243           !D.isFunctionDefinition())) {
10244       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn);
10245     }
10246   }
10247 
10248   MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD);
10249 
10250 
10251 
10252   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
10253     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions.
10254     if (SC == SC_Static) {
10255       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel);
10256       D.setInvalidType();
10257     }
10258 
10259     // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void.
10260     if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) {
10261       SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
10262       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type)
10263           << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void")
10264                                 : FixItHint());
10265       D.setInvalidType();
10266     }
10267 
10268     llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes;
10269     for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters())
10270       checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes);
10271 
10272     if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) {
10273       if (DC->isRecord()) {
10274         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel);
10275         D.setInvalidType();
10276       }
10277       if (FunctionTemplate) {
10278         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel);
10279         D.setInvalidType();
10280       }
10281     }
10282   }
10283 
10284   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10285     if (FunctionTemplate) {
10286       if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10287         FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
10288       return FunctionTemplate;
10289     }
10290 
10291     if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10292       CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous);
10293   }
10294 
10295   for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) {
10296     QualType PT = Param->getType();
10297 
10298     // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value
10299     // types.
10300     if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) {
10301       if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) {
10302         QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType();
10303           if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) {
10304             Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type );
10305             D.setInvalidType();
10306           }
10307       }
10308     }
10309   }
10310 
10311   // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope.
10312   // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation
10313   // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node.
10314   if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
10315     ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec =
10316                          ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create(
10317                                 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(),
10318                                 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD),
10319                                 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs);
10320     CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec);
10321     AddToScope = false;
10322   }
10323 
10324   // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions
10325   // that are run during load/unload.
10326   if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) {
10327     if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) {
10328       Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer)
10329           << 1;
10330       NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>();
10331     }
10332     if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) {
10333       Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer)
10334           << 2;
10335       NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>();
10336     }
10337   }
10338 
10339   // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a
10340   // definition.
10341   // FIXME: We should really be doing this in
10342   // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to
10343   // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code
10344   // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false`
10345   // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet.
10346   if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>())
10347     switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) {
10348     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted:
10349     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted:
10350       Diag(NBA->getLocation(),
10351            diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function)
10352           << NBA->getSpelling();
10353       break;
10354     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration:
10355       Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition)
10356           << NBA->getSpelling();
10357       break;
10358     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition:
10359       break;
10360     }
10361 
10362   return NewFD;
10363 }
10364 
10365 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class.  The Microsoft docs say
10366 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of
10367 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special
10368 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment."
10369 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler
10370 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg.
10371 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer
10372 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See:
10373 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer
10374 /// available since MS has removed the page.
10375 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10376   const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
10377   if (!Method)
10378     return nullptr;
10379   const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent();
10380   if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
10381     Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext());
10382     NewAttr->setImplicit(true);
10383     return NewAttr;
10384   }
10385 
10386   // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg
10387   // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active.
10388   if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue)
10389    return nullptr;
10390 
10391   while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) {
10392     if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
10393       Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext());
10394       NewAttr->setImplicit(true);
10395       return NewAttr;
10396     }
10397   }
10398   return nullptr;
10399 }
10400 
10401 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a
10402 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the
10403 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack
10404 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value).
10405 ///
10406 /// \param FD Function being declared.
10407 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion.
10408 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or
10409 ///          nullptr if no attribute should be added.
10410 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
10411                                                        bool IsDefinition) {
10412   if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD))
10413     return A;
10414   if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition &&
10415       CodeSegStack.CurrentValue)
10416     return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
10417         getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
10418         CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma,
10419         SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate);
10420   return nullptr;
10421 }
10422 
10423 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a
10424 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a
10425 /// best-effort check.
10426 ///
10427 /// \param NewD The new declaration.
10428 /// \param OldD The old declaration.
10429 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check.
10430 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check.
10431 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD,
10432                                           QualType NewT, QualType OldT) {
10433   if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10434     return true;
10435 
10436   // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't
10437   // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation:
10438   //
10439   //   int f();
10440   //   template<typename T> void g() { T f(); }
10441   //
10442   // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int).
10443   if (NewT->isDependentType() &&
10444       (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind()))
10445     return false;
10446 
10447   // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern
10448   // declaration, we don't really know its type yet.
10449   if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl())
10450     return false;
10451 
10452   return true;
10453 }
10454 
10455 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be
10456 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration.
10457 ///
10458 /// \param D Declaration that is checked.
10459 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the
10460 ///                 same declaration name.
10461 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl
10462 ///          belongs to.
10463 ///
10464 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) {
10465   if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10466     return true;
10467 
10468   // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to
10469   // permit cases like
10470   //
10471   //   void func();
10472   //   template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} };
10473   //   template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} };
10474   //
10475   // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated.
10476   //
10477   // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy
10478   // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply
10479   // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in
10480   // the way of access checks.
10481   if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
10482     return false;
10483 
10484   auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
10485   auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl);
10486   return !VD || !PrevVD ||
10487          canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(),
10488                                         PrevVD->getType());
10489 }
10490 
10491 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion
10492 /// validity.
10493 ///
10494 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10495 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10496   const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10497   assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute");
10498   ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse();
10499   const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo();
10500   enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 };
10501 
10502   if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() &&
10503       !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) {
10504     S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10505         << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture;
10506     return true;
10507   }
10508 
10509   for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) {
10510     auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1);
10511     if (Feat[0] == '-') {
10512       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10513           << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str();
10514       return true;
10515     }
10516 
10517     if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) ||
10518         !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) {
10519       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10520           << Feature << BareFeat;
10521       return true;
10522     }
10523   }
10524   return false;
10525 }
10526 
10527 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with
10528 // multiversion functions.
10529 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind,
10530                                            MultiVersionKind MVKind) {
10531   // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in
10532   // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame.
10533   switch (Kind) {
10534   default:
10535     return false;
10536   case attr::Used:
10537     return MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target;
10538   case attr::NonNull:
10539   case attr::NoThrow:
10540     return true;
10541   }
10542 }
10543 
10544 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S,
10545                                                  const FunctionDecl *FD,
10546                                                  const FunctionDecl *CausedFD,
10547                                                  MultiVersionKind MVKind) {
10548   const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, MVKind](Sema &S, const Attr *A) {
10549     S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr)
10550         << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind) << A;
10551     if (CausedFD)
10552       S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10553     return true;
10554   };
10555 
10556   for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) {
10557     switch (A->getKind()) {
10558     case attr::CPUDispatch:
10559     case attr::CPUSpecific:
10560       if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10561           MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific)
10562         return Diagnose(S, A);
10563       break;
10564     case attr::Target:
10565       if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::Target)
10566         return Diagnose(S, A);
10567       break;
10568     case attr::TargetClones:
10569       if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones)
10570         return Diagnose(S, A);
10571       break;
10572     default:
10573       if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVKind))
10574         return Diagnose(S, A);
10575       break;
10576     }
10577   }
10578   return false;
10579 }
10580 
10581 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(
10582     const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10583     const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID,
10584     const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt,
10585     const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt,
10586     const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported,
10587     bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) {
10588   enum DoesntSupport {
10589     FuncTemplates = 0,
10590     VirtFuncs = 1,
10591     DeducedReturn = 2,
10592     Constructors = 3,
10593     Destructors = 4,
10594     DeletedFuncs = 5,
10595     DefaultedFuncs = 6,
10596     ConstexprFuncs = 7,
10597     ConstevalFuncs = 8,
10598     Lambda = 9,
10599   };
10600   enum Different {
10601     CallingConv = 0,
10602     ReturnType = 1,
10603     ConstexprSpec = 2,
10604     InlineSpec = 3,
10605     Linkage = 4,
10606     LanguageLinkage = 5,
10607   };
10608 
10609   if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD &&
10610       !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10611     Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID);
10612     Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second);
10613     return true;
10614   }
10615 
10616   if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 &&
10617       !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10618     return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID);
10619 
10620   if (!TemplatesSupported &&
10621       NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
10622     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10623            << FuncTemplates;
10624 
10625   if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
10626     if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual())
10627       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10628              << VirtFuncs;
10629 
10630     if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD))
10631       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10632              << Constructors;
10633 
10634     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD))
10635       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10636              << Destructors;
10637   }
10638 
10639   if (NewFD->isDeleted())
10640     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10641            << DeletedFuncs;
10642 
10643   if (NewFD->isDefaulted())
10644     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10645            << DefaultedFuncs;
10646 
10647   if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr())
10648     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10649            << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs);
10650 
10651   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType());
10652   const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType);
10653   QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType();
10654 
10655   if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType())
10656     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10657            << DeducedReturn;
10658 
10659   // Ensure the return type is identical.
10660   if (OldFD) {
10661     QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType());
10662     const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType);
10663     FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo();
10664     FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo();
10665 
10666     if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC())
10667       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv;
10668 
10669     QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType();
10670 
10671     if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType)
10672       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType;
10673 
10674     if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind())
10675       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec;
10676 
10677     if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified())
10678       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec;
10679 
10680     if (OldFD->getFormalLinkage() != NewFD->getFormalLinkage())
10681       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage;
10682 
10683     if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC())
10684       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << LanguageLinkage;
10685 
10686     if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(
10687             OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(),
10688             NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation()))
10689       return true;
10690   }
10691   return false;
10692 }
10693 
10694 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD,
10695                                              const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10696                                              bool CausesMV,
10697                                              MultiVersionKind MVKind) {
10698   if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) {
10699     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported);
10700     if (OldFD)
10701       S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10702     return true;
10703   }
10704 
10705   bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind =
10706       MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch ||
10707       MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific;
10708 
10709   if (CausesMV && OldFD &&
10710       checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind))
10711     return true;
10712 
10713   if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVKind))
10714     return true;
10715 
10716   // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used.
10717   if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false))
10718     return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used);
10719 
10720   return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(
10721       OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto),
10722       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10723                           S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)),
10724       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10725                           S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support)
10726                               << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind)),
10727       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10728                           S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)),
10729       /*TemplatesSupported=*/false,
10730       /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind,
10731       /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false);
10732 }
10733 
10734 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the
10735 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself.
10736 ///
10737 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
10738 ///
10739 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10740 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD,
10741                                            MultiVersionKind MVKind,
10742                                            const TargetAttr *TA) {
10743   assert(MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None &&
10744          "Function lacks multiversion attribute");
10745 
10746   // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal
10747   // function.
10748   if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
10749     return false;
10750 
10751   if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) {
10752     FD->setInvalidDecl();
10753     return true;
10754   }
10755 
10756   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVKind)) {
10757     FD->setInvalidDecl();
10758     return true;
10759   }
10760 
10761   FD->setIsMultiVersion();
10762   return false;
10763 }
10764 
10765 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10766   for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) {
10767     if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None)
10768       return true;
10769   }
10770 
10771   return false;
10772 }
10773 
10774 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(
10775     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA,
10776     bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, LookupResult &Previous) {
10777   const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10778   ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse();
10779   // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent.
10780   llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features);
10781 
10782   // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that
10783   // to change, this is a simple redeclaration.
10784   if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() &&
10785       (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()))
10786     return false;
10787 
10788   // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning.
10789   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true,
10790                                        MultiVersionKind::Target)) {
10791     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10792     return true;
10793   }
10794 
10795   if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) {
10796     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10797     return true;
10798   }
10799 
10800   // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration.
10801   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) {
10802     Redeclaration = true;
10803     OldDecl = OldFD;
10804     OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10805     NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10806     return false;
10807   }
10808 
10809   if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) {
10810     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10811     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10812     return true;
10813   }
10814 
10815   ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>());
10816 
10817   if (OldParsed == NewParsed) {
10818     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate);
10819     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10820     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10821     return true;
10822   }
10823 
10824   for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) {
10825     const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10826     // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but
10827     // nothing after the fact.
10828     if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) &&
10829         (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) {
10830       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl)
10831           << 0;
10832       S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10833       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10834       return true;
10835     }
10836   }
10837 
10838   OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10839   NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10840   Redeclaration = false;
10841   OldDecl = nullptr;
10842   Previous.clear();
10843   return false;
10844 }
10845 
10846 static bool MultiVersionTypesCompatible(MultiVersionKind Old,
10847                                         MultiVersionKind New) {
10848   if (Old == New || Old == MultiVersionKind::None ||
10849       New == MultiVersionKind::None)
10850     return true;
10851 
10852   return (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10853           New == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) ||
10854          (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific &&
10855           New == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch);
10856 }
10857 
10858 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing
10859 /// multiversioned declaration collection.
10860 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(
10861     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10862     MultiVersionKind NewMVKind, const TargetAttr *NewTA,
10863     const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec,
10864     const TargetClonesAttr *NewClones, bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
10865     LookupResult &Previous) {
10866 
10867   MultiVersionKind OldMVKind = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind();
10868   // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types.
10869   if (!MultiVersionTypesCompatible(OldMVKind, NewMVKind)) {
10870     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed);
10871     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10872     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10873     return true;
10874   }
10875 
10876   ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed;
10877   if (NewTA) {
10878     NewParsed = NewTA->parse();
10879     llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features);
10880   }
10881 
10882   bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
10883       S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind();
10884 
10885   bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks =
10886       AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, S.Context, NewFD);
10887 
10888   // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a
10889   // previous member of the MultiVersion set.
10890   for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) {
10891     FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction();
10892     if (!CurFD)
10893       continue;
10894     if (MayNeedOverloadableChecks &&
10895         S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules))
10896       continue;
10897 
10898     switch (NewMVKind) {
10899     case MultiVersionKind::None:
10900       assert(OldMVKind == MultiVersionKind::TargetClones &&
10901              "Only target_clones can be omitted in subsequent declarations");
10902       break;
10903     case MultiVersionKind::Target: {
10904       const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10905       if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) {
10906         NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10907         Redeclaration = true;
10908         OldDecl = ND;
10909         return false;
10910       }
10911 
10912       ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>());
10913       if (CurParsed == NewParsed) {
10914         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate);
10915         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10916         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10917         return true;
10918       }
10919       break;
10920     }
10921     case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: {
10922       const auto *CurClones = CurFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>();
10923       Redeclaration = true;
10924       OldDecl = CurFD;
10925       NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10926 
10927       if (CurClones && NewClones &&
10928           (CurClones->featuresStrs_size() != NewClones->featuresStrs_size() ||
10929            !std::equal(CurClones->featuresStrs_begin(),
10930                        CurClones->featuresStrs_end(),
10931                        NewClones->featuresStrs_begin()))) {
10932         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_target_clone_doesnt_match);
10933         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10934         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10935         return true;
10936       }
10937 
10938       return false;
10939     }
10940     case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific:
10941     case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: {
10942       const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
10943       const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
10944       // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions.
10945       // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through
10946       // the redeclaration errors.
10947       if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10948           CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) {
10949         if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() &&
10950             std::equal(
10951                 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(),
10952                 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(),
10953                 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) {
10954                   return Cur->getName() == New->getName();
10955                 })) {
10956           NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10957           Redeclaration = true;
10958           OldDecl = ND;
10959           return false;
10960         }
10961 
10962         // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition.
10963         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch);
10964         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10965         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10966         return true;
10967       }
10968       if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) {
10969         if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() &&
10970             std::equal(
10971                 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(),
10972                 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
10973                 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) {
10974                   return Cur->getName() == New->getName();
10975                 })) {
10976           NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10977           Redeclaration = true;
10978           OldDecl = ND;
10979           return false;
10980         }
10981 
10982         // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU.
10983         for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) {
10984           for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) {
10985             if (CurII == NewII) {
10986               S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs)
10987                   << NewII;
10988               S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10989               NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10990               return true;
10991             }
10992           }
10993         }
10994       }
10995       break;
10996     }
10997     }
10998   }
10999 
11000   // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case.  Checking the 'value' is only
11001   // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are
11002   // handled in the attribute adding step.
11003   if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target &&
11004       CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) {
11005     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11006     return true;
11007   }
11008 
11009   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD,
11010                                        !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVKind)) {
11011     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11012     return true;
11013   }
11014 
11015   // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible.
11016   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) {
11017     OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11018     NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11019     Redeclaration = true;
11020     OldDecl = OldFD;
11021     return false;
11022   }
11023 
11024   NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11025   Redeclaration = false;
11026   OldDecl = nullptr;
11027   Previous.clear();
11028   return false;
11029 }
11030 
11031 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration.
11032 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself.
11033 ///
11034 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
11035 ///
11036 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
11037 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
11038                                       bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
11039                                       LookupResult &Previous) {
11040   const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
11041   const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
11042   const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
11043   const auto *NewClones = NewFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>();
11044   MultiVersionKind MVKind = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind();
11045 
11046   // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS
11047   // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint.
11048   if (NewFD->isMain()) {
11049     if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None &&
11050         !(MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !NewTA->isDefaultVersion())) {
11051       S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main);
11052       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11053       return true;
11054     }
11055     return false;
11056   }
11057 
11058   if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() ||
11059       OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() !=
11060           NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) {
11061     // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause
11062     // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition.
11063     if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None)
11064       return false;
11065     return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA);
11066   }
11067 
11068   FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction();
11069 
11070   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None)
11071     return false;
11072 
11073   // Multiversioned redeclarations aren't allowed to omit the attribute, except
11074   // for target_clones.
11075   if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None &&
11076       OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) {
11077     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl)
11078         << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target);
11079     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11080     return true;
11081   }
11082 
11083   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) {
11084     switch (MVKind) {
11085     case MultiVersionKind::Target:
11086       return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA,
11087                                               Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous);
11088     case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones:
11089       if (OldFD->isUsed(false)) {
11090         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11091         return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used);
11092       }
11093       OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11094       break;
11095     case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch:
11096     case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific:
11097     case MultiVersionKind::None:
11098       break;
11099     }
11100   }
11101 
11102   // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an
11103   // appropriate attribute in the current function decl.  Resolve that these are
11104   // still compatible with previous declarations.
11105   return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA,
11106                                          NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, NewClones,
11107                                          Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous);
11108 }
11109 
11110 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration.
11111 ///
11112 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration
11113 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not
11114 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is
11115 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed
11116 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions
11117 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called
11118 /// via InstantiateDecl).
11119 ///
11120 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is
11121 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the
11122 /// previous declaration).
11123 ///
11124 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
11125 ///
11126 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration.
11127 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
11128                                     LookupResult &Previous,
11129                                     bool IsMemberSpecialization,
11130                                     bool DeclIsDefn) {
11131   assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
11132          "Variably modified return types are not handled here");
11133 
11134   // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with
11135   // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++,
11136   // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible.
11137   bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
11138                                !Previous.isShadowed();
11139 
11140   bool Redeclaration = false;
11141   NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr;
11142   bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false;
11143 
11144   // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of
11145   // the same name, if appropriate.
11146   if (!Previous.empty()) {
11147     // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or
11148     // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload,
11149     // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new
11150     // function to the scope.
11151     if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) {
11152       NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
11153       if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) {
11154         Redeclaration = true;
11155         OldDecl = Candidate;
11156       }
11157     } else {
11158       MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true;
11159       switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl,
11160                             /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) {
11161       case Ovl_Match:
11162         Redeclaration = true;
11163         break;
11164 
11165       case Ovl_NonFunction:
11166         Redeclaration = true;
11167         break;
11168 
11169       case Ovl_Overload:
11170         Redeclaration = false;
11171         break;
11172       }
11173     }
11174   }
11175 
11176   // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name.
11177   if (!Redeclaration &&
11178       checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) {
11179     if (!Previous.empty()) {
11180       // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous
11181       // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity...
11182       Redeclaration = true;
11183       OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl();
11184       MergeTypeWithPrevious = false;
11185 
11186       // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)).
11187       if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() ||
11188           NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) {
11189         if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) {
11190           MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true;
11191           Redeclaration = false;
11192           OldDecl = nullptr;
11193         }
11194       }
11195     }
11196   }
11197 
11198   if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous))
11199     return Redeclaration;
11200 
11201   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types.
11202   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
11203       CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) {
11204     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11205   }
11206 
11207   // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8:
11208   //   A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not
11209   //   a constructor declares that member function to be const.
11210   //
11211   // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line
11212   // definition of a static member function.
11213   //
11214   // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards
11215   // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11.
11216   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD);
11217   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() &&
11218       !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) &&
11219       !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) {
11220     CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr;
11221     if (OldDecl)
11222       OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction());
11223     if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) {
11224       const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
11225         MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11226       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
11227       EPI.TypeQuals.addConst();
11228       MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(),
11229                                           FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
11230 
11231       // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation.
11232       // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined.
11233       if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) {
11234         SourceLocation AddConstLoc;
11235         if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc()
11236                 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>())
11237           AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc());
11238 
11239         Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const)
11240           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const");
11241       }
11242     }
11243   }
11244 
11245   if (Redeclaration) {
11246     // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be
11247     // merged.
11248     if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious,
11249                           DeclIsDefn)) {
11250       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11251       return Redeclaration;
11252     }
11253 
11254     Previous.clear();
11255     Previous.addDecl(OldDecl);
11256 
11257     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl =
11258             dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) {
11259       auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl();
11260       FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl
11261         = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
11262       assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch");
11263 
11264       // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in
11265       // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we
11266       // can add it as a redeclaration.
11267       NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl);
11268 
11269       NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD);
11270       if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) {
11271         NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess());
11272         NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess());
11273       }
11274 
11275       // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function
11276       // template, mark it as a member specialization.
11277       if (IsMemberSpecialization &&
11278           NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) {
11279         NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization();
11280         assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization());
11281         // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted
11282         // status from the parent member template that they are specializing.
11283         if (OldFD->isDeleted()) {
11284           // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules.
11285           assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD);
11286           // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation.
11287           OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false);
11288         }
11289       }
11290 
11291     } else {
11292       if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) {
11293         auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl);
11294         // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates.
11295         NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD);
11296         if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember())
11297           NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess());
11298       }
11299     }
11300   } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks &&
11301              !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) {
11302     assert((Previous.empty() ||
11303             llvm::any_of(Previous,
11304                          [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
11305                            return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
11306                          })) &&
11307            "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present");
11308 
11309     auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
11310       const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND);
11311       return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
11312     });
11313 
11314     if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) {
11315       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
11316            diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads);
11317       Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(),
11318            diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload)
11319           << false;
11320 
11321       NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
11322     }
11323   }
11324 
11325   if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
11326     ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD);
11327 
11328   // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation).
11329 
11330   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11331     // C++-specific checks.
11332     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) {
11333       CheckConstructor(Constructor);
11334     } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
11335                 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) {
11336       CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent();
11337       QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record);
11338 
11339       // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class
11340       // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that.
11341       if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) {
11342         DeclarationName Name
11343           = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(
11344                                         Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType));
11345         if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) {
11346           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name);
11347           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11348           return Redeclaration;
11349         }
11350       }
11351     } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) {
11352       if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
11353         CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD);
11354 
11355       // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be
11356       // explicitly specialized.
11357       if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization)
11358         Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized)
11359             << /*explicit specialization*/ 1;
11360     }
11361 
11362     // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides.
11363     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
11364       if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() &&
11365           !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
11366           Method->isCanonicalDecl()) {
11367         AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method);
11368       }
11369       if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause())
11370         // C++2a [class.virtual]p6
11371         // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause.
11372         Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(),
11373              diag::err_constrained_virtual_method);
11374 
11375       if (Method->isStatic())
11376         checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method);
11377     }
11378 
11379     // C++20: dcl.decl.general p4:
11380     // The optional requires-clause ([temp.pre]) in an init-declarator or
11381     // member-declarator shall be present only if the declarator declares a
11382     // templated function ([dcl.fct]).
11383     if (Expr *TRC = NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
11384       if (!NewFD->isTemplated() && !NewFD->isTemplateInstantiation())
11385         Diag(TRC->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_constrained_non_templated_function);
11386     }
11387 
11388     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD))
11389       ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion);
11390 
11391     // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]).
11392     if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() &&
11393         CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) {
11394       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11395       return Redeclaration;
11396     }
11397 
11398     // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]).
11399     if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() &&
11400         CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) {
11401       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11402       return Redeclaration;
11403     }
11404 
11405     // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless
11406     // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done
11407     // during delayed parsing anyway.
11408     if (!CurContext->isRecord())
11409       CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD);
11410 
11411     // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if
11412     // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C
11413     // compatible, and if it does, warn the user.
11414     // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only.
11415     if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) {
11416       QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType();
11417       if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType())
11418         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete)
11419             << NewFD << R;
11420       else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() &&
11421                !R->isObjCObjectPointerType())
11422         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R;
11423     }
11424 
11425     // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6:
11426     //   [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification
11427     //   [is] part of the function type
11428     //
11429     // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose
11430     // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or
11431     // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in
11432     // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other
11433     // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.)
11434     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
11435       auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool {
11436         // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function
11437         // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very
11438         // restricted prior to C++17.
11439         if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11440           T = RT->getPointeeType();
11441         else if (T->isAnyPointerType())
11442           T = T->getPointeeType();
11443         else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11444           T = MPT->getPointeeType();
11445         if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11446           if (FPT->isNothrow())
11447             return true;
11448         return false;
11449       };
11450 
11451       auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11452       bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType());
11453       for (QualType T : FPT->param_types())
11454         AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T);
11455       if (AnyNoexcept)
11456         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
11457              diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature)
11458             << NewFD;
11459     }
11460 
11461     if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA)
11462       checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous);
11463   }
11464   return Redeclaration;
11465 }
11466 
11467 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) {
11468   // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3:
11469   //   A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or
11470   //   constexpr is ill-formed.
11471   // C11 6.7.4p4:  In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall
11472   //   appear in a declaration of main.
11473   // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it.
11474   // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension.
11475   if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static)
11476     Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
11477          ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main)
11478       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
11479   if (FD->isInlineSpecified())
11480     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main)
11481       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc());
11482   if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) {
11483     SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc();
11484     SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc));
11485     Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main);
11486     Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn)
11487       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange);
11488   }
11489   if (FD->isConstexpr()) {
11490     Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main)
11491         << FD->isConsteval()
11492         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc());
11493     FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified);
11494   }
11495 
11496   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
11497     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main)
11498         << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>();
11499     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11500     return;
11501   }
11502 
11503   // Functions named main in hlsl are default entries, but don't have specific
11504   // signatures they are required to conform to.
11505   if (getLangOpts().HLSL)
11506     return;
11507 
11508   QualType T = FD->getType();
11509   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type");
11510   const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
11511 
11512   // Set default calling convention for main()
11513   if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) {
11514     FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C));
11515     FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11516     T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType());
11517   }
11518 
11519   if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11520     // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return
11521     // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the
11522     // implicit-return-zero rule.
11523 
11524     // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'.
11525     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy))
11526       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11527     else {
11528       Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint);
11529       SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
11530       if (RTRange.isValid())
11531         Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type)
11532             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int");
11533     }
11534   } else {
11535     // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end;
11536     // set the flag which tells us that.
11537     // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3.
11538 
11539     // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'.
11540     if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy))
11541       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11542     else {
11543       // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error.
11544       SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
11545       Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint)
11546           << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int")
11547                                 : FixItHint());
11548       FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11549     }
11550   }
11551 
11552   // Treat protoless main() as nullary.
11553   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return;
11554 
11555   const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT);
11556   unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams();
11557   assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams);
11558 
11559   bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3);
11560 
11561   if (FTP->isVariadic()) {
11562     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main);
11563     // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we
11564     // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter.
11565   }
11566 
11567   // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**.  If
11568   // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start
11569   // getting shifty.
11570   if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin())
11571     HasExtraParameters = false;
11572 
11573   if (HasExtraParameters) {
11574     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams;
11575     FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11576     nparams = 3;
11577   }
11578 
11579   // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved
11580   // if we had some location information about types.
11581 
11582   QualType CharPP =
11583     Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy));
11584   QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP };
11585 
11586   for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) {
11587     QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i);
11588 
11589     bool mismatch = true;
11590 
11591     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i]))
11592       mismatch = false;
11593     else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) {
11594       // As an extension, the following forms are okay:
11595       //   char const **
11596       //   char const * const *
11597       //   char * const *
11598 
11599       QualifierCollector qs;
11600       const PointerType* PT;
11601       if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) &&
11602           (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) &&
11603           Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0),
11604                               Context.CharTy)) {
11605         qs.removeConst();
11606         mismatch = !qs.empty();
11607       }
11608     }
11609 
11610     if (mismatch) {
11611       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i];
11612       // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type
11613       FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11614     }
11615   }
11616 
11617   if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
11618     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg);
11619   }
11620 
11621   if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
11622     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD;
11623     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11624   }
11625 }
11626 
11627 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) {
11628 
11629   // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl
11630   if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain")
11631     return false;
11632 
11633   // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl
11634   const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
11635   if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment())
11636     return false;
11637 
11638   // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain
11639   // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows
11640   if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86)
11641     return true;
11642 
11643   return false;
11644 }
11645 
11646 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) {
11647   QualType T = FD->getType();
11648   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type");
11649   const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
11650 
11651   // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral,
11652   // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type.
11653   if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() ||
11654       FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() ||
11655       FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType())
11656     // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed.
11657     if (FD->getName() != "DllMain")
11658       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11659 
11660   // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points
11661   if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) {
11662     if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) {
11663       if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) {
11664         FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(
11665             FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall));
11666         FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11667       }
11668     } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) {
11669       FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT,
11670                                       FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C));
11671       FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11672     }
11673   }
11674 
11675   if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
11676     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD;
11677     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11678   }
11679 }
11680 
11681 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) {
11682   // FIXME: Need strict checking.  In C89, we need to check for
11683   // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or
11684   // commas outside of a sizeof.  In C99, it's the same list,
11685   // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated
11686   // expressions.  Everything else falls under the
11687   // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception.
11688   //
11689   // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions,
11690   // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter.
11691   if (Init->isValueDependent()) {
11692     assert(Init->containsErrors() &&
11693            "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path.");
11694     return true;
11695   }
11696   const Expr *Culprit;
11697   if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit))
11698     return false;
11699   Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant)
11700     << Culprit->getSourceRange();
11701   return true;
11702 }
11703 
11704 namespace {
11705   // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in
11706   // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does.
11707   class SelfReferenceChecker
11708       : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> {
11709     Sema &S;
11710     Decl *OrigDecl;
11711     bool isRecordType;
11712     bool isPODType;
11713     bool isReferenceType;
11714 
11715     bool isInitList;
11716     llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex;
11717 
11718   public:
11719     typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited;
11720 
11721     SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context),
11722                                                     S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) {
11723       isPODType = false;
11724       isRecordType = false;
11725       isReferenceType = false;
11726       isInitList = false;
11727       if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) {
11728         isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context);
11729         isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType();
11730         isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType();
11731       }
11732     }
11733 
11734     // For most expressions, just call the visitor.  For initializer lists,
11735     // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are
11736     // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields.
11737     void CheckExpr(Expr *E) {
11738       InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E);
11739       if (!InitList) {
11740         Visit(E);
11741         return;
11742       }
11743 
11744       // Track and increment the index here.
11745       isInitList = true;
11746       InitFieldIndex.push_back(0);
11747       for (auto Child : InitList->children()) {
11748         CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child));
11749         ++InitFieldIndex.back();
11750       }
11751       InitFieldIndex.pop_back();
11752     }
11753 
11754     // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed.
11755     // Returns false if additional checking is required.
11756     bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) {
11757       llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields;
11758       Expr *Base = E;
11759       bool ReferenceField = false;
11760 
11761       // Get the field members used.
11762       while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11763         FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
11764         if (!FD)
11765           return false;
11766         Fields.push_back(FD);
11767         if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
11768           ReferenceField = true;
11769         Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11770       }
11771 
11772       // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same.
11773       DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base);
11774       if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl)
11775         return false;
11776 
11777       // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field.
11778       if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField)
11779         return true;
11780 
11781       // Convert FieldDecls to their index number.
11782       llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex;
11783       for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields))
11784         UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex());
11785 
11786       // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index
11787       // numbers.  If field being used has index less than the field being
11788       // initialized, then the use is safe.
11789       for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(),
11790                 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(),
11791                 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(),
11792                 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end();
11793            UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) {
11794         if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter)
11795           return true;
11796         if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter)
11797           break;
11798       }
11799 
11800       // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names.
11801       HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11802       return true;
11803     }
11804 
11805     // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr.
11806     // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional
11807     // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's.
11808     void HandleValue(Expr *E) {
11809       E = E->IgnoreParens();
11810       if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
11811         HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11812         return;
11813       }
11814 
11815       if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) {
11816         Visit(CO->getCond());
11817         HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr());
11818         HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr());
11819         return;
11820       }
11821 
11822       if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO =
11823               dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) {
11824         Visit(BCO->getCond());
11825         HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr());
11826         return;
11827       }
11828 
11829       if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) {
11830         HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr());
11831         return;
11832       }
11833 
11834       if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
11835         if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) {
11836           Visit(BO->getLHS());
11837           HandleValue(BO->getRHS());
11838           return;
11839         }
11840       }
11841 
11842       if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) {
11843         if (isInitList) {
11844           if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E),
11845                                       false /*CheckReference*/))
11846             return;
11847         }
11848 
11849         Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11850         while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11851           // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them.
11852           if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
11853             return;
11854           Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11855         }
11856         if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base))
11857           HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11858         return;
11859       }
11860 
11861       Visit(E);
11862     }
11863 
11864     // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all
11865     // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses.
11866     void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
11867       if (isReferenceType)
11868         HandleDeclRefExpr(E);
11869     }
11870 
11871     void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
11872       if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
11873         HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11874         return;
11875       }
11876 
11877       Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E);
11878     }
11879 
11880     void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
11881       if (isInitList) {
11882         if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/))
11883           return;
11884       }
11885 
11886       // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers.
11887       if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return;
11888 
11889       // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member
11890       // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr.
11891       CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl());
11892       bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic());
11893       Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11894       while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11895         if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
11896           Warn = false;
11897         Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11898       }
11899 
11900       if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) {
11901         if (Warn)
11902           HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11903         return;
11904       }
11905 
11906       // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr.
11907       // Visit that expression.
11908       Visit(Base);
11909     }
11910 
11911     void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) {
11912       Expr *Callee = E->getCallee();
11913 
11914       if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee))
11915         return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E);
11916 
11917       Visit(Callee);
11918       for (auto Arg: E->arguments())
11919         HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
11920     }
11921 
11922     void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
11923       // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined.
11924       if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType &&
11925           isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) {
11926         if (!isPODType)
11927           HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11928         return;
11929       }
11930 
11931       if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) {
11932         HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11933         return;
11934       }
11935 
11936       Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E);
11937     }
11938 
11939     void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {}
11940 
11941     void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
11942       if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) {
11943         Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0);
11944         if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr))
11945           if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1)
11946             ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0);
11947         if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr))
11948           if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp)
11949             ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr();
11950         HandleValue(ArgExpr);
11951         return;
11952       }
11953       Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
11954     }
11955 
11956     void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
11957       // Treat std::move as a use.
11958       if (E->isCallToStdMove()) {
11959         HandleValue(E->getArg(0));
11960         return;
11961       }
11962 
11963       Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E);
11964     }
11965 
11966     void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) {
11967       if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) {
11968         HandleValue(E->getLHS());
11969         Visit(E->getRHS());
11970         return;
11971       }
11972 
11973       Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E);
11974     }
11975 
11976     // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the
11977     // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately
11978     // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics.
11979     void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) {
11980       Visit(E->getCond());
11981       Visit(E->getFalseExpr());
11982     }
11983 
11984     void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) {
11985       Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl();
11986       if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return;
11987       unsigned diag;
11988       if (isReferenceType) {
11989         diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init;
11990       } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) {
11991         diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init;
11992       } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) ||
11993                  isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) ||
11994                  DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) {
11995         diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init;
11996       } else {
11997         // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis.
11998         return;
11999       }
12000 
12001       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE,
12002                             S.PDiag(diag)
12003                                 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation()
12004                                 << DRE->getSourceRange());
12005     }
12006   };
12007 
12008   /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E.
12009   static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E,
12010                                  bool DirectInit) {
12011     // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself,
12012     // for instance, in recursive functions.  Skip them.
12013     if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl))
12014       return;
12015 
12016     E = E->IgnoreParens();
12017 
12018     // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type.
12019     // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings.
12020     if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType())
12021       if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
12022         if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue)
12023           if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr()))
12024             if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl)
12025               return;
12026 
12027     SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E);
12028   }
12029 } // end anonymous namespace
12030 
12031 namespace {
12032   // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is
12033   // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic.
12034   struct VarDeclOrName {
12035     VarDecl *VDecl;
12036     DeclarationName Name;
12037 
12038     friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &
12039     operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) {
12040       return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name;
12041     }
12042   };
12043 } // end anonymous namespace
12044 
12045 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl,
12046                                             DeclarationName Name, QualType Type,
12047                                             TypeSourceInfo *TSI,
12048                                             SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit,
12049                                             Expr *Init) {
12050   bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl;
12051   assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) &&
12052          "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization");
12053 
12054   VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name};
12055 
12056   DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType();
12057   assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type");
12058 
12059   // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3
12060   if (!Init) {
12061     assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?");
12062 
12063     // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing
12064     // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern.
12065     if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) ||
12066         VDecl->hasExternalStorage() ||
12067         VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) {
12068       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init)
12069         << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type;
12070       return QualType();
12071     }
12072   }
12073 
12074   ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits;
12075   if (Init)
12076     DeduceInits = Init;
12077 
12078   if (DirectInit) {
12079     if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init))
12080       DeduceInits = PL->exprs();
12081   }
12082 
12083   if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) {
12084     assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?");
12085     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl);
12086     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit(
12087         VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init);
12088     // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits.
12089     SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end());
12090     return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind,
12091                                                        InitsCopy);
12092   }
12093 
12094   if (DirectInit) {
12095     if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init))
12096       DeduceInits = IL->inits();
12097   }
12098 
12099   // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression.
12100   if (DeduceInits.empty()) {
12101     // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to
12102     // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);"
12103     Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture
12104                                   ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression
12105                                   : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression)
12106         << VN << Type << Range;
12107     return QualType();
12108   }
12109 
12110   if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) {
12111     Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(),
12112          IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions
12113                        : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions)
12114         << VN << Type << Range;
12115     return QualType();
12116   }
12117 
12118   Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0];
12119   if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) {
12120     Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture
12121                                   ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces
12122                                   : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces)
12123         << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range;
12124     return QualType();
12125   }
12126 
12127   // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger.
12128   bool DefaultedAnyToId = false;
12129   if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId &&
12130       Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) {
12131     ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType());
12132     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12133       return QualType();
12134     }
12135     Init = Result.get();
12136     DefaultedAnyToId = true;
12137   }
12138 
12139   // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1:
12140   //   If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier
12141   //   is present, e has type cv A
12142   if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) &&
12143       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) &&
12144       DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType())
12145     return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(),
12146                                     Type.getQualifiers());
12147 
12148   QualType DeducedType;
12149   if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) {
12150     if (!IsInitCapture)
12151       DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit);
12152     else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init))
12153       Diag(Range.getBegin(),
12154            diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list)
12155           << VN
12156           << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType()
12157                                              : DeduceInit->getType())
12158           << DeduceInit->getSourceRange();
12159     else
12160       Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure)
12161           << VN << TSI->getType()
12162           << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType()
12163                                              : DeduceInit->getType())
12164           << DeduceInit->getSourceRange();
12165   }
12166 
12167   // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using
12168   // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual
12169   // checks.
12170   // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though:
12171   // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter.
12172   if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture &&
12173       !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) {
12174     SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
12175     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range;
12176   }
12177 
12178   return DeducedType;
12179 }
12180 
12181 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit,
12182                                          Expr *Init) {
12183   assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors());
12184   QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(
12185       VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(),
12186       VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init);
12187   if (DeducedType.isNull()) {
12188     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12189     return true;
12190   }
12191 
12192   VDecl->setType(DeducedType);
12193   assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid());
12194 
12195   // In ARC, infer lifetime.
12196   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl))
12197     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12198 
12199   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
12200     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl);
12201 
12202   // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches
12203   // the previously declared type.
12204   if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) {
12205     // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete
12206     // array of auto, nor deduce such a type.
12207     MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false);
12208   }
12209 
12210   // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration.
12211   CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl);
12212   return VDecl->isInvalidDecl();
12213 }
12214 
12215 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init,
12216                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
12217   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
12218     Init = EWC->getSubExpr();
12219 
12220   if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init))
12221     Init = CE->getSubExpr();
12222 
12223   QualType InitType = Init->getType();
12224   assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12225           InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) &&
12226          "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct");
12227   if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) {
12228     for (auto I : ILE->inits()) {
12229       if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() &&
12230           !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12231         continue;
12232       SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc();
12233       checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc);
12234     }
12235     return;
12236   }
12237 
12238   if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) {
12239     if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
12240       checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject,
12241                             NTCUK_Init);
12242   } else {
12243     // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing
12244     // object.
12245     // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee
12246     // copy-elision.
12247     if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12248       checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy);
12249   }
12250 }
12251 
12252 namespace {
12253 
12254 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) {
12255   // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly
12256   // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union
12257   // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership
12258   // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining
12259   // whether the containing union is non-trivial.
12260   return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>();
12261 }
12262 
12263 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor
12264     : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor,
12265                                     void> {
12266   using Super =
12267       DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor,
12268                                     void>;
12269 
12270   DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(
12271       QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12272       Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S)
12273       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12274 
12275   void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT,
12276                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12277     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12278       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12279                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12280     return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12281   }
12282 
12283   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12284                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12285     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12286       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12287           << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName();
12288   }
12289 
12290   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12291     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12292       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12293           << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName();
12294   }
12295 
12296   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12297     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12298     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12299       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12300         bool IsUnion = false;
12301         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12302           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12303         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12304             << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12305         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12306         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12307       }
12308       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12309     }
12310 
12311     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12312       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12313           << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12314 
12315     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12316       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12317         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12318   }
12319 
12320   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12321 
12322   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12323   // non-trivial C union.
12324   QualType OrigTy;
12325   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12326   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12327   Sema &S;
12328 };
12329 
12330 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor
12331     : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> {
12332   using Super =
12333       DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>;
12334 
12335   DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(
12336       QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12337       Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S)
12338       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12339 
12340   void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT,
12341                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12342     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12343       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12344                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12345     return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12346   }
12347 
12348   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12349                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12350     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12351       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12352           << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName();
12353   }
12354 
12355   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12356     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12357       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12358           << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName();
12359   }
12360 
12361   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12362     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12363     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12364       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12365         bool IsUnion = false;
12366         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12367           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12368         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12369             << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12370         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12371         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12372       }
12373       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12374     }
12375 
12376     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12377       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12378           << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12379 
12380     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12381       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12382         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12383   }
12384 
12385   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12386   void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12387                           bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12388 
12389   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12390   // non-trivial C union.
12391   QualType OrigTy;
12392   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12393   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12394   Sema &S;
12395 };
12396 
12397 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor
12398     : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> {
12399   using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>;
12400 
12401   DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12402                                  Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
12403                                  Sema &S)
12404       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12405 
12406   void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT,
12407                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12408     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12409       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12410                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12411     return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12412   }
12413 
12414   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12415                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12416     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12417       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12418           << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName();
12419   }
12420 
12421   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12422     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12423       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12424           << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName();
12425   }
12426 
12427   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12428     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12429     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12430       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12431         bool IsUnion = false;
12432         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12433           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12434         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12435             << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12436         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12437         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12438       }
12439       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12440     }
12441 
12442     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12443       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12444           << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12445 
12446     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12447       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12448         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12449   }
12450 
12451   void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT,
12452                 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12453   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12454   void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12455                             bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12456 
12457   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12458   // non-trivial C union.
12459   QualType OrigTy;
12460   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12461   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12462   Sema &S;
12463 };
12464 
12465 } // namespace
12466 
12467 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc,
12468                                  NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
12469                                  unsigned NonTrivialKind) {
12470   assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12471           QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
12472           QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) &&
12473          "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union");
12474 
12475   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) &&
12476       QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
12477     DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12478         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12479   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) &&
12480       QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion())
12481     DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12482         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12483   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12484     DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12485         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12486 }
12487 
12488 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the
12489 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct
12490 /// initialization rather than copy initialization.
12491 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) {
12492   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it.  Just ignore
12493   // the initializer.
12494   if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12495     CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl));
12496     return;
12497   }
12498 
12499   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) {
12500     // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier.
12501     Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization)
12502       << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange();
12503     Method->setInvalidDecl();
12504     return;
12505   }
12506 
12507   VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl);
12508   if (!VDecl) {
12509     assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here");
12510     Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer);
12511     RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12512     return;
12513   }
12514 
12515   // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for.
12516   if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
12517     // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can
12518     // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a
12519     // TypoExpr.
12520     ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl);
12521     if (!Res.isUsable()) {
12522       // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them.
12523       // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init.
12524       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12525       return;
12526     }
12527     if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) {
12528       // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet.
12529       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12530       VDecl->setInit(Res.get());
12531       return;
12532     }
12533     Init = Res.get();
12534 
12535     if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init))
12536       return;
12537   }
12538 
12539   // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions.
12540   if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) {
12541     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition);
12542     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12543     return;
12544   }
12545 
12546   if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) {
12547     // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect.
12548     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init);
12549     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12550     return;
12551   }
12552 
12553   if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) {
12554     // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be
12555     // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by
12556     // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction.
12557     QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType();
12558     if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType))
12559       BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType();
12560     if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType,
12561                             diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12562       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12563       return;
12564     }
12565 
12566     // The variable can not have an abstract class type.
12567     if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(),
12568                                diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12569                                AbstractVariableType))
12570       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12571   }
12572 
12573   // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition,
12574   // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise
12575   // handle the situation.
12576   if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition())
12577     if (Def != VDecl &&
12578         (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) &&
12579         !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() &&
12580         checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl))
12581       return;
12582 
12583   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12584     // C++ [class.static.data]p4
12585     //   If a static data member is of const integral or const
12586     //   enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can
12587     //   specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral
12588     //   constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear
12589     //   in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be
12590     //   defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the
12591     //   namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer.
12592     //
12593     // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static
12594     // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class
12595     // declaration with an initializer.
12596     if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) {
12597       Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization)
12598           << VDecl->getDeclName();
12599       Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(),
12600            diag::note_previous_initializer)
12601           << 0;
12602       return;
12603     }
12604 
12605     if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage())
12606       setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
12607 
12608     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) {
12609       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12610       return;
12611     }
12612   }
12613 
12614   // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside
12615   // a kernel function cannot be initialized."
12616   if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) {
12617     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init);
12618     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12619     return;
12620   }
12621 
12622   // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef).
12623   if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) {
12624     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init);
12625     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12626     return;
12627   }
12628 
12629   // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since
12630   // CheckInitializerTypes may change it.
12631   QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT;
12632 
12633   // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger
12634   // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type.
12635   if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
12636       Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
12637     ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType());
12638     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12639       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12640       return;
12641     }
12642     Init = Result.get();
12643   }
12644 
12645   // Perform the initialization.
12646   ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init);
12647   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12648     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl);
12649     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit(
12650         VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init);
12651 
12652     MultiExprArg Args = Init;
12653     if (CXXDirectInit)
12654       Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(),
12655                           CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs());
12656 
12657     // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments.
12658     for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) {
12659       ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(
12660           Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true,
12661           [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) {
12662             InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E));
12663             return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E;
12664           });
12665       if (Res.isInvalid()) {
12666         VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12667       } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) {
12668         Args[Idx] = Res.get();
12669       }
12670     }
12671     if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl())
12672       return;
12673 
12674     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args,
12675                                    /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false,
12676                                    /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false);
12677     ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT);
12678     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12679       // If the provided initializer fails to initialize the var decl,
12680       // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery.
12681       auto RecoveryExpr =
12682           CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args);
12683       if (RecoveryExpr.get())
12684         VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get());
12685       return;
12686     }
12687 
12688     Init = Result.getAs<Expr>();
12689   }
12690 
12691   // Check for self-references within variable initializers.
12692   // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references)
12693   // are handled by a dataflow analysis.
12694   // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C.
12695   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
12696     if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() ||
12697         VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType())
12698       CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit);
12699 
12700   // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was
12701   // completed by the initializer. For example:
12702   //   int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 };
12703   // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType.
12704   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT))
12705     VDecl->setType(DclT);
12706 
12707   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12708     checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init);
12709 
12710     if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
12711       checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init);
12712 
12713     // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
12714     // Although this code can still have problems:
12715     //   id x = self.weakProp;
12716     //   id y = self.weakProp;
12717     // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
12718     // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
12719     // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
12720     if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction())
12721       if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
12722            VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) &&
12723           !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
12724                            Init->getBeginLoc()))
12725         FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init);
12726   }
12727 
12728   // The initialization is usually a full-expression.
12729   //
12730   // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not
12731   // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate
12732   // full-expression. For instance, in:
12733   //
12734   //   struct Temp { ~Temp(); };
12735   //   struct S { S(Temp); };
12736   //   struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() }
12737   //
12738   // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second.
12739   ExprResult Result =
12740       ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(),
12741                           /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr());
12742   if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12743     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12744     return;
12745   }
12746   Init = Result.get();
12747 
12748   // Attach the initializer to the decl.
12749   VDecl->setInit(Init);
12750 
12751   if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) {
12752     // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed.
12753     if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12754       // do nothing
12755 
12756     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized.
12757     // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL.
12758     } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) {
12759       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12760 
12761     // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer.
12762     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12763       // do nothing
12764 
12765     // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has
12766     // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals.
12767     } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
12768       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12769 
12770     // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers.
12771     // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list
12772     // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be
12773     // constant expressions.
12774     } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() &&
12775                isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) {
12776       const Expr *Culprit;
12777       if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) {
12778         Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(),
12779              diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant)
12780           << Culprit->getSourceRange();
12781       }
12782     }
12783 
12784     if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
12785       if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens()))
12786         if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage())
12787           BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap();
12788   } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() &&
12789              VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) {
12790     // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g.,
12791     //
12792     // struct S {
12793     //   static const int value = 17;
12794     // };
12795 
12796     // C++ [class.mem]p4:
12797     //   A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only
12798     //   if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or
12799     //   const enumeration type, see 9.4.2.
12800     //
12801     // C++11 [class.static.data]p3:
12802     //   If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral
12803     //   or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can
12804     //   specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause
12805     //   that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static
12806     //   data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition
12807     //   with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a
12808     //   brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is
12809     //   an assignment-expression is a constant expression.
12810 
12811     // Do nothing on dependent types.
12812     if (DclT->isDependentType()) {
12813 
12814     // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal
12815     // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal
12816     // type.
12817     } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) {
12818 
12819     // Require constness.
12820     } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) {
12821       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const)
12822         << Init->getSourceRange();
12823       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12824 
12825     // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases.
12826     } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
12827       // Check whether the expression is a constant expression.
12828       SourceLocation Loc;
12829       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified())
12830         // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an
12831         // in-class initializer cannot be volatile.
12832         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile);
12833       else if (Init->isValueDependent())
12834         ; // Nothing to check.
12835       else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc))
12836         ; // Ok, it's an ICE!
12837       else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() &&
12838                Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context))
12839         ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression.
12840       else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) {
12841         // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it,
12842         // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic.
12843         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12844           << Init->getSourceRange();
12845       } else {
12846         // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case.  Report the issue at the
12847         // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check.
12848         Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12849           << Init->getSourceRange();
12850         VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12851       }
12852 
12853     // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension.
12854     } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok
12855       // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support
12856       // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'.
12857       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
12858         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(),
12859              diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11)
12860             << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12861         Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(),
12862              diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11)
12863             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr ");
12864       } else {
12865         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type)
12866           << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12867 
12868         if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) {
12869           Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12870             << Init->getSourceRange();
12871           VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12872         }
12873       }
12874 
12875     // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types.
12876     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) {
12877       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type)
12878           << DclT << Init->getSourceRange()
12879           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr ");
12880       VDecl->setConstexpr(true);
12881 
12882     } else {
12883       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type)
12884         << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12885       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12886     }
12887   } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) {
12888     // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when
12889     // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a
12890     // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it.
12891     // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables
12892     // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present,
12893     // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the
12894     // C++ rules.
12895     if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern &&
12896         ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) ||
12897          !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) &&
12898         !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) &&
12899         !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind()))
12900       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init);
12901 
12902     // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has
12903     // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with
12904     // __declspec(dllexport).
12905     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
12906         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() &&
12907         VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition())
12908       VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern);
12909 
12910     // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant.
12911     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl())
12912       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12913   }
12914 
12915   QualType InitType = Init->getType();
12916   if (!InitType.isNull() &&
12917       (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12918        InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()))
12919     checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc());
12920 
12921   // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization:
12922   //    int x(1);  -as-> int x = 1;
12923   //    ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c);
12924   //
12925   // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for
12926   // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle().
12927   // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which
12928   // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without
12929   // special case code.
12930 
12931   // C++ 8.5p11:
12932   // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally
12933   // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a
12934   // class type.
12935   if (CXXDirectInit) {
12936     assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init.");
12937     VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit);
12938   } else if (DirectInit) {
12939     // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization.
12940     VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit);
12941   }
12942 
12943   if (LangOpts.OpenMP &&
12944       (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty()) &&
12945       VDecl->isFileVarDecl())
12946     DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl);
12947   CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl);
12948 }
12949 
12950 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an
12951 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish
12952 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or
12953 /// complete.
12954 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) {
12955   // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a
12956   // variable's type is either dependent or complete".
12957   if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return;
12958 
12959   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
12960   if (!VD) return;
12961 
12962   // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer.
12963   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D))
12964     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
12965       BD->setInvalidDecl();
12966 
12967   // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer.
12968   if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
12969     D->setInvalidDecl();
12970     return;
12971   }
12972 
12973   QualType Ty = VD->getType();
12974   if (Ty->isDependentType()) return;
12975 
12976   // Require a complete type.
12977   if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(),
12978                           Context.getBaseElementType(Ty),
12979                           diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12980     VD->setInvalidDecl();
12981     return;
12982   }
12983 
12984   // Require a non-abstract type.
12985   if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty,
12986                              diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12987                              AbstractVariableType)) {
12988     VD->setInvalidDecl();
12989     return;
12990   }
12991 
12992   // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors,
12993   // though.
12994 }
12995 
12996 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) {
12997   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it.
12998   if (!RealDecl)
12999     return;
13000 
13001   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) {
13002     QualType Type = Var->getType();
13003 
13004     // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory.
13005     if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) {
13006       Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var;
13007       Var->setInvalidDecl();
13008       return;
13009     }
13010 
13011     if (Type->isUndeducedType() &&
13012         DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr))
13013       return;
13014 
13015     // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with
13016     // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify
13017     // a brace-or-equal-initializer.
13018     // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to
13019     // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data
13020     // member.
13021     if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13022         !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) {
13023       if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) {
13024         // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always
13025         // a definition there.
13026         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
13027             !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
13028           Diag(Var->getLocation(),
13029                diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init)
13030               << Var;
13031           Var->setInvalidDecl();
13032           return;
13033         }
13034       } else {
13035         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl);
13036         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13037         return;
13038       }
13039     }
13040 
13041     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must
13042     // be initialized.
13043     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13044         Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant &&
13045         Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) {
13046       bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false;
13047       if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
13048         for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) {
13049           if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 &&
13050               Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() ==
13051                   LangAS::opencl_constant) {
13052             HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true;
13053           }
13054         }
13055       }
13056       if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) {
13057         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init);
13058         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13059         return;
13060       }
13061     }
13062 
13063     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) {
13064       if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) {
13065         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl)
13066             << Var;
13067         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13068         return;
13069       }
13070       if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(),
13071                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
13072         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13073         return;
13074       }
13075       if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
13076         if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) {
13077           Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor);
13078           Var->setInvalidDecl();
13079           return;
13080         }
13081       }
13082       // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks.
13083       return;
13084     }
13085 
13086     VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition();
13087     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
13088         Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
13089       checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(),
13090                             NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init);
13091 
13092 
13093     switch (DefKind) {
13094     case VarDecl::Definition:
13095       if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer())
13096         break;
13097 
13098       // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member
13099       // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like
13100       // a declaration.
13101       //
13102       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
13103 
13104     case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly:
13105       // It's only a declaration.
13106 
13107       // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is
13108       // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the
13109       // object shall be complete.
13110       if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() &&
13111           !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13112           RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13113                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type))
13114         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13115 
13116       // Make sure that the type is not abstract.
13117       if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13118           RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13119                                  diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
13120                                  AbstractVariableType))
13121         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13122       if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13123           Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) {
13124         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern);
13125         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern);
13126       }
13127 
13128       if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() &&
13129           !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13130         ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var);
13131 
13132       return;
13133 
13134     case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition:
13135       // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an
13136       // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a
13137       // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static",
13138       // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with
13139       // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5).
13140       if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) {
13141         if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT
13142                                     = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) {
13143           if (RequireCompleteSizedType(
13144                   Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(),
13145                   diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type))
13146             Var->setInvalidDecl();
13147         } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
13148           // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is
13149           // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the
13150           // declared type shall not be an incomplete type.
13151           // NOTE: code such as the following
13152           //     static struct s;
13153           //     struct s { int a; };
13154           // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of
13155           // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration.
13156           // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration.
13157           if (Var->isFirstDecl())
13158             RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13159                                 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type);
13160         }
13161       }
13162 
13163       // Record the tentative definition; we're done.
13164       if (!Var->isInvalidDecl())
13165         TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var);
13166       return;
13167     }
13168 
13169     // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable
13170     // definitions with incomplete array type.
13171     if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) {
13172       Diag(Var->getLocation(),
13173            diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer);
13174       Var->setInvalidDecl();
13175       return;
13176     }
13177 
13178     // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable
13179     // definitions with reference type.
13180     if (Type->isReferenceType()) {
13181       Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init)
13182           << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation());
13183       return;
13184     }
13185 
13186     // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a
13187     // variable with dependent type.
13188     if (Type->isDependentType())
13189       return;
13190 
13191     if (Var->isInvalidDecl())
13192       return;
13193 
13194     if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
13195       if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(),
13196                               Context.getBaseElementType(Type),
13197                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
13198         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13199         return;
13200       }
13201     } else {
13202       return;
13203     }
13204 
13205     // The variable can not have an abstract class type.
13206     if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13207                                diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
13208                                AbstractVariableType)) {
13209       Var->setInvalidDecl();
13210       return;
13211     }
13212 
13213     // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer.  C++0x
13214     // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic
13215     // storage duration", not a "local variable".
13216     // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3
13217     //   A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic
13218     //   storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is
13219     //   ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a
13220     //   trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified
13221     //   version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding
13222     //   types and is declared without an initializer.
13223     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
13224       if (const RecordType *Record
13225             = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) {
13226         CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl());
13227         // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the
13228         // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can
13229         // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98.
13230         if (!CXXRecord->isPOD())
13231           setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13232       }
13233     }
13234     // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space,
13235     // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer.
13236     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
13237         Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local)
13238       return;
13239     // C++03 [dcl.init]p9:
13240     //   If no initializer is specified for an object, and the
13241     //   object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or
13242     //   array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if
13243     //   the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class
13244     //   type shall have a user-declared default
13245     //   constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for
13246     //   a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if
13247     //   any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object
13248     //   or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the
13249     //   program is ill-formed.
13250     // C++0x [dcl.init]p11:
13251     //   If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is
13252     //   default-initialized; [...].
13253     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var);
13254     InitializationKind Kind
13255       = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation());
13256 
13257     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None);
13258     ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None);
13259 
13260     if (Init.get()) {
13261       Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get()));
13262       // This is important for template substitution.
13263       Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit);
13264     } else if (Init.isInvalid()) {
13265       // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track
13266       // that initialization was attempted and failed.
13267       auto RecoveryExpr =
13268           CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {});
13269       if (RecoveryExpr.get())
13270         Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get());
13271     }
13272 
13273     CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var);
13274   }
13275 }
13276 
13277 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) {
13278   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it.
13279   if (!D)
13280     return;
13281 
13282   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
13283   if (!VD) {
13284     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var);
13285     D->setInvalidDecl();
13286     return;
13287   }
13288 
13289   VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true);
13290 
13291   // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier.
13292   int Error = -1;
13293   switch (VD->getStorageClass()) {
13294   case SC_None:
13295     break;
13296   case SC_Extern:
13297     Error = 0;
13298     break;
13299   case SC_Static:
13300     Error = 1;
13301     break;
13302   case SC_PrivateExtern:
13303     Error = 2;
13304     break;
13305   case SC_Auto:
13306     Error = 3;
13307     break;
13308   case SC_Register:
13309     Error = 4;
13310     break;
13311   }
13312 
13313   // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't.
13314   switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) {
13315   case TSCS_thread_local:
13316     Error = 6;
13317     break;
13318   case TSCS___thread:
13319   case TSCS__Thread_local:
13320   case TSCS_unspecified:
13321     break;
13322   }
13323 
13324   if (Error != -1) {
13325     Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class)
13326         << VD << Error;
13327     D->setInvalidDecl();
13328   }
13329 }
13330 
13331 StmtResult Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc,
13332                                             IdentifierInfo *Ident,
13333                                             ParsedAttributes &Attrs) {
13334   // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1:
13335   //   A range-based for statement of the form
13336   //      for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement
13337   //   is equivalent to
13338   //      for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement
13339   DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory());
13340 
13341   const char *PrevSpec;
13342   unsigned DiagID;
13343   DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID,
13344                      getPrintingPolicy());
13345 
13346   Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::ForInit);
13347   D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc);
13348   D.takeAttributes(Attrs);
13349 
13350   D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false),
13351                 IdentLoc);
13352   Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D);
13353   cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true);
13354   FinalizeDeclaration(Var);
13355   return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc,
13356                        Attrs.Range.getEnd().isValid() ? Attrs.Range.getEnd()
13357                                                       : IdentLoc);
13358 }
13359 
13360 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) {
13361   if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return;
13362 
13363   MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var);
13364 
13365   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
13366     // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an
13367     // initialiser
13368     if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() &&
13369         !var->hasInit()) {
13370       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration)
13371           << 1 /*Init*/;
13372       var->setInvalidDecl();
13373       return;
13374     }
13375   }
13376 
13377   // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a
13378   // local retaining variable.
13379   if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
13380       var->hasLocalStorage()) {
13381     switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) {
13382     case Qualifiers::OCL_None:
13383     case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
13384     case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
13385       break;
13386 
13387     case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
13388     case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
13389       setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13390       break;
13391     }
13392   }
13393 
13394   if (var->hasLocalStorage() &&
13395       var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
13396     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13397 
13398   // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a
13399   // prior declaration.  We only want to do this for global
13400   // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for
13401   // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can
13402   // change if it's later given a typedef name.
13403   if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13404       var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
13405       var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() &&
13406       !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() &&
13407       !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) &&
13408       !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) &&
13409       !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations,
13410                                   var->getLocation())) {
13411     // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition.
13412     VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl();
13413     while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
13414       prev = prev->getPreviousDecl();
13415 
13416     if (!prev) {
13417       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var;
13418       Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage)
13419           << /* variable */ 0;
13420     }
13421   }
13422 
13423   // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization.
13424   Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit;
13425   const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr;
13426   auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable {
13427     if (!CacheHasConstInit)
13428       CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer(
13429             Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit);
13430     return *CacheHasConstInit;
13431   };
13432 
13433   if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) {
13434     if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) {
13435       // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3:
13436       //   The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not
13437       //   have a non-trivial destructor.
13438       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor);
13439       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
13440         Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local);
13441     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) {
13442       if (!checkConstInit()) {
13443         // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4:
13444         //   An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic
13445         //   initialization.
13446         // FIXME: Need strict checking here.
13447         Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init)
13448           << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange();
13449         if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
13450           Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local);
13451       }
13452     }
13453   }
13454 
13455 
13456   if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() &&
13457       isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) {
13458     const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit());
13459     unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits();
13460     if (NumInits > 2)
13461       for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) {
13462         const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I);
13463         if (!Init)
13464           break;
13465         const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts());
13466         if (!SL)
13467           break;
13468 
13469         unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated();
13470         // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization.
13471         // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated
13472         // together. Do not warn for macros too.
13473         if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) {
13474           bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true;
13475           for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) {
13476             const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J);
13477             if (!Init)
13478               break;
13479             const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts());
13480             if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) {
13481               OnlyOneMissingComma = false;
13482               break;
13483             }
13484           }
13485 
13486           if (OnlyOneMissingComma) {
13487             SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints;
13488             for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i)
13489               Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
13490                   PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ","));
13491 
13492             Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1),
13493                  diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init)
13494                 << Hints;
13495             Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(),
13496                  diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence);
13497           }
13498           // In any case, stop now.
13499           break;
13500         }
13501       }
13502   }
13503 
13504 
13505   QualType type = var->getType();
13506 
13507   if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
13508     getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var);
13509 
13510   Expr *Init = var->getInit();
13511   bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage();
13512   bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal();
13513   QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type);
13514   bool HasConstInit = true;
13515 
13516   // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant.
13517   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init &&
13518       !Init->isValueDependent() &&
13519       (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() ||
13520        var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) {
13521     // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in
13522     // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now.  We can't
13523     // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change
13524     // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined.
13525     SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
13526     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
13527       // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required,
13528       // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules
13529       // in [expr.const]p2-6.
13530       // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit /
13531       // -Wglobal-constructors.
13532       HasConstInit = checkConstInit();
13533 
13534       // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a
13535       // constant initializer.
13536       if (HasConstInit) {
13537         (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes);
13538         Notes.clear();
13539       } else if (CacheCulprit) {
13540         Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(),
13541                            PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr));
13542         Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange();
13543       }
13544     } else {
13545       // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer.
13546       HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes);
13547     }
13548 
13549     if (HasConstInit) {
13550       // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr.
13551     } else if (var->isConstexpr()) {
13552       SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation();
13553       // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source
13554       // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic.
13555       if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
13556                                    diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
13557         DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
13558         Notes.clear();
13559       }
13560       Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init)
13561           << var << Init->getSourceRange();
13562       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
13563         Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
13564     } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) {
13565       auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
13566       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed)
13567           << Init->getSourceRange();
13568       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here)
13569           << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit();
13570       for (auto &it : Notes)
13571         Diag(it.first, it.second);
13572     } else if (IsGlobal &&
13573                !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor,
13574                                            var->getLocation())) {
13575       // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer.  Don't
13576       // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already
13577       // warned about them.
13578       CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
13579       if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) {
13580         // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in
13581         // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer
13582         // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor.
13583         if (!checkConstInit())
13584           Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor)
13585               << Init->getSourceRange();
13586       }
13587     }
13588   }
13589 
13590   // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables.
13591   if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13592       !inTemplateInstantiation()) {
13593     PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr;
13594     int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read;
13595     if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) {
13596       if (HasConstInit)
13597         Stack = &ConstSegStack;
13598       else {
13599         Stack = &BSSSegStack;
13600         SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13601       }
13602     } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) {
13603       Stack = &DataSegStack;
13604       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13605     } else {
13606       Stack = &BSSSegStack;
13607       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13608     }
13609     if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
13610       if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec)
13611         SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit;
13612       UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var);
13613     } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) {
13614       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit;
13615       auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString();
13616       var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13617           Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation,
13618           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate));
13619       if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var))
13620         var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>();
13621     }
13622 
13623     // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer.  If the
13624     // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this
13625     // attribute.
13626     if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit())
13627       var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(),
13628                                                CurInitSegLoc,
13629                                                AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13630   }
13631 
13632   // All the following checks are C++ only.
13633   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
13634     // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the
13635     // current module.
13636     if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty())
13637       Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var);
13638     return;
13639   }
13640 
13641   // Require the destructor.
13642   if (!type->isDependentType())
13643     if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>())
13644       FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType);
13645 
13646   // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current
13647   // module.
13648   if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty())
13649     Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var);
13650 
13651   // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration.
13652   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var))
13653     CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD);
13654 }
13655 
13656 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a
13657 /// dllexport/import function.
13658 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) {
13659   assert(VD->isStaticLocal());
13660 
13661   auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13662 
13663   // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function.
13664   while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) &&
13665          !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() &&
13666          !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13667     FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13668   }
13669 
13670   if (!FD)
13671     return;
13672 
13673   // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function.
13674   if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) {
13675     auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext()));
13676     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13677     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13678   } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13679     auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A);
13680     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13681     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13682 
13683     // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even
13684     // if it is not used in this compilation unit.
13685     if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
13686       FD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13687 
13688   } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13689     auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A);
13690     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13691     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13692   }
13693 }
13694 
13695 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform
13696 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached.
13697 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) {
13698   // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration.
13699   ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl);
13700 
13701   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl);
13702   if (!VD)
13703     return;
13704 
13705   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active
13706   if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13707       !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
13708     if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid)
13709       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13710           Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName,
13711           PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation,
13712           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13713     if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid)
13714       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13715           Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName,
13716           PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation,
13717           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13718     if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid)
13719       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13720           Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName,
13721           PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation,
13722           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13723     if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid)
13724       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13725           Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName,
13726           PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation,
13727           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13728   }
13729 
13730   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) {
13731     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) {
13732       FinalizeDeclaration(BD);
13733     }
13734   }
13735 
13736   checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD);
13737 
13738   // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable
13739   // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check
13740   // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints).
13741   if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) {
13742     // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and
13743     // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case).
13744     if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) {
13745       CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign);
13746       if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) {
13747         Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum)
13748           << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD
13749           << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity();
13750       }
13751     }
13752   }
13753 
13754   if (VD->isStaticLocal())
13755     CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD);
13756 
13757   // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables.
13758   // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA
13759   // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__
13760   // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows
13761   // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables.
13762   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
13763     checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD);
13764 
13765   // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl.
13766   const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD);
13767 
13768   // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line.
13769   if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) {
13770     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() &&
13771         VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13772       // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members
13773       // with a warning.
13774       CXXRecordDecl *Context =
13775         cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext());
13776       bool IsClassTemplateMember =
13777           isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) ||
13778           Context->getDescribedClassTemplate();
13779 
13780       Diag(VD->getLocation(),
13781            IsClassTemplateMember
13782                ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition
13783                : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition);
13784       Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute);
13785       if (!IsClassTemplateMember)
13786         VD->setInvalidDecl();
13787     }
13788   }
13789 
13790   // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index
13791   // isn't exported with the variable.
13792   if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) {
13793     auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13794     if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) {
13795       assert(VD->isStaticLocal());
13796       // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the
13797       // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be
13798       // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe.
13799     } else {
13800       Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD
13801                                                                     << DLLAttr;
13802       VD->setInvalidDecl();
13803     }
13804   }
13805 
13806   if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) {
13807     if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13808       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition)
13809           << Attr;
13810       VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>();
13811     }
13812   }
13813   if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) {
13814     if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13815       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition)
13816           << Attr;
13817       VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>();
13818     }
13819   }
13820 
13821   const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext();
13822   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class
13823   // member, set the visibility of this variable.
13824   if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible())
13825     AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD);
13826 
13827   // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations.
13828   if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
13829     MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD);
13830 
13831   // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic
13832   // tag values.
13833   if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() ||
13834       !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
13835     return;
13836 
13837   for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) {
13838     const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit();
13839     if (!MagicValueExpr) {
13840       continue;
13841     }
13842     Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt;
13843     if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
13844       Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(),
13845            diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice)
13846         << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange();
13847       continue;
13848     }
13849     if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) {
13850       Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(),
13851            diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large)
13852         << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange();
13853       continue;
13854     }
13855     uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue();
13856     RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(),
13857                                MagicValue,
13858                                I->getMatchingCType(),
13859                                I->getLayoutCompatible(),
13860                                I->getMustBeNull());
13861   }
13862 }
13863 
13864 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
13865   auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD);
13866   return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType();
13867 }
13868 
13869 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS,
13870                                                    ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13871   SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls;
13872 
13873   if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned())
13874     Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl());
13875 
13876   DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr;
13877   DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr;
13878   bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false;
13879   DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr;
13880   bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false;
13881 
13882   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13883     if (Decl *D = Group[i]) {
13884       // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need
13885       // to perform.
13886       if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) {
13887         if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup)
13888           FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD;
13889         if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup)
13890           FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D);
13891         if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() &&
13892             !hasDeducedAuto(DD))
13893           FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD;
13894 
13895         if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) {
13896           // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other
13897           // declaration in the same group.
13898           if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) {
13899             Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(),
13900                  diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone)
13901                 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange()
13902                 << DD->getSourceRange();
13903             DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true;
13904           }
13905 
13906           // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a
13907           // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other
13908           // declarator in the same group.
13909           if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) {
13910             Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(),
13911                  diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone)
13912                 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType()
13913                        ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType()
13914                 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange()
13915                 << DD->getSourceRange();
13916             DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true;
13917           }
13918         }
13919       }
13920 
13921       Decls.push_back(D);
13922     }
13923   }
13924 
13925   if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) {
13926     if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) {
13927       handleTagNumbering(Tag, S);
13928       if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() &&
13929           getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13930         Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup);
13931     }
13932   }
13933 
13934   return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls);
13935 }
13936 
13937 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration
13938 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking.
13939 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy
13940 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13941   // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347)
13942   //   If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each
13943   //   deduction, the program is ill-formed.
13944   if (Group.size() > 1) {
13945     QualType Deduced;
13946     VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr;
13947     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13948       VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]);
13949       if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl())
13950         break;
13951       DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType();
13952       if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull())
13953         continue;
13954       if (Deduced.isNull()) {
13955         Deduced = DT->getDeducedType();
13956         DeducedDecl = D;
13957       } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) {
13958         auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT);
13959         auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
13960                         diag::err_auto_different_deductions)
13961                    << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced
13962                    << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType()
13963                    << D->getDeclName();
13964         if (DeducedDecl->hasInit())
13965           Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange();
13966         if (D->getInit())
13967           Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange();
13968         D->setInvalidDecl();
13969         break;
13970       }
13971     }
13972   }
13973 
13974   ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group);
13975 
13976   return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(
13977       DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size()));
13978 }
13979 
13980 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) {
13981   ActOnDocumentableDecls(D);
13982 }
13983 
13984 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13985   // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored.
13986   if (Group.empty() || !Group[0])
13987     return;
13988 
13989   if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found,
13990                       Group[0]->getLocation()) &&
13991       Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name,
13992                       Group[0]->getLocation()))
13993     return;
13994 
13995   if (Group.size() >= 2) {
13996     // This is a decl group.  Normally it will contain only declarations
13997     // produced from declarator list.  But in case we have any definitions or
13998     // additional declaration references:
13999     //   'typedef struct S {} S;'
14000     //   'typedef struct S *S;'
14001     //   'struct S *pS;'
14002     // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations.
14003     Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0];
14004     if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) {
14005       Group = Group.slice(1);
14006     }
14007   }
14008 
14009   // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file.
14010   // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in
14011   // different files (e. g. macros or #include).
14012   Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor());
14013 }
14014 
14015 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function
14016 /// parameters and non-type template parameters.
14017 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
14018   // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this
14019   // parameter.
14020   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
14021     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
14022 
14023   // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
14024   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
14025     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator)
14026       << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
14027   }
14028 
14029   // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a
14030   // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...].
14031   switch (D.getName().getKind()) {
14032   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier:
14033     break;
14034 
14035   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId:
14036   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId:
14037   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId:
14038   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName:
14039   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName:
14040   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam:
14041   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName:
14042     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name)
14043       << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName();
14044     break;
14045 
14046   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId:
14047   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId:
14048     // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case.
14049     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id);
14050     break;
14051   }
14052 }
14053 
14054 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator()
14055 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope.
14056 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
14057   const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec();
14058 
14059   // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'.
14060 
14061   // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'.
14062   StorageClass SC = SC_None;
14063   if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) {
14064     SC = SC_Register;
14065     // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated.
14066     // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension.
14067     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
14068       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
14069            getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class
14070                                      : diag::warn_deprecated_register)
14071         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
14072     }
14073   } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
14074              DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) {
14075     SC = SC_Auto;
14076   } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) {
14077     Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
14078          diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl);
14079     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs();
14080   }
14081 
14082   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec())
14083     Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread)
14084       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
14085   if (DS.isInlineSpecified())
14086     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
14087         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
14088   if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier())
14089     Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr)
14090         << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
14091 
14092   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS);
14093 
14094   CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D);
14095 
14096   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
14097   QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType();
14098 
14099   // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x);
14100   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
14101   if (II) {
14102     LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName,
14103                    ForVisibleRedeclaration);
14104     LookupName(R, S);
14105     if (R.isSingleResult()) {
14106       NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
14107       if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
14108         // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
14109         DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl);
14110         // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
14111         PrevDecl = nullptr;
14112       } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) {
14113         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II;
14114         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
14115 
14116         // Recover by removing the name
14117         II = nullptr;
14118         D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc());
14119         D.setInvalidType(true);
14120       }
14121     }
14122   }
14123 
14124   // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not
14125   // the enclosing context.  This prevents them from accidentally
14126   // looking like class members in C++.
14127   ParmVarDecl *New =
14128       CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(),
14129                      D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC);
14130 
14131   if (D.isInvalidType())
14132     New->setInvalidDecl();
14133 
14134   assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope());
14135   assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1);
14136   New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1,
14137                     S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex());
14138 
14139   // Add the parameter declaration into this scope.
14140   S->AddDecl(New);
14141   if (II)
14142     IdResolver.AddDecl(New);
14143 
14144   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D);
14145 
14146   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
14147     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
14148         << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
14149         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
14150 
14151   if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
14152     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal);
14153   }
14154 
14155   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
14156     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New);
14157 
14158   return New;
14159 }
14160 
14161 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a
14162 /// typedef.
14163 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC,
14164                                               SourceLocation Loc,
14165                                               QualType T) {
14166   /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc.
14167      Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source
14168      location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */
14169   ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr,
14170                                 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc),
14171                                            SC_None, nullptr);
14172   Param->setImplicit();
14173   return Param;
14174 }
14175 
14176 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) {
14177   // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we
14178   // will already have done so in the template itself.
14179   if (inTemplateInstantiation())
14180     return;
14181 
14182   for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) {
14183     if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() &&
14184         !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
14185       Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter)
14186         << Parameter->getDeclName();
14187     }
14188   }
14189 }
14190 
14191 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(
14192     ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) {
14193   if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check.
14194     return;
14195 
14196   // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified
14197   // threshold.
14198   if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) {
14199     unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity();
14200     if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy)
14201       Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size;
14202   }
14203 
14204   // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified
14205   // threshold.
14206   for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) {
14207     QualType T = Parameter->getType();
14208     if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context))
14209       continue;
14210     unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity();
14211     if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy)
14212       Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size)
14213           << Parameter << Size;
14214   }
14215 }
14216 
14217 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc,
14218                                   SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name,
14219                                   QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo,
14220                                   StorageClass SC) {
14221   // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types.
14222   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
14223       T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None &&
14224       T->isObjCLifetimeType()) {
14225 
14226     Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime;
14227 
14228     // Special cases for arrays:
14229     //   - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained
14230     //   - otherwise, it's an error
14231     if (T->isArrayType()) {
14232       if (!T.isConstQualified()) {
14233         if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics())
14234           DelayedDiagnostics.add(
14235               sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType(
14236               NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false));
14237         else
14238           Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership)
14239               << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
14240       }
14241       lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
14242     } else {
14243       lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime();
14244     }
14245     T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime);
14246   }
14247 
14248   ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name,
14249                                          Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T),
14250                                          TSInfo, SC, nullptr);
14251 
14252   // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that
14253   // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the
14254   // lambda scope.
14255   if (New->isParameterPack())
14256     if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda())
14257       LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New);
14258 
14259   if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
14260       New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
14261     checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(),
14262                           NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
14263 
14264   // Parameters can not be abstract class types.
14265   // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once
14266   // the class has been completely parsed.
14267   if (!CurContext->isRecord() &&
14268       RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
14269                              AbstractParamType))
14270     New->setInvalidDecl();
14271 
14272   // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are
14273   // passed by reference.
14274   if (T->isObjCObjectType()) {
14275     SourceLocation TypeEndLoc =
14276         getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc());
14277     Diag(NameLoc,
14278          diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T
14279       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*");
14280     T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
14281     New->setType(T);
14282   }
14283 
14284   // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage
14285   // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier."
14286   // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have
14287   // an address space.
14288   if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default &&
14289       // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type
14290       // to be qualified with an address space.
14291       !(getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
14292         (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) {
14293     Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space);
14294     New->setInvalidDecl();
14295   }
14296 
14297   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types.
14298   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
14299       CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) {
14300     New->setInvalidDecl();
14301   }
14302 
14303   return New;
14304 }
14305 
14306 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
14307                                            SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) {
14308   DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo();
14309 
14310   // C99 6.9.1p6 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, each declaration
14311   // in the declaration list shall have at least one declarator, those
14312   // declarators shall only declare identifiers from the identifier list, and
14313   // every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared.
14314   //
14315   // C89 3.7.1p5 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, only the
14316   // identifiers it names shall be declared in the declaration list."
14317   //
14318   // This is why we only diagnose in C99 and later. Note, the other conditions
14319   // listed are checked elsewhere.
14320   if (!FTI.hasPrototype) {
14321     for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) {
14322       --i;
14323       if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) {
14324         if (getLangOpts().C99) {
14325           SmallString<256> Code;
14326           llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code)
14327               << "  int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n";
14328           Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared)
14329               << FTI.Params[i].Ident
14330               << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code);
14331         }
14332 
14333         // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better
14334         // type.
14335         AttributeFactory attrs;
14336         DeclSpec DS(attrs);
14337         const char* PrevSpec; // unused
14338         unsigned DiagID; // unused
14339         DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec,
14340                            DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy());
14341         // Use the identifier location for the type source range.
14342         DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14343         DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14344         Declarator ParamD(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(),
14345                           DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList);
14346         ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14347         FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD);
14348       }
14349     }
14350   }
14351 }
14352 
14353 Decl *
14354 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D,
14355                               MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
14356                               SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, FnBodyKind BodyKind) {
14357   assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused");
14358   assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!");
14359   Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent();
14360 
14361   // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and
14362   // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration
14363   // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards.
14364   // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare
14365   // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a
14366   // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the
14367   // `omp begin declare variant`.
14368   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases;
14369   if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope())
14370     ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(
14371         ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases);
14372 
14373   D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition);
14374   Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists);
14375   Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody, BodyKind);
14376 
14377   if (!Bases.empty())
14378     ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases);
14379 
14380   return Dcl;
14381 }
14382 
14383 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) {
14384   Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D);
14385 }
14386 
14387 static bool
14388 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD,
14389                                 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) {
14390   // Don't warn about invalid declarations.
14391   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
14392     return false;
14393 
14394   // Or declarations that aren't global.
14395   if (!FD->isGlobal())
14396     return false;
14397 
14398   // Don't warn about C++ member functions.
14399   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
14400     return false;
14401 
14402   // Don't warn about 'main'.
14403   if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()))
14404     if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier())
14405       if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main"))
14406         return false;
14407 
14408   // Don't warn about inline functions.
14409   if (FD->isInlined())
14410     return false;
14411 
14412   // Don't warn about function templates.
14413   if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
14414     return false;
14415 
14416   // Don't warn about function template specializations.
14417   if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
14418     return false;
14419 
14420   // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels.
14421   if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>())
14422     return false;
14423 
14424   // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions.
14425   if (FD->isDeleted())
14426     return false;
14427 
14428   // Don't warn on implicitly local functions (such as having local-typed
14429   // parameters).
14430   if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
14431     return false;
14432 
14433   for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl();
14434        Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) {
14435     // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method
14436     // scope, because they aren't visible from the header.
14437     if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
14438       continue;
14439 
14440     PossiblePrototype = Prev;
14441     return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType();
14442   }
14443 
14444   return true;
14445 }
14446 
14447 void
14448 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD,
14449                                    const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition,
14450                                    SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
14451   const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition;
14452   if (!Definition &&
14453       !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true))
14454     return;
14455 
14456   if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) {
14457     if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) {
14458       if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) {
14459         // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of
14460         // the same class, is OK.
14461         if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) &&
14462             declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()),
14463                                cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext())))
14464           return;
14465       }
14466     }
14467   }
14468 
14469   if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts()))
14470     return;
14471 
14472   // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected
14473   // definition.
14474   if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition))
14475     return;
14476 
14477   // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or
14478   // a template, skip the new definition.
14479   if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) &&
14480       (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage ||
14481        Definition->isInlined() ||
14482        Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() ||
14483        Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) {
14484     SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true;
14485     SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition);
14486     if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
14487       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD);
14488     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition));
14489     return;
14490   }
14491 
14492   if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() &&
14493       Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern)
14494     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline)
14495         << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
14496   else
14497     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD;
14498 
14499   Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
14500   FD->setInvalidDecl();
14501 }
14502 
14503 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator,
14504                                    Sema &S) {
14505   CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent();
14506 
14507   LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope();
14508   LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator;
14509   LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass;
14510   LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType();
14511   const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault();
14512 
14513   if (LCD == LCD_None)
14514     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None;
14515   else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy)
14516     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval;
14517   else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef)
14518     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref;
14519   DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo();
14520 
14521   LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange();
14522   LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst();
14523 
14524   // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already
14525   // captured within tryCaptureVar.
14526   auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin();
14527   for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) {
14528     if (C.capturesVariable()) {
14529       VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar();
14530       if (VD->isInitCapture())
14531         S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD);
14532       const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef;
14533       LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef,
14534           /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(),
14535           /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion()
14536                          ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(),
14537           I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false);
14538 
14539     } else if (C.capturesThis()) {
14540       LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(),
14541                           C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis);
14542     } else {
14543       LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(),
14544                              I->getType());
14545     }
14546     ++I;
14547   }
14548 }
14549 
14550 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D,
14551                                     SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody,
14552                                     FnBodyKind BodyKind) {
14553   if (!D) {
14554     // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope
14555     // anyway so we can try to parse the function body.
14556     PushFunctionScope();
14557     PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
14558     return D;
14559   }
14560 
14561   FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr;
14562 
14563   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14564     FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
14565   else
14566     FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
14567 
14568   // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building
14569   // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition().
14570   if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD))
14571     PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
14572         FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated
14573                           : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
14574 
14575   // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition.
14576   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
14577     Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0;
14578     FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
14579     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14580   }
14581   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) {
14582     Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1;
14583     FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>();
14584     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14585   }
14586 
14587   if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) {
14588     if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
14589         Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() &&
14590         Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
14591       // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any
14592       // default arguments.
14593       InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor);
14594     }
14595   }
14596 
14597   // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already
14598   // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set.
14599   if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() &&
14600       !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) {
14601     CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody);
14602 
14603     // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope.
14604     if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip)
14605       return D;
14606   }
14607 
14608   // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually".  This lets users to
14609   // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing
14610   // this function.
14611   FD->setWillHaveBody();
14612 
14613   // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push
14614   // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack.  But use the information
14615   // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current
14616   // LambdaScopeInfo.
14617   // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo,
14618   // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try
14619   // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential
14620   // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to
14621   // have the LSI properly restored.
14622   if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) {
14623     assert(inTemplateInstantiation() &&
14624            "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack "
14625            "when instantiating a generic lambda!");
14626     RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this);
14627   } else {
14628     // Enter a new function scope
14629     PushFunctionScope();
14630   }
14631 
14632   // Builtin functions cannot be defined.
14633   if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) {
14634     if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) &&
14635         !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) {
14636       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD;
14637       FD->setInvalidDecl();
14638     }
14639   }
14640 
14641   // The return type of a function definition must be complete (C99 6.9.1p3),
14642   // unless the function is deleted (C++ specifc, C++ [dcl.fct.def.general]p2)
14643   QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType();
14644   if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() &&
14645       !FD->isInvalidDecl() && BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete &&
14646       RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType,
14647                           diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result))
14648     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14649 
14650   if (FnBodyScope)
14651     PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD);
14652 
14653   // Check the validity of our function parameters
14654   if (BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete)
14655     CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(),
14656                              /*CheckParameterNames=*/true);
14657 
14658   // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current
14659   // scope.
14660   if (FnBodyScope) {
14661     for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) {
14662       auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD);
14663       if (!NonParmDecl)
14664         continue;
14665       assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) &&
14666              "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet");
14667 
14668       // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope.
14669       if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName())
14670         PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false);
14671 
14672       // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them
14673       // accessible in this scope.
14674       if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) {
14675         for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators())
14676           PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false);
14677       }
14678     }
14679   }
14680 
14681   // Introduce our parameters into the function scope
14682   for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) {
14683     Param->setOwningFunction(FD);
14684 
14685     // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
14686     if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) {
14687       CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param);
14688 
14689       PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope);
14690     }
14691   }
14692 
14693   // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated.
14694   if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14695     ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT);
14696 
14697   // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions.
14698   if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() &&
14699       !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) {
14700     assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>());
14701     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition);
14702     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14703     return D;
14704   }
14705   // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be
14706   // a function template).
14707   ActOnDocumentableDecl(D);
14708   if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() &&
14709       getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl &&
14710       getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation)
14711     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container);
14712 
14713   return D;
14714 }
14715 
14716 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body,
14717 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value
14718 /// optimization.
14719 ///
14720 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value
14721 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any
14722 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can
14723 /// use the named return value optimization.
14724 ///
14725 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return
14726 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that
14727 /// candidate is an NRVO variable.
14728 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) {
14729   ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data();
14730 
14731   for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) {
14732     if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) {
14733       if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable())
14734         Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr);
14735     }
14736   }
14737 }
14738 
14739 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) {
14740   // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet).
14741   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier())
14742     return false;
14743 
14744   // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced
14745   // return type (yet).
14746   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) {
14747     // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type,
14748     // we can still delay parsing it.
14749     if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) {
14750       const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1);
14751       if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
14752           Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) {
14753         QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType());
14754         return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType();
14755       }
14756     }
14757     return false;
14758   }
14759 
14760   return true;
14761 }
14762 
14763 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) {
14764   // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is
14765   // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the
14766   // rest of the file.
14767   // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type,
14768   // because any callers of that function need to know the type.
14769   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) {
14770     if (FD->isConstexpr())
14771       return false;
14772     // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template
14773     // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered
14774     // "undeduced".
14775     if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType())
14776       return false;
14777   }
14778   return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D);
14779 }
14780 
14781 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) {
14782   if (!Decl)
14783     return nullptr;
14784   if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction())
14785     FD->setHasSkippedBody();
14786   else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl))
14787     MD->setHasSkippedBody();
14788   return Decl;
14789 }
14790 
14791 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) {
14792   return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false);
14793 }
14794 
14795 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function
14796 /// body.
14797 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII {
14798 public:
14799   ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {}
14800   ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() {
14801     if (!IsLambda)
14802       S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
14803   }
14804 
14805 private:
14806   Sema &S;
14807   bool IsLambda = false;
14808 };
14809 
14810 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) {
14811   llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo;
14812 
14813   auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) {
14814     if (EscapeInfo.count(BD))
14815       return EscapeInfo[BD];
14816 
14817     bool R = false;
14818     const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD;
14819 
14820     do {
14821       R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape();
14822       if (R)
14823         break;
14824       CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl();
14825     } while (CurBD);
14826 
14827     return EscapeInfo[BD] = R;
14828   };
14829 
14830   // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping
14831   // block, emit a diagnostic.
14832   for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P :
14833        S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs)
14834     if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second))
14835       S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self)
14836           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->");
14837 }
14838 
14839 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body,
14840                                     bool IsInstantiation) {
14841   FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction();
14842   FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr;
14843 
14844   if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && FD && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>())
14845     FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
14846 
14847   sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
14848   sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr;
14849 
14850   if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine())
14851     CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body);
14852 
14853   {
14854     // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because
14855     // one is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr().
14856     // This is meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef().
14857     ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD));
14858 
14859     if (FD) {
14860       FD->setBody(Body);
14861       FD->setWillHaveBody(false);
14862 
14863       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
14864         if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() &&
14865             FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) {
14866           // For a function with a deduced result type to return void,
14867           // the result type as written must be 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)',
14868           // possibly cv-qualified or constrained, but not ref-qualified.
14869           if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) {
14870             Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto)
14871                 << FD->getReturnType();
14872             FD->setInvalidDecl();
14873           } else {
14874             // Falling off the end of the function is the same as 'return;'.
14875             Expr *Dummy = nullptr;
14876             if (DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr(
14877                     FD, dcl->getLocation(), Dummy,
14878                     FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()))
14879               FD->setInvalidDecl();
14880           }
14881         }
14882       } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) {
14883         // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call
14884         // operators because we don't support return type deduction.
14885         auto *LSI = getCurLambda();
14886         if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) {
14887           deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI);
14888 
14889           // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4:
14890           //   [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement
14891           //   [the deduced type is] the type void
14892           QualType RetType =
14893               LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType;
14894 
14895           // Update the return type to the deduced type.
14896           const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14897           FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(),
14898                                               Proto->getExtProtoInfo()));
14899         }
14900       }
14901 
14902       // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked,
14903       // don't complain about missing return statements.
14904       if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>())
14905         WP.disableCheckFallThrough();
14906 
14907       // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition,
14908       // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct.
14909       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine())
14910         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition);
14911 
14912       if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
14913         // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted, deleted or naked
14914         // functions.
14915         if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody() &&
14916             !FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>())
14917           DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters());
14918         DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(),
14919                                                FD->getReturnType(), FD);
14920 
14921         // If this is a structor, we need a vtable.
14922         if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD))
14923           MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent());
14924         else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
14925                      dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD))
14926           MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent());
14927 
14928         // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check
14929         // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around
14930         // to deduce an implicit return type.
14931         if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() &&
14932             (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext()))
14933           computeNRVO(Body, FSI);
14934       }
14935 
14936       // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes:
14937       //   Warn if a global function is defined without a previous
14938       //   prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the
14939       //   definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect
14940       //   global functions that fail to be declared in header files.
14941       const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr;
14942       if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) {
14943         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD;
14944 
14945         if (PossiblePrototype) {
14946           // We found a declaration that is not a prototype,
14947           // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype
14948           if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
14949             TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc();
14950             if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>())
14951               Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(),
14952                    diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype)
14953                   << (FD->getNumParams() != 0)
14954                   << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
14955                                                     FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void")
14956                                               : FixItHint{});
14957           }
14958         } else {
14959           // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`.
14960           auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM,
14961                                   const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
14962             std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc);
14963             if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid())
14964               return false;
14965 
14966             bool Invalid = false;
14967             StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid);
14968             if (Invalid)
14969               return false;
14970 
14971             if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size())
14972               return false;
14973 
14974             const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second;
14975             StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second);
14976 
14977             return StartTok.consume_front("const") &&
14978                    (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) ||
14979                     StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//"));
14980           };
14981 
14982           auto findBeginLoc = [&]() {
14983             // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert
14984             // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename).
14985             if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
14986                  FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) ||
14987                 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) {
14988               // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is.
14989 
14990               if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(),
14991                                getLangOpts()))
14992 
14993                 return FD->getBeginLoc();
14994             }
14995             return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc();
14996           };
14997           Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(),
14998                diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage)
14999               << /* function */ 1
15000               << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None
15001                       ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ")
15002                       : FixItHint{});
15003         }
15004       }
15005 
15006       // If the function being defined does not have a prototype, then we may
15007       // need to diagnose it as changing behavior in C2x because we now know
15008       // whether the function accepts arguments or not. This only handles the
15009       // case where the definition has no prototype but does have parameters
15010       // and either there is no previous potential prototype, or the previous
15011       // potential prototype also has no actual prototype. This handles cases
15012       // like:
15013       //   void f(); void f(a) int a; {}
15014       //   void g(a) int a; {}
15015       // See MergeFunctionDecl() for other cases of the behavior change
15016       // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function
15017       // type without a prototype.
15018       if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype() && FD->getNumParams() != 0 &&
15019           (!PossiblePrototype || (!PossiblePrototype->hasWrittenPrototype() &&
15020                                   !PossiblePrototype->isImplicit()))) {
15021         // The function definition has parameters, so this will change behavior
15022         // in C2x. If there is a possible prototype, it comes before the
15023         // function definition.
15024         // FIXME: The declaration may have already been diagnosed as being
15025         // deprecated in GetFullTypeForDeclarator() if it had no arguments, but
15026         // there's no way to test for the "changes behavior" condition in
15027         // SemaType.cpp when forming the declaration's function type. So, we do
15028         // this awkward dance instead.
15029         //
15030         // If we have a possible prototype and it declares a function with a
15031         // prototype, we don't want to diagnose it; if we have a possible
15032         // prototype and it has no prototype, it may have already been
15033         // diagnosed in SemaType.cpp as deprecated depending on whether
15034         // -Wstrict-prototypes is enabled. If we already warned about it being
15035         // deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we didn't
15036         // warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is not
15037         // enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior.
15038 
15039         // This K&R C function definition definitely changes behavior in C2x,
15040         // so diagnose it.
15041         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior)
15042             << /*definition*/ 1 << /* not supported in C2x */ 0;
15043 
15044         // If we have a possible prototype for the function which is a user-
15045         // visible declaration, we already tested that it has no prototype.
15046         // This will change behavior in C2x. This gets a warning rather than a
15047         // note because it's the same behavior-changing problem as with the
15048         // definition.
15049         if (PossiblePrototype)
15050           Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(),
15051                diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior)
15052               << /*declaration*/ 0 << /* conflicting */ 1 << /*subsequent*/ 1
15053               << /*definition*/ 1;
15054       }
15055 
15056       // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body.
15057       if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body)
15058         if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body))
15059           if (!CmpndBody->body_empty())
15060             Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(),
15061                  diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored);
15062 
15063       if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
15064         const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction;
15065         if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) &&
15066             MD->isVirtual() &&
15067             (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) &&
15068             MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) {
15069           // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI.
15070           if (FD->isInlined() &&
15071               !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
15072             Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD);
15073 
15074             // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we
15075             // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively.
15076             KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent());
15077             const FunctionDecl *Definition;
15078             if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition))
15079               MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true);
15080           } else {
15081             // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used.
15082             MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true);
15083           }
15084         }
15085       }
15086 
15087       assert(
15088           (FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) &&
15089           "Function parsing confused");
15090     } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
15091       assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused");
15092       MD->setBody(Body);
15093       if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) {
15094         DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(),
15095                                                MD->getReturnType(), MD);
15096 
15097         if (Body)
15098           computeNRVO(Body, FSI);
15099       }
15100       if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) {
15101         Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call)
15102             << MD->getSelector().getAsString();
15103         FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false;
15104       }
15105       if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) {
15106         const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr;
15107         bool isDesignated =
15108             MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod);
15109         assert(isDesignated && InitMethod);
15110         (void)isDesignated;
15111 
15112         auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) {
15113           auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
15114           if (!IFace)
15115             return false;
15116           auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass();
15117           if (!SuperD)
15118             return false;
15119           return SuperD->getIdentifier() ==
15120                  NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject);
15121         };
15122         // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses
15123         // of NSObject.
15124         if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) {
15125           Diag(MD->getLocation(),
15126                diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call);
15127           Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(),
15128                diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here);
15129         }
15130         FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false;
15131       }
15132       if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) {
15133         // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits.
15134         if (!MD->isUnavailable())
15135           Diag(MD->getLocation(),
15136                diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call);
15137         FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false;
15138       }
15139 
15140       diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this);
15141     } else {
15142       // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope
15143       // we pushed on.
15144       PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl);
15145       return nullptr;
15146     }
15147 
15148     if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations)
15149       DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl);
15150 
15151     assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper &&
15152            "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been "
15153            "handled in the block above.");
15154 
15155     // Verify and clean out per-function state.
15156     if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) {
15157       // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return
15158       // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14)
15159       // Verify this.
15160       if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body))
15161         DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body));
15162 
15163       // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally.
15164       if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
15165         DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body);
15166 
15167       if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) {
15168         if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType())
15169           CheckDestructor(Destructor);
15170 
15171         MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(),
15172                                                Destructor->getParent());
15173       }
15174 
15175       // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have
15176       // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up
15177       // for deletion in some later function.
15178       if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() ||
15179           getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) {
15180         DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
15181       }
15182       if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
15183         // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are
15184         // enabled.
15185         ActivePolicy = &WP;
15186       }
15187 
15188       if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() &&
15189           !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose))
15190         FD->setInvalidDecl();
15191 
15192       if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) {
15193         for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) {
15194           // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't
15195           // require prologue.
15196           bool RegisterVariables = false;
15197           if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) {
15198             for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) {
15199               if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) {
15200                 RegisterVariables =
15201                     Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit();
15202                 if (!RegisterVariables)
15203                   break;
15204               }
15205             }
15206           }
15207           if (RegisterVariables)
15208             continue;
15209           if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) {
15210             Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function);
15211             Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute);
15212             FD->setInvalidDecl();
15213             break;
15214           }
15215         }
15216       }
15217 
15218       assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() ==
15219                  ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects &&
15220              "Leftover temporaries in function");
15221       assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() &&
15222              "Unaccounted cleanups in function");
15223       assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() &&
15224              "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking");
15225     }
15226   } // Pops the ExitFunctionBodyRAII scope, which needs to happen before we pop
15227     // the declaration context below. Otherwise, we're unable to transform
15228     // 'this' expressions when transforming immediate context functions.
15229 
15230   if (!IsInstantiation)
15231     PopDeclContext();
15232 
15233   PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl);
15234   // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have
15235   // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for
15236   // deletion in some later function.
15237   if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) {
15238     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
15239   }
15240 
15241   if (FD && ((LangOpts.OpenMP && (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice ||
15242                                   !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty())) ||
15243              LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) {
15244     auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD);
15245     if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted ||
15246         ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown)
15247       DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD);
15248   }
15249 
15250   if (FD && !FD->isDeleted())
15251     checkTypeSupport(FD->getType(), FD->getLocation(), FD);
15252 
15253   return dcl;
15254 }
15255 
15256 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the
15257 /// relevant Decl.
15258 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D,
15259                                        ParsedAttributes &Attrs) {
15260   // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl.
15261   if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D))
15262     D = TD->getTemplatedDecl();
15263   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs);
15264 
15265   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D))
15266     if (Method->isStatic())
15267       checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method);
15268 }
15269 
15270 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function
15271 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2).
15272 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc,
15273                                           IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) {
15274   // It is not valid to implicitly define a function in C2x.
15275   assert(LangOpts.implicitFunctionsAllowed() &&
15276          "Implicit function declarations aren't allowed in this language mode");
15277 
15278   // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding
15279   // DeclContext.
15280   // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope.
15281   // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope
15282   // instead.
15283   Scope *BlockScope = S;
15284   while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent())
15285     BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent();
15286 
15287   Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope;
15288   while (!ContextScope->getEntity())
15289     ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent();
15290   ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity());
15291 
15292   // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined
15293   // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of
15294   // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that
15295   // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it.
15296   NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II);
15297   if (ExternCPrev) {
15298     // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so
15299     // that later (non-call) uses can see it.
15300     PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false);
15301 
15302     // C89 footnote 38:
15303     //   If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int",
15304     //   the behavior is undefined.
15305     if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) ||
15306         !Context.typesAreCompatible(
15307             cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(),
15308             Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) {
15309       Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration)
15310           << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99;
15311       Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15312       return ExternCPrev;
15313     }
15314   }
15315 
15316   // Extension in C99 (defaults to error). Legal in C89, but warn about it.
15317   unsigned diag_id;
15318   if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_"))
15319     diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown;
15320   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported.
15321   else if (getLangOpts().C99)
15322     diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl_c99;
15323   else
15324     diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl;
15325 
15326   TypoCorrection Corrected;
15327   // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit
15328   // function declaration is going to be treated as an error.
15329   //
15330   // Perform the corection before issuing the main diagnostic, as some consumers
15331   // use typo-correction callbacks to enhance the main diagnostic.
15332   if (S && !ExternCPrev &&
15333       (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error)) {
15334     DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{};
15335     Corrected = CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName,
15336                             S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError);
15337   }
15338 
15339   Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II;
15340   if (Corrected) {
15341     // If the correction is going to suggest an implicitly defined function,
15342     // skip the correction as not being a particularly good idea.
15343     bool Diagnose = true;
15344     if (const auto *D = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl())
15345       Diagnose = !D->isImplicit();
15346     if (Diagnose)
15347       diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion),
15348                    /*ErrorRecovery*/ false);
15349   }
15350 
15351   // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building
15352   // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing
15353   // more to do.
15354   if (ExternCPrev)
15355     return ExternCPrev;
15356 
15357   // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo();
15358   const char *Dummy;
15359   AttributeFactory attrFactory;
15360   DeclSpec DS(attrFactory);
15361   unsigned DiagID;
15362   bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID,
15363                                   Context.getPrintingPolicy());
15364   (void)Error; // Silence warning.
15365   assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!");
15366   SourceLocation NoLoc;
15367   Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Block);
15368   D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false,
15369                                              /*IsAmbiguous=*/false,
15370                                              /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc,
15371                                              /*Params=*/nullptr,
15372                                              /*NumParams=*/0,
15373                                              /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc,
15374                                              /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc,
15375                                              /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true,
15376                                              /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc,
15377                                              /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None,
15378                                              /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(),
15379                                              /*Exceptions=*/nullptr,
15380                                              /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr,
15381                                              /*NumExceptions=*/0,
15382                                              /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr,
15383                                              /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr,
15384                                              /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc,
15385                                              Loc, D),
15386                 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation());
15387   D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc);
15388 
15389   // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope.
15390   FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D));
15391   FD->setImplicit();
15392 
15393   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD);
15394 
15395   return FD;
15396 }
15397 
15398 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function
15399 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]),
15400 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard.
15401 ///
15402 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
15403 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
15404 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(
15405     FunctionDecl *FD) {
15406   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
15407     return;
15408 
15409   if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New &&
15410       FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New)
15411     return;
15412 
15413   Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam;
15414   bool IsNothrow = false;
15415   if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow))
15416     return;
15417 
15418   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4:
15419   //   An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification
15420   //   indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation
15421   //   function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by
15422   //   throwing an exception [...]
15423   if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>())
15424     FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15425 
15426   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2:
15427   //   An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of
15428   //   storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a
15429   //   replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different
15430   //   from any previously returned value p1 [...]
15431   //
15432   // However, this particular information is being added in codegen,
15433   // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new)
15434 
15435   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2:
15436   //   An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of
15437   //   storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a
15438   //   block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the
15439   //   requested size.
15440   if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) {
15441     FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(
15442         Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD),
15443         /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15444   }
15445 
15446   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3:
15447   //   For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful
15448   //   call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows:
15449   //   (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type
15450   //         std​::​align_­val_­t, the storage will have the alignment
15451   //         specified by the value of this argument.
15452   if (AlignmentParam && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) {
15453     FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(
15454         Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation()));
15455   }
15456 
15457   // FIXME:
15458   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3:
15459   //   For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful
15460   //   call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows:
15461   //   (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[],
15462   //         the storage is aligned for any object that does not have
15463   //         new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the
15464   //         requested size.
15465   //   (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not
15466   //         have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size.
15467 }
15468 
15469 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on
15470 /// the declaration of this function.
15471 ///
15472 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins
15473 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions
15474 /// like NSLog or printf.
15475 ///
15476 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
15477 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
15478 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) {
15479   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
15480     return;
15481 
15482   // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to
15483   // actual attributes.
15484   if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) {
15485     // Handle printf-formatting attributes.
15486     unsigned FormatIdx;
15487     bool HasVAListArg;
15488     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) {
15489       if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) {
15490         const char *fmt = "printf";
15491         unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams();
15492         if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf)
15493             FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
15494           fmt = "NSString";
15495         FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15496                                                &Context.Idents.get(fmt),
15497                                                FormatIdx+1,
15498                                                HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2,
15499                                                FD->getLocation()));
15500       }
15501     }
15502     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx,
15503                                              HasVAListArg)) {
15504      if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>())
15505        FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15506                                               &Context.Idents.get("scanf"),
15507                                               FormatIdx+1,
15508                                               HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2,
15509                                               FD->getLocation()));
15510     }
15511 
15512     // Handle automatically recognized callbacks.
15513     SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding;
15514     if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() &&
15515         Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding))
15516       FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit(
15517           Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation()));
15518 
15519     // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing
15520     // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM
15521     // intrinsics for such functions.
15522     if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() &&
15523         Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID))
15524       FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15525 
15526     // We make "fma" on GNU or Windows const because we know it does not set
15527     // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the
15528     // C standard.
15529     const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
15530     if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) &&
15531         !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) {
15532       switch (BuiltinID) {
15533       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma:
15534       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf:
15535       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal:
15536       case Builtin::BIfma:
15537       case Builtin::BIfmaf:
15538       case Builtin::BIfmal:
15539         FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15540         break;
15541       default:
15542         break;
15543       }
15544     }
15545 
15546     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) &&
15547         !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>())
15548       FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15549                                          FD->getLocation()));
15550     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>())
15551       FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15552     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>())
15553       FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15554     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>())
15555       FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15556     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) &&
15557         !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) {
15558       // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode
15559       // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host
15560       // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__.
15561       if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice !=
15562           Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID))
15563         FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15564       else
15565         FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15566     }
15567 
15568     // Add known guaranteed alignment for allocation functions.
15569     switch (BuiltinID) {
15570     case Builtin::BImemalign:
15571     case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc:
15572       if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>())
15573         FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15574                                                    FD->getLocation()));
15575       break;
15576     default:
15577       break;
15578     }
15579 
15580     // Add allocsize attribute for allocation functions.
15581     switch (BuiltinID) {
15582     case Builtin::BIcalloc:
15583       FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(
15584           Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), ParamIdx(2, FD), FD->getLocation()));
15585       break;
15586     case Builtin::BImemalign:
15587     case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc:
15588     case Builtin::BIrealloc:
15589       FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(2, FD),
15590                                                 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15591       break;
15592     case Builtin::BImalloc:
15593       FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15594                                                 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15595       break;
15596     default:
15597       break;
15598     }
15599   }
15600 
15601   AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD);
15602 
15603   // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot
15604   // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come
15605   // across.
15606   if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind &&
15607       FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) {
15608     const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
15609     if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None)
15610       FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15611   }
15612 
15613   IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier();
15614   if (!Name)
15615     return;
15616   if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
15617        FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) ||
15618       (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) &&
15619        cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() ==
15620        LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) {
15621     // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know
15622     // about.
15623   } else
15624     return;
15625 
15626   if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) {
15627     // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be
15628     // target-specific builtins, perhaps?
15629     if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>())
15630       FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15631                                              &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2,
15632                                              Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3,
15633                                              FD->getLocation()));
15634   }
15635 
15636   if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) {
15637     // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString,
15638     // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that.
15639     if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>())
15640       FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15641                                                 FD->getLocation()));
15642   }
15643 }
15644 
15645 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T,
15646                                     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
15647   assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator");
15648   assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type");
15649 
15650   if (!TInfo) {
15651     assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type");
15652     TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
15653   }
15654 
15655   // Scope manipulation handled by caller.
15656   TypedefDecl *NewTD =
15657       TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(),
15658                           D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo);
15659 
15660   // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration.
15661   if (D.isInvalidType()) {
15662     NewTD->setInvalidDecl();
15663     return NewTD;
15664   }
15665 
15666   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
15667     if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
15668       Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
15669           << 2 << NewTD
15670           << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
15671           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
15672                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
15673     else
15674       NewTD->setModulePrivate();
15675   }
15676 
15677   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8:
15678   //   If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or
15679   //   enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration
15680   //   to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the
15681   //   class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only.
15682   // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration.
15683   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) {
15684   case TST_enum:
15685   case TST_struct:
15686   case TST_interface:
15687   case TST_union:
15688   case TST_class: {
15689     TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl());
15690     setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD);
15691     break;
15692   }
15693 
15694   default:
15695     break;
15696   }
15697 
15698   return NewTD;
15699 }
15700 
15701 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration.
15702 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) {
15703   SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
15704   QualType T = TI->getType();
15705 
15706   if (T->isDependentType())
15707     return false;
15708 
15709   // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning
15710   // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C.
15711   if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>())
15712     if (BT->isInteger())
15713       return false;
15714 
15715   if (T->isBitIntType())
15716     return false;
15717 
15718   return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T;
15719 }
15720 
15721 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration.
15722 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid.
15723 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped,
15724                                   QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed,
15725                                   const EnumDecl *Prev) {
15726   if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) {
15727     Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch)
15728       << Prev->isScoped();
15729     Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15730     return true;
15731   }
15732 
15733   if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) {
15734     if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() &&
15735         !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() &&
15736         !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy,
15737                                         Prev->getIntegerType())) {
15738       // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration.
15739       Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch)
15740         << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType();
15741       Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration)
15742           << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange();
15743       return true;
15744     }
15745   } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) {
15746     Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch)
15747       << Prev->isFixed();
15748     Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15749     return true;
15750   }
15751 
15752   return false;
15753 }
15754 
15755 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for
15756 /// redeclaration diagnostic message.
15757 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only!
15758 ///
15759 /// \returns diagnostic %select index.
15760 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) {
15761   switch (Tag) {
15762   case TTK_Struct: return 0;
15763   case TTK_Interface: return 1;
15764   case TTK_Class:  return 2;
15765   default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!");
15766   }
15767 }
15768 
15769 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with
15770 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface).
15771 ///
15772 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible.
15773 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag)
15774 {
15775   return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface;
15776 }
15777 
15778 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl,
15779                                              TagTypeKind TTK) {
15780   if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl))
15781     return NTK_Typedef;
15782   else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl))
15783     return NTK_TypeAlias;
15784   else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl))
15785     return NTK_Template;
15786   else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl))
15787     return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate;
15788   else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl))
15789     return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument;
15790   switch (TTK) {
15791   case TTK_Struct:
15792   case TTK_Interface:
15793   case TTK_Class:
15794     return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct;
15795   case TTK_Union:
15796     return NTK_NonUnion;
15797   case TTK_Enum:
15798     return NTK_NonEnum;
15799   }
15800   llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK");
15801 }
15802 
15803 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable
15804 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration.
15805 ///
15806 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise.
15807 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous,
15808                                         TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition,
15809                                         SourceLocation NewTagLoc,
15810                                         const IdentifierInfo *Name) {
15811   // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3:
15812   //   The class-key or enum keyword present in the
15813   //   elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the
15814   //   declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier
15815   //   refers. This rule also applies to the form of
15816   //   elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or
15817   //   friend class since it can be construed as referring to the
15818   //   definition of the class. Thus, in any
15819   //   elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to
15820   //   refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be
15821   //   used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or
15822   //   struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9)
15823   //   declared using the class or struct class-key.
15824   TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind();
15825   if (OldTag != NewTag &&
15826       !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)))
15827     return false;
15828 
15829   // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags.
15830   // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point.
15831   if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))
15832     return true;
15833 
15834   // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored
15835   // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg)
15836   // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if
15837   // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched
15838   // declarations.
15839   auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) {
15840     return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch,
15841                                       Loc);
15842   };
15843   if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc))
15844     return true;
15845 
15846   auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) {
15847     return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation());
15848   };
15849   while (IsIgnored(Previous)) {
15850     Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl();
15851     if (!Previous)
15852       return true;
15853     OldTag = Previous->getTagKind();
15854   }
15855 
15856   bool isTemplate = false;
15857   if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous))
15858     isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate();
15859 
15860   if (inTemplateInstantiation()) {
15861     if (OldTag != NewTag) {
15862       // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches
15863       // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem.
15864       Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch)
15865         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15866         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag);
15867       // FIXME: Note previous location?
15868     }
15869     return true;
15870   }
15871 
15872   if (isDefinition) {
15873     // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each
15874     // one that doesn't match the current tag.
15875     if (Previous->getDefinition()) {
15876       // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions.
15877       return true;
15878     }
15879 
15880     bool previousMismatch = false;
15881     for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) {
15882       if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) {
15883         // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled.
15884         if (IsIgnored(I))
15885           continue;
15886 
15887         if (!previousMismatch) {
15888           previousMismatch = true;
15889           Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch)
15890             << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15891             << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind());
15892         }
15893         Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion)
15894           << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag)
15895           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(),
15896                TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag));
15897       }
15898     }
15899     return true;
15900   }
15901 
15902   // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if
15903   // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior
15904   // (non-ignored) declaration.
15905   const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition();
15906   if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef))
15907     PrevDef = nullptr;
15908   const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous;
15909   if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) {
15910     Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch)
15911       << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15912       << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag);
15913     Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use);
15914 
15915     // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it.
15916     if (PrevDef) {
15917       Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion)
15918         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind())
15919         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc),
15920              TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind()));
15921     }
15922   }
15923 
15924   return true;
15925 }
15926 
15927 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name
15928 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration.
15929 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet:
15930 ///   namespace N {
15931 ///     struct X;
15932 ///     namespace M {
15933 ///       struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; };
15934 ///     }
15935 ///   }
15936 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S,
15937                                          SourceLocation NameLoc) {
15938   // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see
15939   // if we get the same namespace back.  If we do not, continue until
15940   // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS.
15941   SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces;
15942   DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
15943   for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) {
15944     // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by
15945     // other namespaces.  Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain.
15946     NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC);
15947     if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace())
15948       return FixItHint();
15949     IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier();
15950     Namespaces.push_back(II);
15951     NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName(
15952         S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName);
15953     if (Lookup == Namespace)
15954       break;
15955   }
15956 
15957   // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and
15958   // build an NNS.
15959   SmallString<64> Insertion;
15960   llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion);
15961   if (DC->isTranslationUnit())
15962     OS << "::";
15963   std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end());
15964   for (auto *II : Namespaces)
15965     OS << II->getName() << "::";
15966   return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion);
15967 }
15968 
15969 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can
15970 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup
15971 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a
15972 /// using-declaration).
15973 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC,
15974                                          DeclContext *NewDC) {
15975   OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext();
15976   NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext();
15977 
15978   if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC))
15979     return true;
15980 
15981   // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either
15982   // encloses the other).
15983   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
15984       (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC)))
15985     return true;
15986 
15987   return false;
15988 }
15989 
15990 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'.  In the
15991 /// former case, Name will be non-null.  In the later case, Name will be null.
15992 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a
15993 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag.
15994 ///
15995 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or
15996 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration.
15997 ///
15998 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should
15999 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration.
16000 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK,
16001                      SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
16002                      IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
16003                      const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS,
16004                      SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc,
16005                      MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
16006                      bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent,
16007                      SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc,
16008                      bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType,
16009                      bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg,
16010                      SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
16011   // If this is not a definition, it must have a name.
16012   IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name;
16013   assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) &&
16014          "Nameless record must be a definition!");
16015   assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference);
16016 
16017   OwnedDecl = false;
16018   TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec);
16019   bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid();
16020 
16021   // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully.
16022   bool isMemberSpecialization = false;
16023   bool Invalid = false;
16024 
16025   // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters
16026   // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work
16027   // for non-C++ cases.
16028   if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 ||
16029       (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) {
16030     if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams =
16031             MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
16032                 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists,
16033                 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) {
16034       if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16035         Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template);
16036         return nullptr;
16037       }
16038 
16039       if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) {
16040         // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may
16041         // be a member of another template).
16042 
16043         if (Invalid)
16044           return nullptr;
16045 
16046         OwnedDecl = false;
16047         DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate(
16048             S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams,
16049             AS, ModulePrivateLoc,
16050             /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1,
16051             TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody);
16052         return Result.get();
16053       } else {
16054         // The "template<>" header is extraneous.
16055         Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams)
16056           << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name;
16057         isMemberSpecialization = true;
16058       }
16059     }
16060 
16061     if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization &&
16062         CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back()))
16063       return nullptr;
16064   }
16065 
16066   // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do
16067   // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible
16068   // redeclaration.
16069   llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying;
16070   bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum;
16071 
16072   if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16073     if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) {
16074       // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the
16075       // type, default to int.
16076       EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16077     } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) {
16078       // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an
16079       // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored.
16080       TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr;
16081       GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI);
16082       EnumUnderlying = TI;
16083 
16084       if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI))
16085         // Recover by falling back to int.
16086         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16087 
16088       if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI,
16089                                           UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType))
16090         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16091 
16092     } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) {
16093       // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type
16094       // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set
16095       // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This
16096       // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming.
16097       if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16098         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16099     }
16100   }
16101 
16102   DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext;
16103   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
16104   bool isStdBadAlloc = false;
16105   bool isStdAlignValT = false;
16106 
16107   RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext();
16108   if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference)
16109     Redecl = NotForRedeclaration;
16110 
16111   /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C
16112   /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl
16113   /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed.
16114   auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * {
16115     assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage");
16116     // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the
16117     // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union
16118     // keyword.
16119     SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc;
16120     TagDecl *New = nullptr;
16121 
16122     if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16123       New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr,
16124                              ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed);
16125       // If this is an undefined enum, bail.
16126       if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid)
16127         return nullptr;
16128       if (EnumUnderlying) {
16129         EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16130         if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>())
16131           ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI);
16132         else
16133           ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0));
16134         ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType());
16135       }
16136     } else { // struct/union
16137       New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16138                                nullptr);
16139     }
16140 
16141     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) {
16142       // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked
16143       // when the ASTContext lays out the structure.
16144       //
16145       // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this
16146       // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is
16147       // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at
16148       // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because
16149       // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the
16150       // parsing of the struct).
16151       if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) {
16152         AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD);
16153         AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD);
16154       }
16155     }
16156     New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
16157     return New;
16158   };
16159 
16160   LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl);
16161   if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) {
16162     // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar').
16163 
16164     // Check for invalid 'foo::'.
16165     if (SS.isInvalid()) {
16166       Name = nullptr;
16167       goto CreateNewDecl;
16168     }
16169 
16170     // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent
16171     // context, don't try to make a decl for it.
16172     if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) {
16173       DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
16174       if (!DC) {
16175         IsDependent = true;
16176         return nullptr;
16177       }
16178     } else {
16179       DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true);
16180       if (!DC) {
16181         Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec)
16182           << SS.getRange();
16183         return nullptr;
16184       }
16185     }
16186 
16187     if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
16188       return nullptr;
16189 
16190     SearchDC = DC;
16191     // Look-up name inside 'foo::'.
16192     LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC);
16193 
16194     if (Previous.isAmbiguous())
16195       return nullptr;
16196 
16197     if (Previous.empty()) {
16198       // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the
16199       // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation,
16200       // and that current instantiation has any dependent base
16201       // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat
16202       // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier.
16203       // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups.
16204       if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() &&
16205           (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) {
16206         IsDependent = true;
16207         return nullptr;
16208       }
16209 
16210       // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist.
16211       Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope)
16212         << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
16213       Name = nullptr;
16214       Invalid = true;
16215       goto CreateNewDecl;
16216     }
16217   } else if (Name) {
16218     // C++14 [class.mem]p14:
16219     //   If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
16220     //   name different from T:
16221     //    -- every member of class T that is itself a type
16222     if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend &&
16223         DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc)))
16224       return nullptr;
16225 
16226     // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward
16227     // declaration or definition.
16228     // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we
16229     // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we
16230     // shouldn't be diagnosing.
16231     LookupName(Previous, S);
16232 
16233     // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced
16234     // by types using'ed into this scope.
16235     if (Previous.isAmbiguous() &&
16236         (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) {
16237       LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter();
16238       while (F.hasNext()) {
16239         NamedDecl *ND = F.next();
16240         if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
16241                 SearchDC->getRedeclContext()))
16242           F.erase();
16243       }
16244       F.done();
16245     }
16246 
16247     // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3:
16248     //   If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor
16249     //   a template-id and the declaration is a function or an
16250     //   elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether
16251     //   the entity has been previously declared shall not consider
16252     //   any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace.
16253     //
16254     // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag
16255     // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing
16256     // scope.  They do implement this rule for friend functions.
16257     //
16258     // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by
16259     // semantic context?
16260     if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16261       DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
16262       LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter();
16263       bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false;
16264       while (F.hasNext()) {
16265         NamedDecl *ND = F.next();
16266         DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
16267         if (DC->isFileContext() &&
16268             !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) {
16269           if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16270             FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true;
16271           else
16272             F.erase();
16273         }
16274       }
16275       F.done();
16276 
16277       // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have
16278       // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace.
16279       if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) {
16280         NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl();
16281         Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace)
16282             << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc);
16283       }
16284     }
16285 
16286     // Note:  there used to be some attempt at recovery here.
16287     if (Previous.isAmbiguous())
16288       return nullptr;
16289 
16290     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) {
16291       // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated
16292       // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching
16293       // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak
16294       // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this?
16295       while (isa<RecordDecl, EnumDecl, ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC))
16296         SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
16297     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16298       // Inside ObjCContainer want to keep it as a lexical decl context but go
16299       // past it (most often to TranslationUnit) to find the semantic decl
16300       // context.
16301       while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC))
16302         SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
16303     }
16304   } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16305     // Don't use ObjCContainerDecl as the semantic decl context for anonymous
16306     // TagDecl the same way as we skip it for named TagDecl.
16307     while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC))
16308       SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
16309   }
16310 
16311   if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
16312       Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) {
16313     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
16314     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl());
16315     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
16316     Previous.clear();
16317   }
16318 
16319   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace &&
16320       DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) {
16321     if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) {
16322       // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc".
16323       isStdBadAlloc = true;
16324 
16325       // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to
16326       // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous
16327       // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately.
16328       if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc)
16329         Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc());
16330     } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) {
16331       isStdAlignValT = true;
16332       if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT)
16333         Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT());
16334     }
16335   }
16336 
16337   // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference
16338   // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope.  In C++, we
16339   // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case
16340   // there's a shadow friend decl.
16341   if (Name && Previous.empty() &&
16342       (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) {
16343     if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl;
16344     assert(SS.isEmpty());
16345 
16346     if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) {
16347       // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5:
16348       //   -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form
16349       //
16350       //          class-key identifier
16351       //
16352       //      if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the
16353       //      decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a
16354       //      function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is
16355       //      declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains
16356       //      the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend
16357       //      declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest
16358       //      non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the
16359       //      declaration.
16360       //
16361       // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for
16362       // C structs and unions.
16363       //
16364       // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum
16365       // type, including via an elaborated type specifier.  We'll
16366       // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same
16367       // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type.
16368       //
16369       // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete
16370       // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not.
16371       //
16372       // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag.
16373       // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the
16374       // lexical context,
16375       SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC);
16376 
16377       // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag.
16378       S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts());
16379     } else {
16380       assert(TUK == TUK_Friend);
16381       // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3:
16382       //   If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a
16383       //   class or function, the friend class or function is a member of
16384       //   the innermost enclosing namespace.
16385       SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
16386     }
16387 
16388     // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly
16389     // diagnose some problems.
16390     // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a
16391     // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a
16392     // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier.  In C that is not correct
16393     // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup.
16394     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16395       // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts,
16396       // which are meaningless.
16397       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext());
16398       LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC);
16399     } else {
16400       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext());
16401       LookupName(Previous, S);
16402     }
16403   }
16404 
16405   // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it.
16406   if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous)
16407     Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous);
16408 
16409   if (!Previous.empty()) {
16410     NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl();
16411     NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
16412 
16413     // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef
16414     // which hides a tag decl in the same scope.  Finding this
16415     // with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen in C++.
16416     //
16417     // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is
16418     // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is
16419     // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue;
16420     // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407
16421     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16422       if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16423         if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) {
16424           TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
16425           if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name &&
16426               Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()
16427                           ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) {
16428             PrevDecl = Tag;
16429             Previous.clear();
16430             Previous.addDecl(Tag);
16431             Previous.resolveKind();
16432           }
16433         }
16434       }
16435     }
16436 
16437     // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must
16438     // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a
16439     // redefinition if either context is within the other.
16440     if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) {
16441       auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl);
16442       if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend &&
16443           isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) &&
16444           !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(
16445                           *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) {
16446         Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse);
16447         Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(),
16448              diag::note_using_decl_target);
16449         Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl)
16450             << 0;
16451         // Recover by ignoring the old declaration.
16452         Previous.clear();
16453         goto CreateNewDecl;
16454       }
16455     }
16456 
16457     if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16458       // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared
16459       // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or
16460       // rementions the tag), reuse the decl.
16461       if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend ||
16462           isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S,
16463                         SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) {
16464         // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a
16465         // struct or something similar.
16466         if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind,
16467                                           TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc,
16468                                           Name)) {
16469           bool SafeToContinue
16470             = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum &&
16471                Kind != TTK_Enum);
16472           if (SafeToContinue)
16473             Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag)
16474               << Name
16475               << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc),
16476                                               PrevTagDecl->getKindName());
16477           else
16478             Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name;
16479           Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use);
16480 
16481           if (SafeToContinue)
16482             Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind();
16483           else {
16484             // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition.
16485             Name = nullptr;
16486             Previous.clear();
16487             Invalid = true;
16488           }
16489         }
16490 
16491         if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) {
16492           const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl);
16493           if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)
16494             return PrevTagDecl;
16495 
16496           QualType EnumUnderlyingTy;
16497           if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>())
16498             EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
16499           else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>())
16500             EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0);
16501 
16502           // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by
16503           // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition,
16504           // in which case we want the caller to bail out.
16505           if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc,
16506                                      ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy,
16507                                      IsFixed, PrevEnum))
16508             return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr;
16509         }
16510 
16511         // C++11 [class.mem]p1:
16512         //   A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification,
16513         //   except that a nested class or member class template can be declared
16514         //   and then later defined.
16515         if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() &&
16516             S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) {
16517           Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared);
16518           Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
16519         }
16520 
16521         if (!Invalid) {
16522           // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless
16523           // we have attributes.
16524           if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16525             if (!Attrs.empty()) {
16526               // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new
16527               // declaration to hold them.
16528             } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference &&
16529                        (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() ==
16530                             Decl::FOK_Undeclared ||
16531                         PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) &&
16532                        SS.isEmpty()) {
16533               // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but
16534               // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes
16535               // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module.
16536               // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if
16537               // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior
16538               // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same
16539               // scope where we would have injected a declaration.
16540               if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext()
16541                        ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()))
16542                 return PrevTagDecl;
16543               // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in
16544               // that scope.
16545               S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts());
16546             } else {
16547               return PrevTagDecl;
16548             }
16549           }
16550 
16551           // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag.
16552           if (TUK == TUK_Definition) {
16553             if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) {
16554               // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition
16555               // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error
16556               // here; we'll catch this in the general case below.
16557               bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false;
16558               if (isMemberSpecialization) {
16559                 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def))
16560                   IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation =
16561                     RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() !=
16562                     TSK_ExplicitSpecialization;
16563                 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def))
16564                   IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation =
16565                     ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() !=
16566                     TSK_ExplicitSpecialization;
16567               }
16568 
16569               // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do
16570               // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However,
16571               // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in
16572               // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89).
16573               NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr;
16574               if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) {
16575                 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We
16576                 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and
16577                 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one
16578                 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and
16579                 // use it in place of this one.
16580                 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16581                   // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we
16582                   // complete parsing the new one and do the structural
16583                   // comparison.
16584                   SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true;
16585                   SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl();
16586                   SkipBody->Previous = Def;
16587                   return Def;
16588                 } else {
16589                   SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true;
16590                   SkipBody->Previous = Def;
16591                   makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden);
16592                   // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll
16593                   // skip starting the definitiion later.
16594                 }
16595               } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) {
16596                 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't
16597                 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning.
16598                 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope())
16599                   Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name;
16600                 else
16601                   Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name;
16602                 notePreviousDefinition(Def,
16603                                        NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc);
16604                 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this
16605                 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later
16606                 // references get the previous definition.
16607                 Name = nullptr;
16608                 Previous.clear();
16609                 Invalid = true;
16610               }
16611             } else {
16612               // If the type is currently being defined, complain
16613               // about a nested redefinition.
16614               auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl();
16615               if (TD->isBeingDefined()) {
16616                 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name;
16617                 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(),
16618                      diag::note_previous_definition);
16619                 Name = nullptr;
16620                 Previous.clear();
16621                 Invalid = true;
16622               }
16623             }
16624 
16625             // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced
16626             // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it.
16627           }
16628 
16629           // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration.  If this is some kind
16630           // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC
16631           // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier.
16632           if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) {
16633             SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext();
16634             AS = AS_none;
16635           }
16636         }
16637         // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we
16638         // have a definition.  Just create a new decl.
16639 
16640       } else {
16641         // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested
16642         // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a
16643         // new decl/type.  We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities
16644         // have distinct types.
16645         Previous.clear();
16646       }
16647       // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl
16648       // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by
16649       // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition.
16650 
16651     // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag
16652     // lookup.  This is only actually possible in C++, where a few
16653     // things like templates still live in the tag namespace.
16654     } else {
16655       // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier
16656       // found the wrong kind of type on the first
16657       // (non-redeclaration) lookup.
16658       if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) &&
16659           !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) {
16660         NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind);
16661         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK
16662                                                        << Kind;
16663         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
16664         Invalid = true;
16665 
16666       // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope.
16667       } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S,
16668                                 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) {
16669         // do nothing
16670 
16671       // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types.
16672       } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16673         NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind);
16674         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK;
16675         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl;
16676         Invalid = true;
16677 
16678       // Otherwise it's a declaration.  Call out a particularly common
16679       // case here.
16680       } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16681         unsigned Kind = 0;
16682         if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1;
16683         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef)
16684           << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType();
16685         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl;
16686         Invalid = true;
16687 
16688       // Otherwise, diagnose.
16689       } else {
16690         // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope,
16691         // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous.
16692         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name;
16693         notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc);
16694         Name = nullptr;
16695         Invalid = true;
16696       }
16697 
16698       // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a
16699       // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration.
16700       Previous.clear();
16701     }
16702   }
16703 
16704 CreateNewDecl:
16705 
16706   TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr;
16707   if (Previous.isSingleResult())
16708     PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
16709 
16710   // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the
16711   // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union
16712   // keyword.
16713   SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc;
16714 
16715   // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous
16716   // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via
16717   // PrevDecl.
16718   TagDecl *New;
16719 
16720   if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16721     // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.:
16722     // enum X { A, B, C } D;    D should chain to X.
16723     New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16724                            cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum,
16725                            ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed);
16726 
16727     if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit()))
16728       StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16729 
16730     // If this is an undefined enum, warn.
16731     if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) {
16732       TagDecl *Def;
16733       if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) {
16734         // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration.
16735         // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing.
16736       }
16737       else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) {
16738         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def)
16739           << New;
16740         Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
16741       } else {
16742         unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum;
16743         if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16744           DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum;
16745         else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
16746           DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum;
16747         Diag(Loc, DiagID);
16748       }
16749     }
16750 
16751     if (EnumUnderlying) {
16752       EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16753       if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>())
16754         ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI);
16755       else
16756         ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0));
16757       ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType());
16758       assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete");
16759     }
16760   } else {
16761     // struct/union/class
16762 
16763     // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.:
16764     // struct X { int A; } D;    D should chain to X.
16765     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16766       // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs.
16767       New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16768                                   cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl));
16769 
16770       if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit()))
16771         StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New);
16772     } else
16773       New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16774                                cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl));
16775   }
16776 
16777   // C++11 [dcl.type]p3:
16778   //   A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...].
16779   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) &&
16780       TUK == TUK_Definition) {
16781     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier)
16782       << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16783     Invalid = true;
16784   }
16785 
16786   if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition &&
16787       DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) {
16788     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum)
16789       << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16790     Invalid = true;
16791   }
16792 
16793   // Maybe add qualifier info.
16794   if (SS.isNotEmpty()) {
16795     if (SS.isSet()) {
16796       // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the
16797       // nested-name-specifier against the current context.
16798       if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) &&
16799           diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc,
16800                                        isMemberSpecialization))
16801         Invalid = true;
16802 
16803       New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
16804       if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) {
16805         New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists);
16806       }
16807     }
16808     else
16809       Invalid = true;
16810   }
16811 
16812   if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) {
16813     // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when
16814     // the ASTContext lays out the structure.
16815     //
16816     // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this
16817     // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is
16818     // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at
16819     // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because
16820     // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the
16821     // parsing of the struct).
16822     if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) {
16823       AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD);
16824       AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD);
16825     }
16826   }
16827 
16828   if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) {
16829     if (isMemberSpecialization)
16830       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
16831         << 2
16832         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc);
16833     // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only
16834     // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are
16835     // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__.
16836     else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod())
16837       New->setModulePrivate();
16838   }
16839 
16840   // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template),
16841   // check the specialization.
16842   if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous))
16843     Invalid = true;
16844 
16845   // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C,
16846   // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to
16847   // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope.
16848   if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) &&
16849       getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) {
16850     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16851       // C++ [dcl.fct]p6:
16852       //   Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types.
16853       if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) {
16854         Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type)
16855             << Name;
16856         Invalid = true;
16857       }
16858     } else if (!PrevDecl) {
16859       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16860     }
16861   }
16862 
16863   if (Invalid)
16864     New->setInvalidDecl();
16865 
16866   // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the
16867   // lexical context will be different from the semantic context.
16868   New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
16869 
16870   // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable.
16871   // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward
16872   // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make
16873   // the tag name visible.
16874   if (TUK == TUK_Friend)
16875     New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat);
16876 
16877   // Set the access specifier.
16878   if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord())
16879     SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS);
16880 
16881   if (PrevDecl)
16882     CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, PrevDecl);
16883 
16884   if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip))
16885     New->startDefinition();
16886 
16887   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs);
16888   AddPragmaAttributes(S, New);
16889 
16890   // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
16891   if (TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16892     // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables;
16893     // if so, borrow its access specifier.
16894     if (PrevDecl)
16895       New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess());
16896 
16897     DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
16898     DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New);
16899     if (Name) // can be null along some error paths
16900       if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC))
16901         PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false);
16902   } else if (Name) {
16903     S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
16904     PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true);
16905   } else {
16906     CurContext->addDecl(New);
16907   }
16908 
16909   // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context.
16910   if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier())
16911     if (!New->isInvalidDecl() &&
16912         New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
16913         II->isStr("FILE"))
16914       Context.setFILEDecl(New);
16915 
16916   if (PrevDecl)
16917     mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl);
16918 
16919   if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New))
16920     inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD);
16921 
16922   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this
16923   // record.
16924   AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New);
16925 
16926   if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl())
16927     CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous);
16928 
16929   OwnedDecl = true;
16930   // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from
16931   // the cases where we make the type anonymous.
16932   if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16933     if (New->isBeingDefined())
16934       if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New))
16935         RD->completeDefinition();
16936     return nullptr;
16937   } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) {
16938     return SkipBody->Previous;
16939   } else {
16940     return New;
16941   }
16942 }
16943 
16944 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) {
16945   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16946   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
16947 
16948   // Enter the tag context.
16949   PushDeclContext(S, Tag);
16950 
16951   ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD);
16952 
16953   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this
16954   // record.
16955   AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag);
16956 }
16957 
16958 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) {
16959   if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New))
16960     return false;
16961 
16962   // Make the previous decl visible.
16963   makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous);
16964   return true;
16965 }
16966 
16967 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCContainerDecl *IDecl) {
16968   assert(IDecl->getLexicalParent() == CurContext &&
16969       "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
16970   CurContext = IDecl;
16971 }
16972 
16973 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD,
16974                                            SourceLocation FinalLoc,
16975                                            bool IsFinalSpelledSealed,
16976                                            bool IsAbstract,
16977                                            SourceLocation LBraceLoc) {
16978   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16979   CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD);
16980 
16981   FieldCollector->StartClass();
16982 
16983   if (!Record->getIdentifier())
16984     return;
16985 
16986   if (IsAbstract)
16987     Record->markAbstract();
16988 
16989   if (FinalLoc.isValid()) {
16990     Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create(
16991         Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword,
16992         static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed)));
16993   }
16994   // C++ [class]p2:
16995   //   [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the
16996   //   class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For
16997   //   purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated
16998   //   as if it were a public member name.
16999   CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create(
17000       Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(),
17001       Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(),
17002       /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
17003       /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true);
17004   Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record);
17005   InjectedClassName->setImplicit();
17006   InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public);
17007   if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate())
17008       InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template);
17009   PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S);
17010   assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() &&
17011          "Broken injected-class-name");
17012 }
17013 
17014 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD,
17015                                     SourceRange BraceRange) {
17016   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
17017   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
17018   Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange);
17019 
17020   // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid.
17021   if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) {
17022     assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it");
17023     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag))
17024       RD->completeDefinition();
17025   }
17026 
17027   if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
17028     FieldCollector->FinishClass();
17029     if (RD->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>()) {
17030       auto *Def = RD->getDefinition();
17031       assert(Def && "The record is expected to have a completed definition");
17032       unsigned NumInitMethods = 0;
17033       for (auto *Method : Def->methods()) {
17034         if (!Method->getIdentifier())
17035             continue;
17036         if (Method->getName() == "__init")
17037           NumInitMethods++;
17038       }
17039       if (NumInitMethods > 1 || !Def->hasInitMethod())
17040         Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::err_sycl_special_type_num_init_method);
17041     }
17042   }
17043 
17044   // Exit this scope of this tag's definition.
17045   PopDeclContext();
17046 
17047   if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() &&
17048       Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
17049     Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
17050 
17051   // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag.
17052   if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl())
17053     Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag);
17054 
17055   // Clangs implementation of #pragma align(packed) differs in bitfield layout
17056   // from XLs and instead matches the XL #pragma pack(1) behavior.
17057   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSAIX() &&
17058       AlignPackStack.hasValue()) {
17059     AlignPackInfo APInfo = AlignPackStack.CurrentValue;
17060     // Only diagnose #pragma align(packed).
17061     if (!APInfo.IsAlignAttr() || APInfo.getAlignMode() != AlignPackInfo::Packed)
17062       return;
17063     const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag);
17064     if (!RD)
17065       return;
17066     // Only warn if there is at least 1 bitfield member.
17067     if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(),
17068                      [](const FieldDecl *FD) { return FD->isBitField(); }))
17069       Diag(BraceRange.getBegin(), diag::warn_pragma_align_not_xl_compatible);
17070   }
17071 }
17072 
17073 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() {
17074   // Exit this scope of this interface definition.
17075   PopDeclContext();
17076 }
17077 
17078 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) {
17079   assert(ObjCCtx == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts");
17080   OriginalLexicalContext = ObjCCtx;
17081   ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition();
17082 }
17083 
17084 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) {
17085   ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCCtx);
17086   OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr;
17087 }
17088 
17089 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) {
17090   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
17091   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
17092   Tag->setInvalidDecl();
17093 
17094   // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid.
17095   if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) {
17096     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag))
17097       RD->completeDefinition();
17098   }
17099 
17100   // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not
17101   // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with
17102   // the FieldCollector.
17103 
17104   PopDeclContext();
17105 }
17106 
17107 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields.
17108 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc,
17109                                 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy,
17110                                 bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth) {
17111   assert(BitWidth);
17112   if (BitWidth->containsErrors())
17113     return ExprError();
17114 
17115   // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type.
17116   // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type.
17117   if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
17118     // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error.
17119     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy,
17120                                  diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless))
17121       return ExprError();
17122     if (FieldName)
17123       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield)
17124         << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange();
17125     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield)
17126       << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange();
17127   } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth),
17128                                              UPPC_BitFieldWidth))
17129     return ExprError();
17130 
17131   // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check
17132   // it now.
17133   if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent())
17134     return BitWidth;
17135 
17136   llvm::APSInt Value;
17137   ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold);
17138   if (ICE.isInvalid())
17139     return ICE;
17140   BitWidth = ICE.get();
17141 
17142   // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field.
17143   if (Value == 0 && FieldName)
17144     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName;
17145 
17146   if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) {
17147     if (FieldName)
17148       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width)
17149                << FieldName << toString(Value, 10);
17150     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width)
17151       << toString(Value, 10);
17152   }
17153 
17154   // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object
17155   // size.
17156   if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) {
17157     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide)
17158            << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10);
17159   }
17160 
17161   if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) {
17162     uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy);
17163     uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy);
17164     bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth);
17165 
17166     // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield
17167     // ABI.
17168     bool CStdConstraintViolation =
17169         BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
17170     bool MSBitfieldViolation =
17171         Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) &&
17172         (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft());
17173     if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) {
17174       unsigned DiagWidth =
17175           CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize;
17176       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width)
17177              << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10)
17178              << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth;
17179     }
17180 
17181     // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all
17182     // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than
17183     // 'bool'.
17184     if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) {
17185       Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width)
17186           << FieldName << toString(Value, 10)
17187           << (unsigned)TypeWidth;
17188     }
17189   }
17190 
17191   return BitWidth;
17192 }
17193 
17194 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order
17195 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it.
17196 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart,
17197                        Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) {
17198   FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD),
17199                                DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth),
17200                                /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public);
17201   return Res;
17202 }
17203 
17204 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member.
17205 ///
17206 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record,
17207                              SourceLocation DeclStart,
17208                              Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth,
17209                              InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
17210                              AccessSpecifier AS) {
17211   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
17212     const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator();
17213     Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context)
17214       << Decomp.getSourceRange();
17215     return nullptr;
17216   }
17217 
17218   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
17219   SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart;
17220   if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc();
17221 
17222   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
17223   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
17224   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17225     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
17226 
17227     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo,
17228                                         UPPC_DataMemberType)) {
17229       D.setInvalidType();
17230       T = Context.IntTy;
17231       TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc);
17232     }
17233   }
17234 
17235   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
17236 
17237   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified())
17238     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
17239         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
17240   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec())
17241     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
17242          diag::err_invalid_thread)
17243       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
17244 
17245   // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously
17246   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr;
17247   LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName,
17248                         ForVisibleRedeclaration);
17249   LookupName(Previous, S);
17250   switch (Previous.getResultKind()) {
17251     case LookupResult::Found:
17252     case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
17253       PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>();
17254       break;
17255 
17256     case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
17257       PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
17258       break;
17259 
17260     case LookupResult::NotFound:
17261     case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation:
17262     case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
17263       break;
17264   }
17265   Previous.suppressDiagnostics();
17266 
17267   if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
17268     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
17269     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl);
17270     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
17271     PrevDecl = nullptr;
17272   }
17273 
17274   if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S))
17275     PrevDecl = nullptr;
17276 
17277   bool Mutable
17278     = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable);
17279   SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc();
17280   FieldDecl *NewFD
17281     = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle,
17282                      TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D);
17283 
17284   if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
17285     Record->setInvalidDecl();
17286 
17287   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
17288     NewFD->setModulePrivate();
17289 
17290   if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) {
17291     // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something
17292     // with the same name in the same scope.
17293   } else if (II) {
17294     PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S);
17295   } else
17296     Record->addDecl(NewFD);
17297 
17298   return NewFD;
17299 }
17300 
17301 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness.
17302 ///
17303 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type,
17304 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration
17305 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be
17306 /// created.
17307 ///
17308 /// \returns a new FieldDecl.
17309 ///
17310 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once
17311 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T,
17312                                 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
17313                                 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc,
17314                                 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth,
17315                                 InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
17316                                 SourceLocation TSSL,
17317                                 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl,
17318                                 Declarator *D) {
17319   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
17320   bool InvalidDecl = false;
17321   if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType();
17322 
17323   // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and
17324   // marking this declaration as invalid.
17325   if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) {
17326     InvalidDecl = true;
17327     T = Context.IntTy;
17328   }
17329 
17330   QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T);
17331   if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) {
17332     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy,
17333                                  diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) {
17334       // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid.
17335       Record->setInvalidDecl();
17336       InvalidDecl = true;
17337     } else {
17338       NamedDecl *Def;
17339       EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def);
17340       if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) {
17341         Record->setInvalidDecl();
17342         InvalidDecl = true;
17343       }
17344     }
17345   }
17346 
17347   // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space
17348   if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() ||
17349       T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) {
17350     Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space);
17351     Record->setInvalidDecl();
17352     InvalidDecl = true;
17353   }
17354 
17355   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
17356     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be
17357     // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types.
17358     if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() ||
17359         T->isBlockPointerType()) {
17360       Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T;
17361       Record->setInvalidDecl();
17362       InvalidDecl = true;
17363     }
17364     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension
17365     // is enabled.
17366     if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
17367                         "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) {
17368       Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields);
17369       InvalidDecl = true;
17370     }
17371   }
17372 
17373   // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229).
17374   if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth &&
17375       T.hasQualifiers()) {
17376     InvalidDecl = true;
17377     Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers);
17378   }
17379 
17380   // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other
17381   // than a variably modified type.
17382   if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
17383     if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(
17384             TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size))
17385       InvalidDecl = true;
17386   }
17387 
17388   // Fields can not have abstract class types
17389   if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T,
17390                                              diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
17391                                              AbstractFieldType))
17392     InvalidDecl = true;
17393 
17394   if (InvalidDecl)
17395     BitWidth = nullptr;
17396   // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field.
17397   if (BitWidth) {
17398     BitWidth =
17399         VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth).get();
17400     if (!BitWidth) {
17401       InvalidDecl = true;
17402       BitWidth = nullptr;
17403     }
17404   }
17405 
17406   // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration.
17407   if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) {
17408     unsigned DiagID = 0;
17409     if (T->isReferenceType())
17410       DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference
17411                                         : diag::err_mutable_reference;
17412     else if (T.isConstQualified())
17413       DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const;
17414 
17415     if (DiagID) {
17416       SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc;
17417       if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid())
17418         ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc();
17419       Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID);
17420       if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) {
17421         Mutable = false;
17422         InvalidDecl = true;
17423       }
17424     }
17425   }
17426 
17427   // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460):
17428   //   At most one variant member of a union may have a
17429   //   brace-or-equal-initializer.
17430   if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit)
17431     checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc);
17432 
17433   FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo,
17434                                        BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle);
17435   if (InvalidDecl)
17436     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17437 
17438   if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
17439     Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II;
17440     Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
17441     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17442   }
17443 
17444   if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17445     if (Record->isUnion()) {
17446       if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17447         CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
17448         if (RDecl->getDefinition()) {
17449           // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial
17450           // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial
17451           // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator
17452           // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such
17453           // objects.
17454           if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD))
17455             NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17456         }
17457       }
17458 
17459       // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type,
17460       // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions
17461       // enabled.
17462       if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) {
17463         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ?
17464                                     diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type :
17465                                     diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type)
17466           << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy;
17467         if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
17468           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17469       }
17470     }
17471   }
17472 
17473   // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST
17474   // representation, not a parser representation.
17475   if (D) {
17476     // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here.
17477     ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D);
17478 
17479     if (NewFD->hasAttrs())
17480       CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD);
17481   }
17482 
17483   // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of
17484   // retainable type.
17485   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD))
17486     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17487 
17488   if (T.isObjCGCWeak())
17489     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field);
17490 
17491   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types.
17492   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
17493       CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation()))
17494     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17495 
17496   NewFD->setAccess(AS);
17497   return NewFD;
17498 }
17499 
17500 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) {
17501   assert(FD);
17502   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++");
17503 
17504   if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType())
17505     return false;
17506 
17507   QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17508   if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17509     CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
17510     if (RDecl->getDefinition()) {
17511       // We check for copy constructors before constructors
17512       // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about
17513       // copy constructors.
17514 
17515       CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid;
17516       // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the
17517       // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any
17518       // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a
17519       // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't
17520       // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.)
17521       if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor())
17522         member = CXXCopyConstructor;
17523       else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor())
17524         member = CXXDefaultConstructor;
17525       else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment())
17526         member = CXXCopyAssignment;
17527       else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
17528         member = CXXDestructor;
17529 
17530       if (member != CXXInvalid) {
17531         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
17532             getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) {
17533           // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of
17534           // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs
17535           // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions,
17536           // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those
17537           // members unavailable.
17538           SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
17539           if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) {
17540             if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())
17541               FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "",
17542                             UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc));
17543             return false;
17544           }
17545         }
17546 
17547         Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
17548                diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member :
17549                diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member)
17550           << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member;
17551         DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member);
17552         return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11;
17553       }
17554     }
17555   }
17556 
17557   return false;
17558 }
17559 
17560 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an
17561 ///  AST enum value.
17562 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl
17563 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) {
17564   switch (ivarVisibility) {
17565   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind");
17566   case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private;
17567   case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public;
17568   case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected;
17569   case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package;
17570   }
17571 }
17572 
17573 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this
17574 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it.
17575 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S,
17576                                 SourceLocation DeclStart,
17577                                 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth,
17578                                 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) {
17579 
17580   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
17581   Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth;
17582   SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart;
17583   if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc();
17584 
17585   // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for
17586   // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace!
17587 
17588   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
17589   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
17590 
17591   if (BitWidth) {
17592     // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4
17593     BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get();
17594     if (!BitWidth)
17595       D.setInvalidType();
17596   } else {
17597     // Not a bitfield.
17598 
17599     // validate II.
17600 
17601   }
17602   if (T->isReferenceType()) {
17603     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type);
17604     D.setInvalidType();
17605   }
17606   // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other
17607   // than a variably modified type.
17608   else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
17609     if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(
17610             TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size))
17611       D.setInvalidType();
17612   }
17613 
17614   // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar.
17615   ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac =
17616     Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility)
17617                                         : ObjCIvarDecl::None;
17618   // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface.
17619   ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext);
17620   if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl())
17621     return nullptr;
17622   ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext;
17623   if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl =
17624       dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17625     if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) {
17626     // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class.
17627       EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface();
17628       assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!");
17629     }
17630     else
17631       EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl;
17632   } else {
17633     if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl =
17634         dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17635       if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) {
17636         Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension();
17637         return nullptr;
17638       }
17639     }
17640     EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl;
17641   }
17642 
17643   // Construct the decl.
17644   ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext,
17645                                              DeclStart, Loc, II, T,
17646                                              TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth);
17647 
17648   if (II) {
17649     NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName,
17650                                            ForVisibleRedeclaration);
17651     if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S)
17652         && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
17653       Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II;
17654       Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
17655       NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17656     }
17657   }
17658 
17659   // Process attributes attached to the ivar.
17660   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D);
17661 
17662   if (D.isInvalidType())
17663     NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17664 
17665   // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type.
17666   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID))
17667     NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17668 
17669   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
17670     NewID->setModulePrivate();
17671 
17672   if (II) {
17673     // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add
17674     // these to the interface.
17675     S->AddDecl(NewID);
17676     IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID);
17677   }
17678 
17679   if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() &&
17680       !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl))
17681     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface);
17682 
17683   return NewID;
17684 }
17685 
17686 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for
17687 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class
17688 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type,
17689 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface.
17690 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc,
17691                              SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) {
17692   if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty())
17693     return;
17694 
17695   Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1];
17696   ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl);
17697 
17698   if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context))
17699     return;
17700   ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext);
17701   if (!ID) {
17702     if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) {
17703       if (!CD->IsClassExtension())
17704         return;
17705     }
17706     // No need to add this to end of @implementation.
17707     else
17708       return;
17709   }
17710   // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars.
17711   llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0);
17712   Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc);
17713 
17714   Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext),
17715                               DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr,
17716                               Context.CharTy,
17717                               Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy,
17718                                                                DeclLoc),
17719                               ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW,
17720                               true);
17721   AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar);
17722 }
17723 
17724 namespace {
17725 /// [class.dtor]p4:
17726 ///   At the end of the definition of a class, overload resolution is
17727 ///   performed among the prospective destructors declared in that class with
17728 ///   an empty argument list to select the destructor for the class, also
17729 ///   known as the selected destructor.
17730 ///
17731 /// We do the overload resolution here, then mark the selected constructor in the AST.
17732 /// Later CXXRecordDecl::getDestructor() will return the selected constructor.
17733 void ComputeSelectedDestructor(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
17734   if (!Record->hasUserDeclaredDestructor()) {
17735     return;
17736   }
17737 
17738   SourceLocation Loc = Record->getLocation();
17739   OverloadCandidateSet OCS(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
17740 
17741   for (auto *Decl : Record->decls()) {
17742     if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Decl)) {
17743       if (DD->isInvalidDecl())
17744         continue;
17745       S.AddOverloadCandidate(DD, DeclAccessPair::make(DD, DD->getAccess()), {},
17746                              OCS);
17747       assert(DD->isIneligibleOrNotSelected() && "Selecting a destructor but a destructor was already selected.");
17748     }
17749   }
17750 
17751   if (OCS.empty()) {
17752     return;
17753   }
17754   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
17755   unsigned Msg = 0;
17756   OverloadCandidateDisplayKind DisplayKind;
17757 
17758   switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, Loc, Best)) {
17759   case OR_Success:
17760   case OR_Deleted:
17761     Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Best->Function));
17762     break;
17763 
17764   case OR_Ambiguous:
17765     Msg = diag::err_ambiguous_destructor;
17766     DisplayKind = OCD_AmbiguousCandidates;
17767     break;
17768 
17769   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
17770     Msg = diag::err_no_viable_destructor;
17771     DisplayKind = OCD_AllCandidates;
17772     break;
17773   }
17774 
17775   if (Msg) {
17776     // OpenCL have got their own thing going with destructors. It's slightly broken,
17777     // but we allow it.
17778     if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL) {
17779       PartialDiagnostic Diag = S.PDiag(Msg) << Record;
17780       OCS.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(Loc, Diag), S, DisplayKind, {});
17781       Record->setInvalidDecl();
17782     }
17783     // It's a bit hacky: At this point we've raised an error but we want the
17784     // rest of the compiler to continue somehow working. However almost
17785     // everything we'll try to do with the class will depend on there being a
17786     // destructor. So let's pretend the first one is selected and hope for the
17787     // best.
17788     Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(OCS.begin()->Function));
17789   }
17790 }
17791 } // namespace
17792 
17793 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl,
17794                        ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac,
17795                        SourceLocation RBrac,
17796                        const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) {
17797   assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl");
17798 
17799   // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have
17800   // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since
17801   // it will now change.
17802   if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17803     ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17804     switch (DC->getKind()) {
17805     default: break;
17806     case Decl::ObjCCategory:
17807       Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface());
17808       break;
17809     case Decl::ObjCImplementation:
17810       Context.
17811         ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface());
17812       break;
17813     }
17814   }
17815 
17816   RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17817   CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17818 
17819   if (CXXRecord && !CXXRecord->isDependentType())
17820     ComputeSelectedDestructor(*this, CXXRecord);
17821 
17822   // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include
17823   // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total.
17824   unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0;
17825   if (Record) {
17826     for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) {
17827       if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I))
17828         if (IFD->getDeclName())
17829           ++NumNamedMembers;
17830     }
17831   }
17832 
17833   // Verify that all the fields are okay.
17834   SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields;
17835 
17836   for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end();
17837        i != end; ++i) {
17838     FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i);
17839 
17840     // Get the type for the field.
17841     const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr();
17842 
17843     if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
17844       // Remember all fields written by the user.
17845       RecFields.push_back(FD);
17846     }
17847 
17848     // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more
17849     // diagnostics about it.
17850     if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
17851       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17852       continue;
17853     }
17854 
17855     // C99 6.7.2.1p2:
17856     //   A structure or union shall not contain a member with
17857     //   incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not
17858     //   contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to
17859     //   an instance of itself), except that the last member of a
17860     //   structure with more than one named member may have incomplete
17861     //   array type; such a structure (and any union containing,
17862     //   possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure)
17863     //   shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an
17864     //   array.
17865     bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end());
17866     if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) {
17867       // Field declared as a function.
17868       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function)
17869         << FD->getDeclName();
17870       FD->setInvalidDecl();
17871       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17872       continue;
17873     } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() &&
17874                (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) {
17875       if (Record) {
17876         // Flexible array member.
17877         // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array.
17878         // It will accept flexible array in union and also
17879         // as the sole element of a struct/class.
17880         unsigned DiagID = 0;
17881         if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) {
17882           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end)
17883             << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind();
17884           Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration);
17885           FD->setInvalidDecl();
17886           EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17887           continue;
17888         } else if (Record->isUnion())
17889           DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt
17890                        ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms
17891                        : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
17892                              ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu
17893                              : diag::err_flexible_array_union;
17894         else if (NumNamedMembers < 1)
17895           DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt
17896                        ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms
17897                        : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
17898                              ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu
17899                              : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate;
17900 
17901         if (DiagID)
17902           Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName()
17903                                           << Record->getTagKind();
17904         // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified
17905         // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place
17906         // virtual bases after the derived members.  This would make a flexible
17907         // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end
17908         // of the type.
17909         if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0)
17910           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base)
17911               << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind();
17912         if (!getLangOpts().C99)
17913           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member)
17914             << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind();
17915 
17916         // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not
17917         // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now.
17918         //
17919         // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete
17920         // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this.
17921         QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17922         if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) {
17923           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor)
17924             << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
17925           FD->setInvalidDecl();
17926           EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17927           continue;
17928         }
17929         // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct.
17930         Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true);
17931       } else {
17932         // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted,
17933         // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done
17934         // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known.
17935       }
17936     } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() &&
17937                RequireCompleteSizedType(
17938                    FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(),
17939                    diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) {
17940       // Incomplete type
17941       FD->setInvalidDecl();
17942       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17943       continue;
17944     } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17945       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
17946         // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a
17947         // flexible array member.
17948         Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true);
17949         if (!Record->isUnion()) {
17950           // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject
17951           // it.  Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of
17952           // structures.
17953           if (!IsLastField)
17954             Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct)
17955               << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
17956           else {
17957             // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in
17958             // other structs as an extension.
17959             Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct)
17960               << FD->getDeclName();
17961           }
17962         }
17963       }
17964       if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) &&
17965           RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(),
17966                                  diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
17967                                  AbstractIvarType)) {
17968         // Ivars can not have abstract class types
17969         FD->setInvalidDecl();
17970       }
17971       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember())
17972         Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17973       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember())
17974         Record->setHasVolatileMember(true);
17975     } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
17976       /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object
17977       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object)
17978         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*");
17979       QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType());
17980       FD->setType(T);
17981     } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() &&
17982                FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() &&
17983                getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) &&
17984                !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() &&
17985                (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
17986                 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) {
17987       // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system
17988       // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked
17989       // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can
17990       // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but
17991       // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under
17992       // ARC.
17993       FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(
17994           Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership,
17995           FD->getLocation()));
17996     } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
17997                getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record &&
17998                !Record->hasObjectMember()) {
17999       if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
18000           FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong())
18001         Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
18002       else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) {
18003         QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
18004         if (BaseType->isRecordType() &&
18005             BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember())
18006           Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
18007         else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
18008                  BaseType.isObjCGCStrong())
18009                Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
18010       }
18011     }
18012 
18013     if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18014         !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) {
18015       QualType FT = FD->getType();
18016       if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) {
18017         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true);
18018         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
18019             Record->isUnion())
18020           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true);
18021       }
18022       QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy();
18023       if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) {
18024         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true);
18025         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion())
18026           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true);
18027       }
18028       if (FT.isDestructedType()) {
18029         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true);
18030         Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true);
18031         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion())
18032           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true);
18033       }
18034 
18035       if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) {
18036         if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() ==
18037             RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs)
18038           Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs);
18039       } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
18040         Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs);
18041     }
18042 
18043     if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified())
18044       Record->setHasVolatileMember(true);
18045     // Keep track of the number of named members.
18046     if (FD->getIdentifier())
18047       ++NumNamedMembers;
18048   }
18049 
18050   // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'.
18051   if (Record) {
18052     bool Completed = false;
18053     if (CXXRecord) {
18054       if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) {
18055         // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions.
18056         for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
18057                I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(),
18058                E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I)
18059           I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess());
18060       }
18061 
18062       // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class.
18063       AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord);
18064 
18065       if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) {
18066         if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) {
18067           // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple
18068           // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this
18069           // problem now.
18070           if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) {
18071             CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders;
18072             CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders);
18073 
18074             for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(),
18075                                              MEnd = FinalOverriders.end();
18076                  M != MEnd; ++M) {
18077               for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(),
18078                                             SOEnd = M->second.end();
18079                    SO != SOEnd; ++SO) {
18080                 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 &&
18081                        "Virtual function without overriding functions?");
18082                 if (SO->second.size() == 1)
18083                   continue;
18084 
18085                 // C++ [class.virtual]p2:
18086                 //   In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base
18087                 //   class subobject has more than one final overrider the
18088                 //   program is ill-formed.
18089                 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders)
18090                   << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record;
18091                 Diag(M->first->getLocation(),
18092                      diag::note_overridden_virtual_function);
18093                 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator
18094                           OM = SO->second.begin(),
18095                        OMEnd = SO->second.end();
18096                      OM != OMEnd; ++OM)
18097                   Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider)
18098                     << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent();
18099 
18100                 Record->setInvalidDecl();
18101               }
18102             }
18103             CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders);
18104             Completed = true;
18105           }
18106         }
18107       }
18108     }
18109 
18110     if (!Completed)
18111       Record->completeDefinition();
18112 
18113     // Handle attributes before checking the layout.
18114     ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs);
18115 
18116     // Check to see if a FieldDecl is a pointer to a function.
18117     auto IsFunctionPointer = [&](const Decl *D) {
18118       const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
18119       if (!FD)
18120         return false;
18121       QualType FieldType = FD->getType().getDesugaredType(Context);
18122       if (isa<PointerType>(FieldType)) {
18123         QualType PointeeType = cast<PointerType>(FieldType)->getPointeeType();
18124         return PointeeType.getDesugaredType(Context)->isFunctionType();
18125       }
18126       return false;
18127     };
18128 
18129     // Maybe randomize the record's decls. We automatically randomize a record
18130     // of function pointers, unless it has the "no_randomize_layout" attribute.
18131     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18132         (Record->hasAttr<RandomizeLayoutAttr>() ||
18133          (!Record->hasAttr<NoRandomizeLayoutAttr>() &&
18134           llvm::all_of(Record->decls(), IsFunctionPointer))) &&
18135         !Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().RandstructSeed.empty() &&
18136         !Record->isRandomized()) {
18137       SmallVector<Decl *, 32> NewDeclOrdering;
18138       if (randstruct::randomizeStructureLayout(Context, Record,
18139                                                NewDeclOrdering))
18140         Record->reorderDecls(NewDeclOrdering);
18141     }
18142 
18143     // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now.
18144     if (CXXRecord) {
18145       auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor();
18146       if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() &&
18147           ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) {
18148         CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted();
18149         SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation());
18150       }
18151     }
18152 
18153     if (Record->hasAttrs()) {
18154       CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record);
18155 
18156       if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>())
18157         checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record),
18158                                            IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(),
18159                                            IA->getInheritanceModel());
18160     }
18161 
18162     // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero
18163     // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause
18164     // compatibility problems.
18165     bool CheckForZeroSize;
18166     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18167       CheckForZeroSize = true;
18168     } else {
18169       // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code.
18170       CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record);
18171       CheckForZeroSize =
18172           CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() &&
18173           !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() &&
18174           CXXRecord->isCLike();
18175     }
18176     if (CheckForZeroSize) {
18177       bool ZeroSize = true;
18178       bool IsEmpty = true;
18179       unsigned NonBitFields = 0;
18180       for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(),
18181                                       E = Record->field_end();
18182            (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) {
18183         IsEmpty = false;
18184         if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
18185           if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context))
18186             ZeroSize = false;
18187         } else {
18188           ++NonBitFields;
18189           QualType FieldType = I->getType();
18190           if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() ||
18191               !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero())
18192             ZeroSize = false;
18193         }
18194       }
18195 
18196       // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are
18197       // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside
18198       // extern "C" block.
18199       if (ZeroSize) {
18200         Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ?
18201                          diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c :
18202                          diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat)
18203           << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1);
18204       }
18205 
18206       // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7),
18207       // but are accepted by GCC.
18208       if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18209         Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union :
18210                                diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union)
18211           << Record->isUnion();
18212       }
18213     }
18214   } else {
18215     ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields =
18216       reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data());
18217     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
18218       ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac);
18219       // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext.
18220       for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18221         ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID);
18222         ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]);
18223       }
18224       // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be
18225       // duplicates.
18226       if (ID->getSuperClass())
18227         DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass());
18228     } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl =
18229                   dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
18230       assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl");
18231       for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I)
18232         // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation.
18233         // Only it is in implementation's lexical context.
18234         ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl);
18235       CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac);
18236       IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac);
18237       IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac);
18238     } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl =
18239                 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
18240       // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been
18241       // reported as errors elsewhere.
18242       // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field.
18243       // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac);
18244       // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext.
18245       // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars.
18246       ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface();
18247       for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18248         if (IDecl) {
18249           if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar =
18250               IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) {
18251             Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(),
18252                  diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration);
18253             Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
18254             continue;
18255           }
18256           for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) {
18257             if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar
18258                   = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) {
18259               Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(),
18260                    diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration);
18261               Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
18262               continue;
18263             }
18264           }
18265         }
18266         ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl);
18267         CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]);
18268       }
18269       CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac);
18270       CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac);
18271     }
18272   }
18273 }
18274 
18275 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within
18276 /// the given type T.
18277 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context,
18278                                         llvm::APSInt &Value,
18279                                         QualType T) {
18280   assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) &&
18281          "Integral type required!");
18282   unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T);
18283 
18284   if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) {
18285     if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType())
18286       --BitWidth;
18287     return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth;
18288   }
18289   return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth;
18290 }
18291 
18292 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type
18293 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists).
18294 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) {
18295   // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into
18296   // enum checking below.
18297   assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) ||
18298          T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!");
18299   const unsigned NumTypes = 4;
18300   QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = {
18301     Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy
18302   };
18303   QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = {
18304     Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy,
18305     Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
18306   };
18307 
18308   unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T);
18309   QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes
18310                                                         : UnsignedIntegralTypes;
18311   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I)
18312     if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth)
18313       return Types[I];
18314 
18315   return QualType();
18316 }
18317 
18318 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum,
18319                                           EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst,
18320                                           SourceLocation IdLoc,
18321                                           IdentifierInfo *Id,
18322                                           Expr *Val) {
18323   unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
18324   llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth);
18325   QualType EltTy;
18326 
18327   if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue))
18328     Val = nullptr;
18329 
18330   if (Val)
18331     Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get();
18332 
18333   if (Val) {
18334     if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent() ||
18335         Val->containsErrors())
18336       EltTy = Context.DependentTy;
18337     else {
18338       // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed
18339       // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts.
18340       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) {
18341         // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the
18342         // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted
18343         // constant expression of the underlying type.
18344         EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
18345         ExprResult Converted =
18346           CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal,
18347                                            CCEK_Enumerator);
18348         if (Converted.isInvalid())
18349           Val = nullptr;
18350         else
18351           Val = Converted.get();
18352       } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() &&
18353                  !(Val =
18354                        VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold)
18355                            .get())) {
18356         // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression.
18357       } else {
18358         if (Enum->isComplete()) {
18359           EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
18360 
18361           // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be
18362           // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11,
18363           // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant
18364           // expression checking.
18365           if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) {
18366             if (Context.getTargetInfo()
18367                     .getTriple()
18368                     .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) {
18369               Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy;
18370             } else {
18371               Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy;
18372             }
18373           }
18374 
18375           // Cast to the underlying type.
18376           Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy,
18377                                   EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean
18378                                                          : CK_IntegralCast)
18379                     .get();
18380         } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18381           // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5:
18382           //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
18383           //   is the type of its initializing value:
18384           //     - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the
18385           //       initializing value has the same type as the expression.
18386           EltTy = Val->getType();
18387         } else {
18388           // C99 6.7.2.2p2:
18389           //   The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant
18390           //   shall be an integer constant expression that has a value
18391           //   representable as an int.
18392 
18393           // Complain if the value is not representable in an int.
18394           if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy))
18395             Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int)
18396               << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange()
18397               << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative());
18398           else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) {
18399             // Force the type of the expression to 'int'.
18400             Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
18401           }
18402           EltTy = Val->getType();
18403         }
18404       }
18405     }
18406   }
18407 
18408   if (!Val) {
18409     if (Enum->isDependentType())
18410       EltTy = Context.DependentTy;
18411     else if (!LastEnumConst) {
18412       // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5:
18413       //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
18414       //   is the type of its initializing value:
18415       //     - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the
18416       //       initializing value has an unspecified integral type.
18417       //
18418       // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does
18419       // C99 6.7.2.2p3.
18420       if (Enum->isFixed()) {
18421         EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
18422       }
18423       else {
18424         EltTy = Context.IntTy;
18425       }
18426     } else {
18427       // Assign the last value + 1.
18428       EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
18429       ++EnumVal;
18430       EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType();
18431 
18432       // Check for overflow on increment.
18433       if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) {
18434         // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5:
18435         //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
18436         //   is the type of its initializing value:
18437         //
18438         //     - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as
18439         //       the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator
18440         //       unless the incremented value is not representable in that type,
18441         //       in which case the type is an unspecified integral type
18442         //       sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type
18443         //       exists, the program is ill-formed.
18444         QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy);
18445         if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) {
18446           // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this
18447           // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around.
18448           EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
18449           EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2);
18450           ++EnumVal;
18451           if (Enum->isFixed())
18452             // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed.
18453             Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped)
18454               << toString(EnumVal, 10)
18455               << EltTy;
18456           else
18457             Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large)
18458               << toString(EnumVal, 10);
18459         } else {
18460           EltTy = T;
18461         }
18462 
18463         // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the
18464         // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented
18465         // value, then increment.
18466         EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
18467         EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType());
18468         EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy));
18469         ++EnumVal;
18470 
18471         // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values,
18472         // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in
18473         // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that
18474         // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger
18475         // integral type.
18476         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull())
18477           Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow);
18478       } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18479                  !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) {
18480         // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value.
18481         Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int)
18482           << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1;
18483       }
18484     }
18485   }
18486 
18487   if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) {
18488     // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the
18489     // enumerator's type.
18490     EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy));
18491     EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType());
18492   }
18493 
18494   return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy,
18495                                   Val, EnumVal);
18496 }
18497 
18498 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II,
18499                                                 SourceLocation IILoc) {
18500   if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) ||
18501       !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18502     return SkipBodyInfo();
18503 
18504   // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to
18505   // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and
18506   // skip the body.
18507   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName,
18508                                          forRedeclarationInCurContext());
18509   auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl);
18510   if (!PrevECD)
18511     return SkipBodyInfo();
18512 
18513   EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext());
18514   NamedDecl *Hidden;
18515   if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) {
18516     SkipBodyInfo Skip;
18517     Skip.Previous = Hidden;
18518     return Skip;
18519   }
18520 
18521   return SkipBodyInfo();
18522 }
18523 
18524 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst,
18525                               SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id,
18526                               const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs,
18527                               SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) {
18528   EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl);
18529   EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst =
18530     cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst);
18531 
18532   // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope.  Zip up the scope tree until
18533   // we find one that is.
18534   S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
18535 
18536   // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this
18537   // scope.
18538   LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration);
18539   LookupName(R, S);
18540   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>();
18541 
18542   if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
18543     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
18544     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl);
18545     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
18546     PrevDecl = nullptr;
18547   }
18548 
18549   // C++ [class.mem]p15:
18550   // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name
18551   // different from T:
18552   // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped
18553   // enumerated type
18554   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped())
18555     DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(),
18556                             DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc));
18557 
18558   EnumConstantDecl *New =
18559     CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val);
18560   if (!New)
18561     return nullptr;
18562 
18563   if (PrevDecl) {
18564     if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
18565       // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled.
18566       CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R);
18567     }
18568 
18569     // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the
18570     // enum constant will 'hide' the tag.
18571     assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) &&
18572            "Received TagDecl when not in C++!");
18573     if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) {
18574       if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl))
18575         Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id;
18576       else
18577         Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id;
18578       notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc);
18579       return nullptr;
18580     }
18581   }
18582 
18583   // Process attributes.
18584   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs);
18585   AddPragmaAttributes(S, New);
18586 
18587   // Register this decl in the current scope stack.
18588   New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess());
18589   PushOnScopeChains(New, S);
18590 
18591   ActOnDocumentableDecl(New);
18592 
18593   return New;
18594 }
18595 
18596 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the
18597 // duplicate enum warning.  A few common cases are exempted as follows:
18598 // Element2 = Element1
18599 // Element2 = Element1 + 1
18600 // Element2 = Element1 - 1
18601 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum.
18602 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) {
18603   Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr();
18604   if (!InitExpr)
18605     return true;
18606   InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts();
18607 
18608   if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) {
18609     if (!BO->isAdditiveOp())
18610       return true;
18611     IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS());
18612     if (!IL)
18613       return true;
18614     if (IL->getValue() != 1)
18615       return true;
18616 
18617     InitExpr = BO->getLHS();
18618   }
18619 
18620   // This checks if the elements are from the same enum.
18621   DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr);
18622   if (!DRE)
18623     return true;
18624 
18625   EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
18626   if (!EnumConstant)
18627     return true;
18628 
18629   if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) !=
18630       Enum)
18631     return true;
18632 
18633   return false;
18634 }
18635 
18636 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that
18637 // a previous element has already been set to.
18638 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements,
18639                                         EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) {
18640   // Avoid anonymous enums
18641   if (!Enum->getIdentifier())
18642     return;
18643 
18644   // Only check for small enums.
18645   if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64)
18646     return;
18647 
18648   if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation()))
18649     return;
18650 
18651   typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector;
18652   typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector;
18653 
18654   typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector;
18655 
18656   // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map.
18657   typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap;
18658 
18659   // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys.
18660   auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) {
18661     llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal();
18662     return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue();
18663   };
18664 
18665   DuplicatesVector DupVector;
18666   ValueToVectorMap EnumMap;
18667 
18668   // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without
18669   // an initializer.
18670   for (auto *Element : Elements) {
18671     EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element);
18672 
18673     // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for
18674     // this constant.  Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed.
18675     if (!ECD) {
18676       return;
18677     }
18678 
18679     // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop.
18680     if (ECD->getInitExpr())
18681       continue;
18682 
18683     // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop.
18684     EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD});
18685   }
18686 
18687   if (EnumMap.size() == 0)
18688     return;
18689 
18690   // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates.
18691   for (auto *Element : Elements) {
18692     // The last loop returned if any constant was null.
18693     EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element);
18694     if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum))
18695       continue;
18696 
18697     auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD));
18698     if (Iter == EnumMap.end())
18699       continue;
18700 
18701     DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second;
18702     if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) {
18703       // Ensure constants are different.
18704       if (D == ECD)
18705         continue;
18706 
18707       // Create new vector and push values onto it.
18708       auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>();
18709       Vec->push_back(D);
18710       Vec->push_back(ECD);
18711 
18712       // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector.
18713       Entry = Vec.get();
18714 
18715       // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of
18716       // diagnostics.
18717       DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec));
18718       continue;
18719     }
18720 
18721     ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>();
18722     // Make sure constants are not added more than once.
18723     if (*Vec->begin() == ECD)
18724       continue;
18725 
18726     Vec->push_back(ECD);
18727   }
18728 
18729   // Emit diagnostics.
18730   for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) {
18731     assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements.");
18732 
18733     // Emit warning for one enum constant.
18734     auto *FirstECD = Vec->front();
18735     S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values)
18736       << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10)
18737       << FirstECD->getSourceRange();
18738 
18739     // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with
18740     // the same value.
18741     for (auto *ECD : llvm::drop_begin(*Vec))
18742       S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element)
18743         << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10)
18744         << ECD->getSourceRange();
18745   }
18746 }
18747 
18748 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val,
18749                              bool AllowMask) const {
18750   assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum");
18751   assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition");
18752 
18753   auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt()));
18754   llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second;
18755 
18756   if (R.second) {
18757     for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) {
18758       const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal();
18759       // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values.
18760       if (EVal.isPowerOf2())
18761         FlagBits = FlagBits.zext(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal;
18762     }
18763   }
18764 
18765   // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's
18766   // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is
18767   // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we
18768   // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value.
18769   //
18770   // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is
18771   // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is
18772   // likely a logic error.
18773   llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth());
18774   return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val));
18775 }
18776 
18777 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange,
18778                          Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S,
18779                          const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) {
18780   EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX);
18781   QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum);
18782 
18783   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs);
18784 
18785   if (Enum->isDependentType()) {
18786     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18787       EnumConstantDecl *ECD =
18788         cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]);
18789       if (!ECD) continue;
18790 
18791       ECD->setType(EnumType);
18792     }
18793 
18794     Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0);
18795     return;
18796   }
18797 
18798   // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long
18799   // long value.  ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension,
18800   // emit a warning.
18801   unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
18802   unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth();
18803   unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth();
18804 
18805   // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and
18806   // reverse the list.
18807   unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0;
18808   unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0;
18809 
18810   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18811     EnumConstantDecl *ECD =
18812       cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]);
18813     if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18814 
18815     const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18816 
18817     // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values.
18818     if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative())
18819       NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits,
18820                                  (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits());
18821     else
18822       NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits,
18823                                  (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits());
18824   }
18825 
18826   // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum.
18827   QualType BestType;
18828   unsigned BestWidth;
18829 
18830   // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3:
18831   //   An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying
18832   //   type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first
18833   //   of the following types that can represent all the values of
18834   //   the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long
18835   //   int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
18836   // C99 6.4.4.3p2:
18837   //   An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int.
18838   // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension
18839   QualType BestPromotionType;
18840 
18841   bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
18842   // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all
18843   // enum definitions.
18844   if (LangOpts.ShortEnums)
18845     Packed = true;
18846 
18847   // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the
18848   // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators.
18849   if (Enum->isComplete()) {
18850     BestType = Enum->getIntegerType();
18851     if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType())
18852       BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType);
18853     else
18854       BestPromotionType = BestType;
18855 
18856     BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType);
18857   }
18858   else if (NumNegativeBits) {
18859     // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of
18860     // int/long/longlong) that fits.
18861     // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short.
18862     if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) {
18863       BestType = Context.SignedCharTy;
18864       BestWidth = CharWidth;
18865     } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth &&
18866                NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) {
18867       BestType = Context.ShortTy;
18868       BestWidth = ShortWidth;
18869     } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) {
18870       BestType = Context.IntTy;
18871       BestWidth = IntWidth;
18872     } else {
18873       BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
18874 
18875       if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) {
18876         BestType = Context.LongTy;
18877       } else {
18878         BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
18879 
18880         if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth)
18881           Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large);
18882         BestType = Context.LongLongTy;
18883       }
18884     }
18885     BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType);
18886   } else {
18887     // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits
18888     // all of the enumerator values.
18889     // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short.
18890     if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) {
18891       BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
18892       BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy;
18893       BestWidth = CharWidth;
18894     } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) {
18895       BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
18896       BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy;
18897       BestWidth = ShortWidth;
18898     } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) {
18899       BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
18900       BestWidth = IntWidth;
18901       BestPromotionType
18902         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18903                            ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
18904     } else if (NumPositiveBits <=
18905                (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) {
18906       BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
18907       BestPromotionType
18908         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18909                            ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
18910     } else {
18911       BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
18912       assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth &&
18913              "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?");
18914       BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
18915       BestPromotionType
18916         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18917                            ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
18918     }
18919   }
18920 
18921   // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match
18922   // the type of the enum if needed.
18923   for (auto *D : Elements) {
18924     auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
18925     if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18926 
18927     // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an
18928     // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size.  If each
18929     // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the
18930     // same as the enumerator decl itself.  This means that in "enum { X = 1U }"
18931     // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'.
18932 
18933     // Determine whether the value fits into an int.
18934     llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18935 
18936     // If it fits into an integer type, force it.  Otherwise force it to match
18937     // the enum decl type.
18938     QualType NewTy;
18939     unsigned NewWidth;
18940     bool NewSign;
18941     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18942         !Enum->isFixed() &&
18943         isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) {
18944       NewTy = Context.IntTy;
18945       NewWidth = IntWidth;
18946       NewSign = true;
18947     } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) {
18948       // Already the right type!
18949       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18950         // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an
18951         // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its
18952         // enumeration.
18953         ECD->setType(EnumType);
18954       continue;
18955     } else {
18956       NewTy = BestType;
18957       NewWidth = BestWidth;
18958       NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
18959     }
18960 
18961     // Adjust the APSInt value.
18962     InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth);
18963     InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign);
18964     ECD->setInitVal(InitVal);
18965 
18966     // Adjust the Expr initializer and type.
18967     if (ECD->getInitExpr() &&
18968         !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType()))
18969       ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
18970           Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(),
18971           /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride()));
18972     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18973       // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an
18974       // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its
18975       // enumeration.
18976       ECD->setType(EnumType);
18977     else
18978       ECD->setType(NewTy);
18979   }
18980 
18981   Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType,
18982                            NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits);
18983 
18984   CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType);
18985 
18986   if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) {
18987     for (Decl *D : Elements) {
18988       EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
18989       if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18990 
18991       llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18992       if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() &&
18993           !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true))
18994         Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range)
18995           << ECD << Enum;
18996     }
18997   }
18998 
18999   // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned.
19000   if (Enum->hasAttrs())
19001     CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum);
19002 }
19003 
19004 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr,
19005                                   SourceLocation StartLoc,
19006                                   SourceLocation EndLoc) {
19007   StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr);
19008 
19009   FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext,
19010                                                    AsmString, StartLoc,
19011                                                    EndLoc);
19012   CurContext->addDecl(New);
19013   return New;
19014 }
19015 
19016 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name,
19017                                       IdentifierInfo* AliasName,
19018                                       SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
19019                                       SourceLocation NameLoc,
19020                                       SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) {
19021   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc,
19022                                          LookupOrdinaryName);
19023   AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc),
19024                            AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma);
19025   AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit(
19026       Context, AliasName->getName(), /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, Info);
19027 
19028   // If a declaration that:
19029   // 1) declares a function or a variable
19030   // 2) has external linkage
19031   // already exists, add a label attribute to it.
19032   if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) {
19033     if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl))
19034       PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr);
19035     else
19036       Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
19037           << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl;
19038   // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.
19039   } else
19040     (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr));
19041 }
19042 
19043 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name,
19044                              SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
19045                              SourceLocation NameLoc) {
19046   Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
19047 
19048   if (PrevDecl) {
19049     PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
19050   } else {
19051     (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[Name].insert(WeakInfo(nullptr, NameLoc));
19052   }
19053 }
19054 
19055 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name,
19056                                 IdentifierInfo* AliasName,
19057                                 SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
19058                                 SourceLocation NameLoc,
19059                                 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) {
19060   Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc,
19061                                     LookupOrdinaryName);
19062   WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc);
19063 
19064   if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) {
19065     if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>())
19066       if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl))
19067         DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W);
19068   } else {
19069     (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[AliasName].insert(W);
19070   }
19071 }
19072 
19073 ObjCContainerDecl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const {
19074   return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext));
19075 }
19076 
19077 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD,
19078                                                      bool Final) {
19079   assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl");
19080 
19081   // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate
19082   // attribute prior to checking if it is a template.
19083   if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>())
19084     return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19085 
19086   // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated.
19087   if (FD->isDependentContext())
19088     return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded;
19089 
19090   // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition.
19091   auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() {
19092     // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we
19093     // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will
19094     // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline".
19095     FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition();
19096 
19097     return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage(
19098                       getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def));
19099   };
19100 
19101   if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) {
19102     // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions
19103     // we don't need due to their linkage.
19104     Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy =
19105         OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl());
19106     // DevTy may be changed later by
19107     //  #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*).
19108     // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status
19109     // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true.
19110     if (DevTy)
19111       if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host)
19112         return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
19113     // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target
19114     // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols.
19115     if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy)
19116       if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol())
19117         return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19118     // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed,
19119     // we'll omit it.
19120     if (Final)
19121       return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
19122   } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) {
19123     // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host
19124     // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to
19125     // be ommitted.
19126     Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy =
19127         OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl());
19128     if (DevTy)
19129       if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost)
19130         return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
19131   }
19132 
19133   if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA)
19134     return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19135 
19136   if (LangOpts.CUDA) {
19137     // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted.  Similarly,
19138     // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted.
19139     // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this
19140     // doesn't count for our purposes here.)
19141     Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD);
19142     if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host)
19143       return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded;
19144     if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
19145         (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global))
19146       return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded;
19147 
19148     if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol())
19149       return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19150   }
19151 
19152   // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of
19153   // known-emitted functions.
19154   return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown;
19155 }
19156 
19157 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) {
19158   // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the
19159   // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked.
19160   // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function
19161   // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the
19162   // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling
19163   // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as
19164   // known-emitted.
19165   return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
19166          IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global;
19167 }
19168